- 12.49 MB
- 2021-11-23 发布
- 1、本文档由用户上传,淘文库整理发布,可阅读全部内容。
- 2、本文档内容版权归属内容提供方,所产生的收益全部归内容提供方所有。如果您对本文有版权争议,请立即联系网站客服。
- 3、本文档由用户上传,本站不保证质量和数量令人满意,可能有诸多瑕疵,付费之前,请仔细阅读内容确认后进行付费下载。
- 网站客服QQ:403074932
3
Unit 1 My classroom
教材分析
本单元学习的主题是新学期开始打扫新更换的教室。教学内容主要是通过学生们谈论、打
扫教室的情景来呈现的。教学重点是能够听、说、认读核心句型“What’s in the classroom?”
“Let’s go and see!”“—Where is it? —It’s near the window.”“Let’s clean the
classroom.”“Let me clean the teacher’s desk.”;能够听、说、认读单词和短语“classroom,
window, blackboard, light, picture, door, teacher’s desk, computer, fan, wall, floor”。
教学目标
知识与能力目标:
句型
·能够听、说、认读句型“What’s in the classroom?”“Let’s go and see!”“—Where is
it? —It’s near the window.”“Let’s clean the classroom.”“Let me clean the
teacher’s desk.”
·能够在情景中运用句型“—Where is…? —It’s in/on/under/near the…”询问并回答物
品的位置
·能够在情景中运用句型“Let’s…”“Let me…”提出行动建议
·能够按意群朗读“—Where is the green book? —It is under the teacher’s desk.”等
四组句子
词汇
·能够听、说、认读单词和短语“classroom, window, blackboard, light, picture, door,
teacher’s desk, computer, fan, wall, floor”
·能够正确使用上述词汇描述教室里的物品及设施
·能够在有意义的语境中正确书写上述词汇
语音
·能够掌握 a-e 的发音规则,即 a-e 在单词中发长音/eɪ/
·能够读出符合 a-e 发音规则的单词,并能够根据读音拼写出符合 a-e 发音规则的单词
情感态度、文化意识、学习策略目标:
·学习礼貌言行,能够对请求、道歉等行为做出恰当反应
·具有讲卫生、爱整洁的意识
·能够根据 a-e 的发音规则拼读单词,并能够根据 a 与 a-e 的发音规则拼写单词
课时安排
第一课时: Part A Let’s talk & Let’s play
第二课时: Part A Let’s learn & Let’s do
第三课时: Part A Let’s spell
第四课时: Part B Let’s talk & Let’s play
第五课时: Part B Let’s learn & Let’s play
第六课时: Part B Read and write & Let’s check & Let’s sing
The first period(第一课时)
Part A Let’s talk & Let’s play
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s talk
·通过观察、谈论 Let’s talk 板块的图片,能够理解对话大意
·能够按照正确的语音、语调及意群朗读对话,并能够在小组中进行角色扮演
·能够在情景中运用句型“—Where is…? —It’s in/on/under/near…”询问并回答物
品的位置
·能够在情景中恰当运用句型“What’s in the classroom?”“Let’s go and see!”谈
论教室
·能够在语境中借助图片等帮助理解新词“classroom, really, picture, near, window”
的意思,并能够正确发音
Let’s play ·通过本部分提供的教学活动,进一步巩固对方位介词的理解和运用及操练本课时的重要
句型“—Where is…? —It’s in/on/under/near…”
▶教学重点
1 能够按照正确的语音、语调及意群朗读对话,并能够在小组中进行角色扮演。
2 能够理解和掌握本课重点句型“What’s in the classroom?” “Let’s go and see!”“—Where is…?
—It’s in/on/under/near…”。
3 能够在情景中运用以上句型与他人谈论相关话题。
▶教学难点
能够在语境中灵活运用以上句型。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2.PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、头饰、单词卡片等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Enjoy an English song—We have a new classroom. (出示课件)
3. Free talk.
T: Hello, S1. What’s in your pencil box?
S1: (Open the pencil box.) A pen, three pencils, a ruler…
The teacher asks more students to answer the question of “What’s
in your pencil box?”
4. Let’s do.
T: Boys and girls, let’s play a game—“I say, you do.”
Show me your ruler. Put your pencil on your desk.
Put your crayon in your bag.
Put your eraser on your English book.
…
Teaching purpose
通过与学生的自由谈话
拉近师生间的距离,创造和
谐愉悦的学习环境,并引出
本课句型“What’s in…?”。
通过 Let’s do 复习以前学过
的方位介词 on, in, under 等,
为后面的学习做好铺垫。
Teaching purpose
在导入环节,教师继续
使 用 句 型 “ What’s in
your…?”对学生的绘画内容
进行提问,提前进行新句型
及常用语“Really? Let’s go
and see.”的渗透,使学生能
自然进入英语的学习氛围
中。
5
5. Lead-in.
T: OK. Let’s have a break. Take out your pencil and crayons to
draw a picture.
Then the teacher asks students to stand up and answer:
T: S1, what’s in your picture?
S1: Some flowers.
T: Really? Let’s go and see. Oh, your flowers are beautiful! S2,
what’s in your picture?
S2: An apple.
T: Really? Let’s go and see. Oh, your apple is big and red!
…
Step 2: Presentation
1. Learn the new vocabulary “classroom, picture, window, near the
window”.
(1)Look and learn.
T: Good, your pictures are very nice. Look! I have some pictures,
too. Class, all the things in the pictures are in our new classroom.
Show a picture of “classroom”. (课件出示:教室的图片及单词)
T: Look! This is a new classroom. Read after me:
class/klɑːs/-room/ru:m/, classroom .
Write down the word “classroom” on the blackboard and teach it.
Show another picture with a cover. (课件出示:一张被遮住的图画
的图片)
T: Guess! What is it?
Ss: 图画。
T: Really? Let’s have a look! Yes. It’s a picture. Read after
me: c/k/-ture/tʃə(r)/, picture .
Write down the word “picture” on the blackboard and teach it.
T: Do we have pictures in our classroom? Where are they?
Ss: Yes, they are on the…
T: Yes, they are on the wall.
Point to a picture near the window and teach the phrase “near the
window” and the sentence “It’s near the window.”
(课件出示:几张在窗户附近的图画及短语 near the window)
T: (Point to a picture near the window on the PPT.) Where is the
picture?
Ss: It’s near the window.
T: Yes, it’s near the window. Read after me: n/n/-ear/ɪə(r)/,
near/nɪə(r)/, w/w/-i/ I /-n/n/-d/d/-ow/əʊ/, window .
It’s near the window. Write down the sentence “It’s near the
window.” on the blackboard and teach it.
(2)Ask and answer.
Teaching purpose
学习 Let’s talk 板块的
对话之前,先通过图片和实
物学习新词汇“classroom,
picture, window, near the
window”及句子“It’s near
the window.”,为后面理解对
话清除障碍。
The teacher asks questions and let students answer them with the
sentence structures “—Where is the…? —It’s near the…” according
to some objects or word cards.
2. Learn the dialogue of “Let’s talk”.
Show the headdresses of Sarah and Zhang Peng.
T: Who are they?
Ss: Sarah and Zhang Peng.
Show the picture of Sarah and Zhang Peng’s new classroom. (出
示课件)
T: Class, we have a new classroom. This is Sarah and Zhang Peng’s
new classroom. They’re happy, because they have a new classroom.
What’s in the classroom? Let’s go and see!
S1: Many desks and chairs.
S2: A window.
S3: Some pictures.
…
Write down the sentences “We have a new classroom.” “What’s
in the classroom?” “Let’s go and see!” on the blackboard.
T: Good job! Guess! What are Sarah and Zhang Peng talking about?
S1: They are talking about the new classroom.
S2: They are talking about the picture.
3. Listen to the dialogue and answer the questions.
T: Well done! Let’s listen to the recording with the questions.
Underline the answers in the books. Let’s go and see! (课件出示:
教材 P4 Let’s talk 板块的音频)
Ask students to answer the questions.
S1: It’s so big.
S2: It’s Sarah’s picture.
S3: It’s near the window.
Step 3: Practice
1. Listen to the dialogue again and imitate.
Play the recording and let students listen and imitate sentence
by sentence.
2. Read the dialogue.
Ask students to read the dialogue freely and in pairs or in groups.
3. Read and act out.
T: Let’s read the dialogue in roles. Girls will be Sarah. Boys
will be Zhang Peng.
Then act out in pairs and show in class.
Teaching purpose
通过头饰和 PPT 图片
创设情境,引入 Let’s talk
板块的对话,先让学生观察
图片,说说图片中的教室里
都有哪些物品,一来检测学
生对新词的掌握情况,二来
可以降低学习难度,为后面
的学习扫清障碍。
Teaching purpose
听对话,通过三个问题
检测学生对对话的理解。
Teaching purpose
听录音跟读,引导学生
按照正确的语音、语调朗读
对话。采用分角色表演的方
式对重要句型进行操练,帮
助学生理解并运用这些句
型。
7
T: Who will be Sarah and Zhang Peng? Now, find your partners and
act it out. I will select the best pair. The red star is for the winner!
4. Play a game.
Borrow some pencil boxes from students and hide the pencil boxes
in different places.
T: Where is S1’s pencil box?
Let some students guess.
T: What’s in his/her pencil box?
Open the pencil box and let students answer.
5. Let’s play.
Present the picture of “Let’s play”. (出示课件)
T: I see something in the picture. It begins with “c”. What is
it?
S1: It’s a crayon.
T: Really? Let’s go and see! Where is it?
S1: It’s in the desk.
S2: It’s a car. It’s on the desk.
S3: I see a crayon, too. It’s on the floor.
T: Good job, kids! Now boys and girls, let’s play a game: I spy.
(游戏说明:当老师说“I spy. I spy. I see a letter ‘p’.”,学
生可以问“Where is it?”。老师告诉学生在哪里,然后学生必须告诉老师
那是什么。)
Make a model:
T: I spy. I spy. I see a letter “p”.
S1: Where is it?
T: It’s near the window.
S1: It’s a picture.
Then let students practice in pairs.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Ask and answer in pairs.
Show the picture of a classroom. (课件出示:另一幅教室图片) Ask
students to make their own dialogues according to the picture.
Practice in pairs and act it out in class.
2. Draw the new classroom and talk about it.
3. Show time.
T: So nice! You all have your new classroom. You must keep your
classroom clean and beautiful.
Teaching purpose
通过 Let’s play 板块提
供的 I spy 游戏进一步巩固
并练习新词汇及句型“—
Where is…? — It’s in/on/
under/near the…”。
Teaching purpose
在巩固和拓展环节,通
过编写并展示对话和画并
谈论学生新教室的图片,培
养和提高学生的综合语言
运用能力。
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Practice the dialogue.
2. Talk about your classroom with your partner.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1 教学流程简洁明了,过渡自然流畅,重点突出,借助各种教学手段降低难度、突破教学难点。
2 教师利用图片、实物、肢体语言等手段,让学生更直观地理解新词汇。
3 通过图片、PPT 等创设虚拟的语言情境,让学生在情景中真实自然地运用所学语言知识进行交流,达到
了学以致用的目的。
4 板书设计简练,学生在拓展环节能够根据板书内容编写新对话,对教学起到了很好的辅助作用。
9
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s talk
· Be able to understand the main idea of the dialogue by observing and talking about the pictures.
· Be able to read the dialogue correctly, fluently and emotionally, and then act it out in groups.
· Be able to use the sentence structures “—Where is…? —It’s in/on/under/near…” to ask and
answer the locations of objects in situations.
·Be able to use the sentence structures “What’s in the classroom?”“Let’s go and see!” properly
to talk about the classroom.
· Be able to understand and read the new words “classroom, really, picture, near, window”.
Let’s play
· Be able to consolidate the prepositions of the position and use the sentence structures “—Where
is…? —It’s in/on/under/near…” to communicate in real language situations.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to read the dialogue correctly, fluently and emotionally, and then act it out in groups.
·Be able to understand and master the key sentence structures “What’s in the classroom?”“Let’s
go and see!”“—Where is…? —It’s in/on/under/near…”
·Be able to use the above sentence structures to talk about related topics with others in situations.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the above sentence structures flexibly in situations.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Enjoy an English song—We
have a new classroom.
3. Free talk.
4. Let’s do.
5. Lead-in.
1. Greetings.
2. Enjoy the song.
3. Perceive the key sentence
structure.
4. Review the words “in,
on, under…”.
5. Draw a simple picture and
answer the question
“What’s in your
picture?”
Review the words that
students have learnt
and lead in the new
sentence structure to
prepare for the new
lesson.
Presentation
1. Teach the new vocabulary
“classroom, picture,
window, near the window”.
2. Teach the dialogue of
“Let’s talk”.
Talk about the picture and
teach the sentences “We have
a new classroom.” “What’s
in the classroom?” “Let’s
go and see!”
3. Play the recording and ask
some questions.
1. Learn the new vocabulary.
2. Talk about the picture.
Learn the dialogue of
“Let’s talk”. Learn
the key sentences.
3. Listen to the recording
and answer the questions.
Learn the new words,
phrase and sentence
before the learning of
the dialogue. Sweep the
language barrier.
Make sentences with
objects or pictures to
consolidate the
sentence structures and
deepen the
understanding of the
dialogue.
Practice
1. Listen to the dialogue again
and imitate.
Play the recording again and
let students listen and
imitate.
2. Read the dialogue.
3. Read and act out.
4. Play a game.
5. Let’s play.
Present the picture of
“Let’s play”. Make a
demonstration.
1. Listen to the recording
again and imitate.
2. Read the dialogue in
different ways.
3. Read and act out.
4. Play a game.
5. Let’s play.
Play the game and
practice in pairs.
Lead students to read
the dialogue according
to the correct
pronunciation and
intonation. Use games
and role-play to
practice the key
sentence structures to
help students
understand and use
them.
11
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Show the picture of a
classroom. Ask students
to make their own
dialogues.
2. Draw the new classroom
and talk about it.
3. Ask students to show.
1. Make a new dialogue.
2. Draw a picture of the new
classroom. Talk about it
in groups.
3. Act it out.
Cultivate and
improve students’
comprehensive
language using
ability by making the
dialogue.
Homework
1. Practice the dialogue.
2. Talk about your classroom with your partner.
3. Do the exercises.
The second period(第二课时)
Part A Let’s learn & Let’s do
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s learn
·能够听、说、认读单词“classroom, window, blackboard, light, picture, door”
·能够听、说单词“TV”
·能够在情景中熟练运用句型“—What’s in the classroom? —One blackboard…”来
问答教室中的各种物品
Let’s do
·能够听懂指令并根据指令做出正确的动作反应
·能够通过操练在情景中恰当运用“open, turn on, close, put up, clean”等动词(短
语)
·能够培养学生节约能源的意识
▶教学重点
能够理解和掌握句型“What’s in the classroom?”及重点单词“classroom, window, blackboard, light,
picture, door”。
▶教学难点
1 能够掌握句型“What’s in the classroom?”及重点单词“classroom, window, blackboard, light,
picture, door”。
2 能够在情景中熟练运用动词(短语)“open, turn on, close, put up, clean”。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2.PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、单词卡片等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
T: Hello, everyone. Welcome back to our classroom!
2. Enjoy the song—In the classroom. (出示课件)
3. Free talk.
T: What’s in the classroom?
Ss: One blackboard…
4. Lead-in.
Write down the topic “Unit 1 My classroom” on the blackboard.
Step 2: Presentation
1. Teach the word “classroom”. (课件出示:一间教室的图片)
T: What’s this?
Ss: It’s a classroom.
Teach the word “classroom” and write it down on the blackboard.
Ask students to read the word three times to help them understand the
spelling and the word formation of “classroom”.
T: class + room=classroom. cl/kl/-a/ɑː/-ss/s/-r/r/-oo/u:/-m/m/,
classroom .
Let students read it after the teacher.
Then show another picture of “classroom” on the PPT. (课件出
示:另一间教室图片,重点突出教室中物品的陈列)
T: What’s in the classroom?
Ask students to look at the picture and answer the question.
2. Teach the word “window”.
After students say out the word “window”, write it down on the
blackboard and teach it.
T: w/w/-i/I/-n/n/-d/d/-ow/ əʊ/, window .
Let students read it after the teacher.
T: Look at the window. (Point to an open window.) What can we do?
Do the action of closing the window. Write down the sentence “Close
the window.” on the blackboard and teach the word “close”.(cl/kl/-o/
əʊ/-se/z/, close .) Let students read it aloud after the
teacher with the action of closing the window.
3. Teach the word “door”. (课件出示:门的图片及单词)
T: What is this?
Ss: Door.
Write down the word “door” on the blackboard and teach it.
Emphasize that “oor” sounds / ɔ:(r)/.
Point to the word “blackboard” and tell students that “oar”
also sounds / ɔ:/ here.
Teaching purpose
通过欣赏歌曲,活跃学
习氛围,为开展新课的教学
做好铺垫。
Teaching purpose
通过呈现生活中的教室
来创设情境,引出本课的主
题。
Teaching purpose
在进行单词教学的同
时,渗透 Let’s do 板块动词
短语的教学,巧妙地将二者
合二为一。
Teaching purpose
语音是英语教学的难
点。在本课新授单词 door 和
blackboard 中都有/ /的
发音,通过拼读单词并进行
对比,加深对该音标的认识。
13
Students try to read the word “blackboard”.
Show the video of opening the door on the PPT. (课件出示:开门
的动画及短语)
T: What can we do?
Write down the sentence “Open the door.” on the blackboard and
teach the word “open”(o + pen=open). Ask students to read it with
the action of opening the door.
Show the video of closing the door, opening the window and closing
the window on the PPT. (课件出示:关门、开窗户和关窗户的动画及短语)
T: Look! What else can we do?
Get students to do the actions with the teacher and say out the
sentences.
4. Teach the word “blackboard”. (课件出示:黑板图片和对应的单
词)
Take out the word card of “blackboard”. Cover the word “board”.
Let students read “black” aloud. Then show the whole word
“blackboard”. Get students to read it. At last, write it down on the
blackboard. Show a picture of Sarah cleaning the blackboard on the PPT.
(课件出示:教材 P5 Sarah 擦黑板的图片及短语)
T: What is she doing?
Ss: She’s cleaning the blackboard.
Write down the sentence “Clean the blackboard.” on the blackboard
and teach the word “clean” (cl/kl/-ea/i:/-n/n/, clean/kli:n/). Let
students read the sentence “Clean the blackboard.” aloud after the
teacher with the action.
Show some pictures. (课件出示:首先呈现一张教室脏乱的图片,通过
点击鼠标控制,图片上的门、窗户、桌子和椅子能被打扫干净)
T: Wow! This classroom is so dirty. What can we do? I can clean
the window. You can…
S1: Clean the door.
S2: Clean the desks.
…
5. Teach the words “picture, light” in the same way.
(1)Show a picture and teach the word “picture”. (课件出示:一
幅图片及单词 picture) Write down the word “picture” on the blackboard,
and write “ture” with a red chalk.
T: “-ture” sounds /tʃə(r)/. p/p/-i/ɪ/-c/k/-ture/tʃə(r)/, picture
.
Use the phonetic knowledge to help students remember the word
better.
(2)T: Let me put up the picture on the blackboard.
Write down the sentence “Put up the picture.” on the blackboard
and ask students to read it and do the action together.
Teaching purpose
通过课件中图片和动画
的呈现,教室中实物的展示
及教师的肢体动作演示,引
出本课的动词短语教学,帮
助学生掌握并运用于实际。
Teaching purpose
在教授 picture 时,通过
呈现单词局部设疑,讲解
“-ture”在单词中的音标,
借助语音知识帮助学生更好
地记忆单词。通过对短语
turn on 的教学,结合生活实
际,培养学生节约能源的意
识。
T: Look at the two words “put” “up”. p/p/-u/ʊ/-t/t/, put/pʊt/,
u/ʌ/-p/p/, up/ʌp/.
Get students to read in the same way.
(3)Show the picture of “light” on the PPT. Then teach the word
“light”. (课件出示:灯的图片及单词)
T: l/l/-igh/aɪ/-t/t/, light/laɪt/.
Get students to read it.
(4)Turn on the light in the classroom, and teach the sentence “Turn
on the light.”
T: t/t/-ur/ɜː/-n/n/, turn/tɜːn/.
Get students to read it.
Write down the sentence “Turn on the light.” on the blackboard
and ask students to read it and do the action together.
(5)Take out the picture of “TV”.
T: What is this?
Ss: TV.
Teach the word “TV” and let students pay attention to the
pronunciation.
Lead students to say the sentence “Turn on the TV.” Tell them
to form the habit of saving energy.
6. Show a picture of “classroom”. (课件出示:一幅教室图片,教
室里有一块黑板,两盏灯,三扇窗户,许多桌子和椅子)
T: There is one blackboard, two lights, three windows, many desks
and chairs…
Help students understand the plural forms of countable nouns.
Show the corresponding exercises on the PPT.
7. Listen, read and act.
(1)Let students listen to the recording of “Let’s learn” and
read after it. (出示课件)
(2)T: We can see all these things in our classroom. What’s in Zoom
and Zip’s classroom? Let’s go and see. You can listen to the recording.
Pay attention to the pronunciation and the intonation. When we state
many things, the word “and” must be used before the last thing. We
read the things before “and” with the rising tone, and read the last
thing with the falling tone.
Play the recording again and let students listen and read it twice.
Ask students to act out the dialogue in pairs. Choose several groups
to show the dialogue in class.
Make a model:
Teaching purpose
在向学生输入本课单词
知识的基础上,通过呈现教
室图片,引导学生使用重点
句型进行语言的输出,并让
他们学会运用可数名词复数
形式进行适当的表达,辅以
习题,讲练结合。
Teaching purpose
教师播放单词部分的录
音,学生听录音跟读。引导
学生按照正确的语音、语调
朗读单词,并为后面教学环
节的展开做好准备。
15
—What’s in the classroom?
—One blackboard, one TV…
8. Play the recording of “Let’s do”. (出示课件)
Ask students to listen for the first time and get the overall
perception of the recording.
Listen again. Let students point out the correct picture in their
books and do the actions with the teacher.
Finally, ask four students to come to the platform and do the
actions.
Step 3: Practice
1. Play a game—“Loudly and quietly.”
(游戏说明:将本课的所有单词卡片背面朝上摆放在讲台上,每组选派一
名学生配合组员完成游戏。这名学生随机拿起一张卡片,读出该单词, 如果
他/她是大声读,则其他组员小声读;如果他/她是小声读,则其他组员大声
读。)
2. Look and match.
T: I have some pictures of these words. Can you look and match?
(课件出示:本课所有单词及图片)
3. Guessing game.
T: Wow! You learn so many words. Let’s play a game. Can you guess
what words they are?
Show the six words with some letters missing on the PPT. (课件
出示:本课所有单词省略几个字母,然后逐个出示并播放单词读音)
Ask students to fill in the blanks according to the recording of
these words. Help students spell the words according to the phonetic
knowledge.
For example, ind , “w” is /w/, and “ow” is / əʊ/.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Draw and say.
Let students draw the pictures of their classroom.
Ask each group to choose a student to show her/his picture in class
and say what is in the classroom in the picture.
2. Enjoy a song.
Enjoy the song—We have a new classroom. (出示课件) While listening
to the song, recall the learning content of the class.
▶板书设计
Teaching purpose
通过绘画并说一说的活
动,将本课所学的知识进行
有效的融合与输出,提高本
课的趣味性。
Teaching purpose
通过大小声读单词、单
词与图片匹配以及省略单词
部分字母,让学生补全单词
的游戏,指导学生从单词的
音、形、义三个层面理解单
词,并结合语音来记忆单词,
加深对单词音和形的掌握。
Teaching purpose
三次播放 Let’s do 板块
的录音,每次播放都有不同
的要求。由浅入深,让学生
由听懂,到掌握,再到最后
做出动作,顺利完成本课内
容由输入到输出的过程。
▶作业设计
1. Describe your classroom for your parents.
2. Copy the words “classroom, picture, blackboard, light, door, window”.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1 运用歌曲引入新课,利用图片、视频等手段创设教学情境,吸引学生的注意力,激发学生的学习兴趣,
帮助学生更直观地理解单词、短语等新内容。
2 单词、短语、句子的操练贯穿每个教学环节,在呈现方式上有图片、动画、实物、肢体语言等多种方式。
3 教授单词的过程中,适时地展开了音标教学及拼读教学,在此基础上指导并帮助学生记忆单词。
4 板书设计直观,突出重点词汇和句型,起到了很好的辅助教学的作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s learn
· Be able to listen, speak and read the words “classroom, window, blackboard, light, picture,
door”.
· Be able to listen and speak the word “TV”.
·Be able to use the sentence structures“—What’s in the classroom? —One blackboard…”skillfully
to ask and answer the objects in the classroom in situations.
Let’s do
· Be able to understand the instructions and do the actions according to instructions.
·Be able to use the verbs (phrases) “open, turn on, close, put up, clean” properly in the situation
through practice.
· Be able to cultivate students’awareness of energy conservation.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand and master the sentence structure “What’s in the classroom?” and the
key words “classroom, window, blackboard, light, picture, door”.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to master the sentence structure “What’s in the classroom?” and the key words
“classroom, window, blackboard, light, picture, door” in situations.
·Be able to use the verbs (phrases) “open, turn on, close, put up, clean” skillfully in situations.
17
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Enjoy the song—In the
classroom.
3. Free talk.
4. Lead-in.
1. Greetings.
2. Enjoy the song.
3. Review the main
sentences they have
learnt.
4. Read the topic.
Create learning
atmosphere by enjoying
the song. Quickly
review the sentences to
lead in the new lesson.
Presentation
1. Teach the word “classroom”.
Show a picture of
“classroom” on the PPT.
Teach “classroom” and write
it down on the blackboard.
Look at the picture and
learn the word
“classroom”.
2. Teach the word “window”.
Teach and write down the word
“window” on the blackboard.
Write down the sentence
“Close the window.” on the
blackboard and
teach the word “close”.
Learn the word “window”.
Learn and read the
sentence “Close the
window.” aloud with the
action of closing the
window.
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Presentation
3. Teach the word “door”.
Teach the word “door”. And
write down the word on the
blackboard.
Write down the sentence “Open
the door.” on the blackboard
and teach the word “open”.
Read and learn the word
“door”.
Learn and read the
sentence “Open the
door.” aloud with the
action of opening the
door.
Create a situation to
lead in the topic of
this lesson. The two
parts “phonetic
teaching and word
teaching, word teaching
and verb phrases
teaching” permeate
each other and
complement each other.
Use phonetic symbols to
help students remember
the words better.
4. Teach the word
“blackboard”.
Teach the word
“blackboard”. Write the
sentence “Clean the
blackboard.” on the
blackboard and teach the word
“clean”.
Read and learn the word
“blackboard”.
Learn and read the
sentence “Clean the
blackboard.” aloud with
the action.
5. Teach the word “picture,
light”.
(1)Use the phonetic knowledge to
help students remember the
word “picture” better.
(2)Write down the sentence “Put
up the picture.” on the
blackboard and ask students to
do the action together.
(3)Show the picture of “light”
on the PPT. Then teach the
word “light”.
(4)Turn on the light in the
classroom, and teach the
sentence “Turn on the
light.”
(5)Teach the word “TV” and the
sentence “Turn on the TV.”
(1)Learn and read the word
“picture”.
(2)Read the sentence “Put
up the picture.” aloud
after the teacher with
the action.
(3)Learn and read the word
“light”.
(4)Read the sentence
“Turn on the light.”
aloud after the teacher
with the action.
(5)Read the word “TV”
and the sentence “Turn
on the TV.”
Help students better
memorize the new
vocabulary and
sentences. Combine the
teaching with the
reality to cultivate
student’s
awareness of energy
saving.
19
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Presentation
6. Show a picture of
“classroom”.
Describe the classroom.
Lead students to complete
the exercises.
Complete the exercises and
understand the plural forms
of countable nouns.
Lead students to use
the key sentence
structures to
express properly.
Help them to
understand the
plural forms of
countable nouns.
Make preparations
for the
following teaching.
7. Listen, read and act.
Play the recording of
“Let’s learn”.
Listen and follow the
recording. Act out the
dialogue.
8. Play the recording of
“Let’s do”.
Listen to the recording
three times, and do the
actions.
Practice
1. Play a game—“Loudly
and quietly.” Read the words. Deepen the
understanding
of the forms and the
meanings of words.
Lead students to
memorize the words
with phonetics.
Deepen the mastery of
the sounds and the
forms of words.
2. Look and match.
Show pictures of the new
words.
Quickly match the words with
pictures.
3. Guessing game.
Show the six words with
some letters missing.
Fill in the blanks.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Draw and say. Draw a picture of the
classroom and talk in class.
The knowledge
learned in this
lesson is
effectively
integrated and
output. Through the
relaxing song, let
students recall what
they have learned in
this lesson.
2. Enjoy a song.
Listen to the song and
recall the learning content
of the class.
Homework
1. Describe your classroom for your parents.
2. Copy the words “classroom, picture, blackboard, light, door, window”.
3. Do the exercises.
The third period(第三课时)
Part A Let’s spell
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s spell
·能够感知并归纳 a-e 在单词中的发音规则,即 a-e 在单词中发长音/eI/
·能够读出符合 a-e 发音规则的单词
·能够根据单词的读音拼写出符合 a-e 发音规则的单词
▶教学重点
1 能够归纳 a-e 在单词中的发音规则,即 a-e 在单词中发长音/eɪ/。
2 能够读出符合 a-e 发音规则的单词。
▶教学难点
能够根据单词的读音拼写出符合 a-e 发音规则的单词。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2.PPT 课件、课文录音、视频等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision
1. Greetings and free talk.
2. Listen to a chant and review the sound of “/æ/”.
T: Let’s listen to a chant together.
T: Listen again. Then tell me the words you hear in the chant.
Ss: Apple./Ant./Cat./Cap.
T: They have the same letter “a” and the letter “a” sounds /æ/.
Read together.
3. Show and read some words. (课件出示:单词 dad, hat, map, bag)
Let students read the words in groups. Give a prize to the best
group.
Teaching purpose
通过相互问候和自由谈
话活动,与学生产生亲切感,
拉近彼此的距离。通过有韵
律的歌谣,将学生带入一个
轻松愉快的学习氛围中,并
且通过歌谣复习字母 a 在重
读闭音节中发短音/æ/的规
律。
21
Step 2: Presentation
1. Lead-in.
Create a situation and introduce the open syllable words with
letter “a”.
(1)Teach the words “name, Jake, face”.
Show Jake’s photo. (课件出示:Jake 的照片)
T: Look at the boy. He’s my friend. His name is Jake. /n/-/eɪ/-/m/,
name/neɪm/; /dʒ/-/ eɪ/-/k/, Jake/ dʒeɪk/.
Let students repeat the words “name, Jake” and write them down
on the blackboard.
T: He has a small face. /f/-/eɪ/-/s/, face/feɪs/.
Let students repeat the word “face” and write it down on the
blackboard.
(2)Teach the words “cake, make”.
Show a picture of a cake. (课件出示:一张蛋糕的图片)
T: Oh, what’s this? Yes, it’s a birthday cake. Jake can make a
cake. /k/-/eɪ/-/k/, cake/keɪk/; /m/-/eɪ/-/k/, make/meɪk/.
Let students repeat the words “cake, make” and write them down
on the blackboard.
(3)Teach the words “date, Dave”.
Show Dave’s photo. (课件出示:Dave 的照片)
T: Is this Jake? No, he’s Dave. Can Dave make a cake? No, he can’t.
But he likes to eat cake. Dave’s birthday is coming, so Jake will make
a cake for Dave. What’s the date of Dave’s birthday? Dave,
/d/-/eɪ/-/v/, /deɪv/; date, /d/-/eɪ/-/t/, /deɪt/.
Let students repeat the words “Dave, date” and write them down
on the blackboard.
2. Learn the pronunciation rule of “a-e”.
(1)Find the common letters.
Show the words “name, Jake, face, cake, make, date, Dave” on the
PPT. (出示课件)
Play the recording of “Read, listen and chant”. (课件出示:Read,
listen and chant 的音频)
T: Boys and girls, let’s listen to the recording. Pay attention
to the words on the PPT. What can you find?
Ss: They have the same letter “a”, and they have the same letter
“e” at the end.
(2)Learn the pronunciation of “a-e”.
T: Great! They all have “a-e”. The letter “e” at the end is
silent. Let’s read these words again. Pay attention to their
pronunciation.
T: Yes, “a-e” sounds “/eɪ/”. Look at my mouth: /eɪ/, /eɪ/, /eɪ/.
Pay attention to the letter “e”. It’s silent.
Teaching purpose
通过教材提供的歌谣创
设情景,引出单词“name,
Jake, face, cake, make, date,
Dave”,引导学生初步感知
和体验 a-e 的发音规则。
Teaching purpose
教师在教学中通过拆
音、拼音和分类等语音意识
训练活动,引导学生观察、
发现并归纳出 a-e 在单词中
的发音规则。
(3)Read after the recording.
Play the recording again. (出示课件)
Let students read after the recording and pay attention to the
pronunciation and the intonation.
Let students read the words by themselves.
(4)Try to pronounce the words.
Show more words with “a-e”.
Spell first, then let students pronounce the following words.
Step 3: Practice
1. Let’s chant.
2. Read, listen and tick.
Read the words in the book. Let students pay attention to the sounds
/æ/ and /eɪ/.
Listen to the recording and tick the right words. (课件出示:教
材 P6 Read, listen and tick 部分的音频)
Check the answers.
Answers: 1. cake 2. dad 3. hate
3. Listen, circle and write.
Listen to the recording and try to circle the right letters and
write the right words. (课件出示:教材 P6 Listen, circle and write
部分的音频)
First let students observe the pictures carefully and make
predictions. Then play the recording and let students listen, circle
and write. Let students pay attention to the handwriting.
Check the answers.
Answers: cap cake map face
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Classify the given words.
Let students read the following words and classify them according
to their pronunciations. Ask them to discuss with their partners.
Teaching purpose
通过朗朗上口的歌谣,
让学生掌握 a-e 的发音规则;
通过 Read, listen and tick 部
分的听力活动对比 a 和 a-e
的发音,训练 a 和 a-e 的音
—形对应关系;通过 Listen,
circle and write 部分的听音
写单词活动帮助学生按照发
音规则拼写单词,并辨认词
形。
Teaching purpose
通过将所给单词按读音
分类和听音填空补全短文两
个活动,巩固语音知识并检
测学生对本节课 a-e 发音及
发音规则的掌握情况。
23
Check the answers.
Answers: bag: A C D G H Kate: B E F I J K
2. I can finish the passage.
Listen to the passage and fill in the blanks. (课件出示:填空练
习题)
Check the answers. And read the passage.
Answers: My name is Kate. I can make a cake. This is my cap. It’s
in my bag. Where’s my cat? It’s on the map.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Read the chant for your family.
2. Try to find more words with “a-e” that sounds “/eɪ/”.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1 通过热身阶段的师生问好和自由谈话活动,拉近了彼此的心理距离。
2 在复习环节通过有韵律的歌谣,复习字母 a 在重读闭音节中发短音/ /的规律;在练习环节,通过相同
韵律的歌谣巩固 a-e 在开音节中发长音/eɪ/的规律,让学生在轻松愉快的氛围中复习旧知、巩固新知。
3 教师在教学中通过拆音、拼音和分类等语音意识训练活动,引导学生观察、发现并自己归纳出 a-e 在单
词中的发音规则,很好地体现了课堂教学中以学生为主体的教学理念。
4 板书设计直观,重难点一目了然,起到了辅助教学的作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s spell
· Be able to conclude and summarize the pronunciation rule of “a-e” in words.
· Be able to read the words that conform to the pronunciation rule of “a-e”.
· Be able to spell the words that conform to the pronunciation rule of “a-e”.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to summarize the pronunciation rule of “a-e” in words.
·Be able to read the words that conform to the pronunciation rule of “a-e”.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to spell the words that conform to the pronunciation rule of “a-e”.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
1. Greetings and free talk.
2. Play a chant and review the
sound of “/æ/”.
3. Show the words “dad, hat,
map, bag”. And let students
read.
1. Greetings and free
talk.
2. Listen to a chant and
review the sound of
“/æ/”.
3. Read the words in
groups.
Bring students into a
relaxing and happy
learning atmosphere
through the rhythmic
chant. Review the sound
of letter “a” in
stressed closed
syllables.
Presentation
1. Lead-in.
(1)Teach the words “name, Jake,
face”.
(2)Teach the words “cake,
make”.
(3)Teach the words “date,
Dave”.
Understand the meaning of
the words and repeat the
words.
Create a situation.
Lead students to
perceive the
pronunciation rule of
“a-e”.
25
2. Teach the pronunciation rule
of “a-e”.
(1)Show the words “name, Jake,
face, cake, make, date, Dave”
and let students find the same
letters in the words.
(2)Teach the pronunciation of
“a-e”.
(3)Play the recording.
(4)Show more words and let
students try to spell them.
(1)Listen to the recording
and find the same
letters.
(2)Learn the
pronunciation
of “a-e”.
(3)Read after the
recording.
Read the words by
themselves.
(4)Try to spell more words
with “a-e”.
Lead students to
observe, discover and
summarize the
pronunciation rule of
“a-e” in words.
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Practice
1. Play a chant.
2. Read, listen and tick.
Let students pay attention
to the sounds /æ/ and /eɪ/.
Play the recording.
Check the answers.
3. Listen, circle and
write.
Let students observe the
pictures carefully and
make predictions. Then
play the recording.
Check the answers.
1. Let’s chant.
Practice the sound of
/eɪ/.
2. Listen to the recording
and tick the right words.
3. Listen to the recording
and try to circle the
right letters and write
the right words.
Consolidate the
pronunciation of “a-e”
through various
exercises. Help students
recognize the word form
and spell the word
according to the
pronunciation rule.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Classify the given
words.
Check the answers.
2. Finish the passage.
Show the exercise and let
students fill in the
blanks.
Check the answers.
1. Read the following words
and classify them
according to their
pronunciation. Discuss
with the partners and
record the results.
2. Listen to the passage and
fill in the blanks.
Read the passage.
Improve students’ speech
recognition ability.
Homework
1. Read the chant for your family.
2. Try to find more words with “a-e” that sounds “/eɪ/”.
3. Do the exercises.
The fourth period(第四课时)
Part B Let’s talk & Let’s play
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s talk
·能够在图片、PPT 和老师的帮助下理解对话大意
·能够按照正确的语音、语调朗读对话,并能够在小组中进行角色扮演
·能够在情景中恰当运用句型“Let’s…”“Let me…”提出行动建议并做出正确反应
·能够在语境中理解新词“teacher’s desk, clean, help”的意思,并能够正确发音
Let’s play ·通过该板块提供的教学活动,巩固并操练本课时的重要句型“Let’s…”“Let me…”
▶教学重点
1 能够按照正确的语音、语调朗读对话,并能够在小组中进行角色扮演。
2 能够在情景中恰当运用句型“Let’s…” “Let me…”提出行动建议并做出正确反应。
▶教学难点
能够在情景中熟练运用句型“Let’s…” “Let me…”提出行动建议并做出正确反应。
▶教学准备
1. 预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、骰子等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision & Lead-in
Teaching purpose
在热身阶段,通过 TPR
活动,将学生所有感官调动
起来,全身心地投入到英语
学习中,同时将本课的重点
句型“Let’s…”作为指令,
27
1. Greetings and sing an English song—We have a new classroom.
(课件出示:教材 P10 Let’s sing 板块的歌曲音频)
2. Do the TPR action.
T: First, let’s do some actions together. I say, you do and then
repeat. Let’s stand up!
T: Wonderful! Are you happy now? Good. Sit down, please!
3. Revision and lead-in.
Show the second picture of “Let’s talk” in Part A on the PPT.
(出示课件) Point to different objects. Lead students to review the
words in Part A: classroom, blackboard, light, picture, door. Then lead
in the new phrase: teacher’s desk.
Step 2: Presentation
1. Teach the phrase “teacher’s desk” and the word “clean”.
T: (Point to a student’s desk.) That’s your desk.
T: (Point to the teacher’s desk.) I’m a teacher. And this is my
desk. This is the teacher’s desk.
Read it like this: teacher—teacher’s—teacher’s desk. Let
students read the phrase in groups, read by boys and girls, read one
by one and so on.
Show a picture of a dirty teacher’s desk on the PPT. (课件出示:
一张脏的讲台图片)
T: What’s this?
Ss: It’s a teacher’s desk.
T: Yes, but it is dirty. Let’s clean the teacher’s desk.
Take out the rag and do the action of wiping the teacher’s desk
to help students understand the meaning of the word “clean”.
Students practice the phrases: clean the teacher’s desk/windows/
blackboard /door. (Practice through these ways: say in unison, rush
to answer, say in groups, say one by one and so on.)
2. Teach the sentence structures “Let’s…”“Let me…”
Look around the classroom and say, “Our classroom is messy. Let’s
clean the classroom and give other teachers a surprise. OK?”
Write down the sentence structure “Let’s…” on the blackboard
and teach it.
Point to S1 and S2 and say, “Let’s clean the desks and chairs,
S1, S2.”
Teaching purpose
教师首先利用肢体语
言、抹布等道具创设情境引
入并帮助学生理解、学习
Let’s talk 对话中出现的新短
语“teacher’s desk”和单词
“ clean ”, 以 及 动 词 短 语
“ clean the teacher’s
desk/classroom/windows/blac
kboard/door”。
Teaching purpose
在创设的真实语言情境
中,利用肢体语言,帮助学
生理解并使用句型“Let’
s/Let me clean the…”“Let
me help you.”。
T: For two, three or many people, we can use “Let’s…” Teach
“let’s=let us”.
Ask students to read the sentence “Let’s clean the classroom.”
Ask a row of students to read the sentence one by one and check
if they can read it correctly.
T: The blackboard is dirty. I can clean it by myself. Let me clean
the blackboard.
Write down the sentence structure “Let me…” on the blackboard
and teach it.
T: For only one person, we can say “Let me…” “Let him…” or
“Let her…”
Ask students to read the sentence “Let me clean the blackboard.”
twice.
T: Who wants to clean the teacher’s desk/windows/blackboard/
door…?
Let some students practice the sentences “Let me clean the
teacher’s desk/windows/blackboard/door…”
3. Teach the word “help”.
Take out another rag and say to S2, “Let me help you.” Clean the
windows and say to students, “So many windows, who can help us?”
Repeat the word “help” and teach it.
Ss: Let me help you. Several students join in. The teacher says
“Thank you.” to the students.
T: Thank you, good boys and girls. The windows are clean now. Our
classroom is clean, too. Go back to your seat! I think other teachers
will be very happy!
4. Teach the dialogue of “Let’s talk”.
(1)Let students have a preliminary understanding of the dialogue.
Show the pictures of “Let’s talk”. (课件出示:教材 P7 Let’s talk
板块的图片)
T: Look! Who can you see in the pictures?
S1: Wu Yifan and his classmates./Wu Yifan, Mike, John and Zhang
Peng.
T: Right. Where are they?
S2: They are in the classroom.
T: Good! What are they doing in the classroom?
Ss: They are cleaning the classroom.
(2)Show some questions and make students understand the dialogue.
Play the recording. (课件出示:教材 P7 Let’s talk 板块的音频)
Teaching purpose
通过对图片的观察和简
单的问答,引导学生初步预
测对话内容,进一步感知整
个对话的语境,培养学生的
观察能力和逻辑推理能力。
29
(3)Listen to the recording again and answer the questions.
(4)Check the answers.
Step 3: Practice
1. Listen again and repeat.
Play the recording again. (出示课件) And ask students to repeat
after it.
2. Practice the dialogue in pairs or in groups.
Let students read the dialogue in pairs or in groups.
3. Read the dialogue in different roles.
T: Let’s read the dialogue in roles. Group 1 is Wu Yifan. Group
2 is John. Group 3 is Mike. Group 4 is Zhang Peng.
T: Now read the dialogue in groups of four. Then act it out. I will
reward the best group.
4. Play a game.
Show the pictures. (课件出示:快速显示打扫教室、擦窗户、擦桌椅、
擦黑板、擦讲台、擦门等图片) Ask students to say a sentence with the
sentence structures “Let’s…” or “Let me…” as quickly as they
can.
5. Let’s play.
Take out the dice prepared before class and play with students.
(游戏说明:教师在课前按照教材中的示意图制作一个大的六面体骰子,
出示骰子并投掷一次,按照投掷结果说句子“Let me…”“Let’s…”,然
后请学生掷骰子说句子。再进行小组活动,最后小组展示。)
T: Let’s clean the classroom. Throw the dice like this. OK. Let
me…
S1: (Throw the dice.) Let me…
T: Boys and girls, are you clear? Play with your partners now.
Let some groups show in class.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Create a new dialogue.
Show a picture of a messy house. (课件出示:一张凌乱的房屋图片)
T: Grandma Wang is ill. Her house is messy. Can we help her?
Ss: Yes, we can. We can help her clean the house.
Teaching purpose
学生听录音跟读,教师
引导学生按照正确的语音、
语调及意群朗读对话。再通
过分角色读课文,让学生熟
悉对话内容及结构,为后面
环节的自主交流做好铺垫。
Teaching purpose
通过 Let’s play 让学生
能熟练运用句型。先由教师
示范,让学生明白游戏规则
及方法,再进行小组活动,
最后小组展示,检查操练效
果。
Teaching purpose
在拓展环节,把学生分
成若干个小组,通过创设贴
近生活的语言情境,让学生
用本课所学词汇及句型新编
一个对话,进行工作分工,
提高学生的语篇输出能力,
T: OK. Please work in groups of four and make a dialogue.
Let students make their dialogues in groups.
2. Show time.
Prepare some rags. Let several groups show in class.
3. Give some presents to the performers.
4. Sum up.
T: Grandma Wang is happy now. I’m also very happy that you’re
helpful at school. I think you’re helpful at home, too. Please help
your parents at home!
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Practice the dialogue.
2. Help your parents at home.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1 通过创设各种情境,营造民主、和谐的教学气氛,引导和鼓励学生使用英语。
2 在特定的语境中引入新单词,不但让学生觉得有趣,还有利于加深学生对单词的理解。
3 在教学中遵循了“词不离句,句不离景”的教学规律。
4 在教学过程中要时刻关注后进生和性格内向的孩子,尽可能为他们提供展示自我的机会。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
31
Let’s talk
· Be able to understand the main idea of the dialogue with the help of the pictures, PPT and the
teacher.
· Be able to read the dialogue with the correct pronunciation and intonation, and be able to act
out in groups.
·Be able to use the sentence structures “Let’s…”“Let me…” properly to offer action suggestions
and make correct response in situations.
·Be able to understand and read the new phrase and words “teacher’s desk, clean, help” in context.
Let’s play
·Consolidate and practice the key sentence structures “Let’s…”“Let me…” of this period.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to use the sentence structures “Let’s…”“Let me…” skillfully to offer action
suggestions and make correct response in real situations.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the sentence structures “Let’s…” “Let me…” skillfully to offer action
suggestions and make correct response in real situations.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings and sing an English
song—We have a new classroom.
2. Do the TPR action.
3. Revision and lead-in.
Show the second picture of
“Let’s talk” in Part A.
Then lead in the new phrase.
1. Greetings and sing the
English song.
2. Do the TPR action with
the teacher. Review the
words in Part A.
3. Look at the picture and
review the words in Part
A.
Review the words that
students have learned
and lead in the key
sentence structure to
prepare for the new
lesson.
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Presentation
1. Teach the phrase
“teacher’s desk” and
the word “clean”. Help
students understand the
meaning of the word
“clean” with the
action.
Learn the phrase “teacher’s
desk” and the word “clean”.
Practice the phrases “clean
the teacher’s desk/ windows/
blackboard/door”.
Create situations and
make students
understand the new
words and sentence
structures by body
language and other
teaching appliances.
Then make students
understand the dialogue
by answering some
questions.
2. Teach the sentence
structures “Let’s…”
“Let me…”
Teach the sentence
structures by creating a
situation and doing
actions.
Learn the sentence structures.
Practice the sentences and use
the sentence structures in the
situation.
3. Teach the word “help”
by creating a situation
and doing actions.
Understand the meaning of
“help”. Use the sentence
“Let me help you.” in the
situation.
4. Teach the dialogue of
“Let’s talk”.
(1)Show the pictures and
talk about them.
(2)Show some questions and
let students understand
the dialogue. Play the
recording.
(3)Play the recording
again.
(4)Check the answers.
Have a preliminary
understanding of the dialogue
by answering some simple
questions. Listen to the
recording twice and understand
the dialogue deeply by
thinking about the questions.
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
33
Practice
1. Play the recording again
and let students repeat.
2. Let students practice
the dialogue in pairs or
in groups.
3. Let students read the
dialogue in different
roles.
4. Play a game.
Show the pictures on the
PPT and let students use
“Let’s…” or “Let
me…” to say a sentence
as quickly as they can.
5. Let’s play.
1. Listen to the recording
and repeat.
2. Practice the dialogue in
pairs or in groups.
3. Read in roles.
4. Look at the pictures and
use the sentence
structures to say a
sentence quickly.
5. Throw the dice and say the
sentence in groups.
Make students master the
key words and sentence
structures of this lesson
better by giving students
enough time to practice in
class. Lead students to
use the key words and
sentence structures
through various
exercises, so as to pave
the way for the later
independent
communication.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Create a new dialogue.
Create a situation:
Grandma Wang is ill. Her
house is messy. Can we
help her?
2. Show time.
3. Give some presents to the
performers.
4. Sum up.
1. Work in groups of four and
make a dialogue.
2. Show in class.
Help students use the new
words and sentence
structures properly in the
situation. Improve
students’ discourse
output ability.
Homework
1. Practice the dialogue.
2. Help your parents at home.
3. Do the exercises.
The fifth period(第五课时)
Part B Let’s learn & Colour and say
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s learn ·能够听、说、认读单词和短语“teacher’s desk, computer, fan, wall, floor”
·能够熟练描述教室中各种物品的颜色
Colour and say ·通过完成为教室涂色并作口头表达的活动,帮助学生更好地理解词汇含义,并为学生提
供运用词汇个性化表达的机会
▶教学重点
1.能够听、说、认读单词和短语“teacher’s desk, computer, fan, wall, floor”。
2.能够熟练描述教室中各种物品的颜色。
▶教学难点
在描述教室中物品的颜色时,能够正确使用名词单复数进行表达。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2.PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、单词卡片、贴纸等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision & Lead-in
1. Greetings and sing the song—We have a new classroom. (课件
出示:教材 P10 Let’s sing 板块的歌曲音频)
2. Do and say.
The teacher says and students do and repeat.
T: Wonderful! You are very helpful!
3. Lead-in.
Show the pictures of Zoom and Zip. (课件出示:Zoom 和 Zip 的头像)
T: Zoom and Zip have a new classroom. They will go and have a look.
Let’s go with them!
Ss: Great!
Show the picture of the classroom in “Let’s learn”. (课件出
示:教材 P8 Let’s learn 板块的教室图片)
T: Wow! Their classroom is so nice. It’s new. This is the new
classroom.
Write down the sentence “This is the new classroom.” on the
blackboard. Teach the sentence. Then let students read it one by one.
Step 2: Presentation
T: OK. Let’s look at Zoom and Zip’s new classroom. What’s in
the classroom? What colour is it/are they?
Teaching purpose
学生的说唱活动以之前
学过的指令性祈使句为内
容,用有韵律的节奏调动学
生所有感官参与活动,让学
生快速进入英语学习的状
态,同时为下一步的学习提
供知识储备。
Teaching purpose
改变以往单词卡或单一
图片呈现单词的方式,让学
生在场景中学习新单词,不
但可以引起学生的学习兴
趣,还能使学生感受物品的
含义,并形成一个小语境,
更有利于学生理解和掌握词
汇。
35
Talk with students to review the names and colours of the objects
in the classroom.
Pay attention to the plural forms of nouns, such as “lights”:
There are four lights.
1. Teach the new word “computer” and the new phrase “teacher’s
desk”.
T: Please find something in the picture of the classroom! It’s
black. It’s near the blackboard. Come on, boys and girls! Point to
it! Who is the first?
S1: (Point to the computer.)…
T: Good! You find it. You are the first. It’s a computer. Repeat
“computer”. ( 课 件出 示: 教 材 P8 Let’s learn 板 块中 的电 脑图 及
computer 的相关内容)
Teach the word “computer” syllable by syllable: /kəm/-/pju:/
-/tə(r)/, .
T: What colour is the computer?
S1: It’s black.
T: Yes. We can say “The computer is…”
S2: The computer is black.
T: Good job! The computer is black.
Write down the sentence “The computer is black.” on the
blackboard.
(课件出示:白色电脑图、红色电脑图、蓝色电脑图等)
T: What colour is the computer?
Let some students answer the question with the sentence structure
“The computer is…”
T: Look at our classroom. Where is the computer in our classroom?
Ss: It’s on the teacher’s desk.
(课件出示:教材 P8 Let’s learn 板块中的讲台图及 teacher’s desk
的相关内容)
Teach the new phrase (teacher—teacher’s—teacher’s desk).
T: What colour is the teacher’s desk in the picture?
S1: It’s yellow. The teacher’s desk is yellow.
T: What colour is the teacher’s desk in our classroom?
S2: It’s… The teacher’s desk is…
2. Teach the new word “fan”.
T: I feel hot. What can make me cool? Can you find it in the
classroom?
Students point to the fan and answer.
T: Good! It’s a fan. (课件出示:教材 P8 Let’s learn 板块中的风
扇图及 fan 的相关内容)
Read the word: Fan, /f/-/æ/-/n/, /fæn/.
T: What colour is the fan in the picture?
S1: The fan is blue.
T: What colour is the fan in our classroom?
S2: It’s…
Show the pictures of fans in different colours. (出示课件) Lead
students to describe them with the sentence structure “The fan is…”
3. Teach the new word “wall”.
T: Look at Zoom and Zip’s new classroom. Where is the fan?
Students point to the fan and say, “There it is!”
T: Yes, it’s on the wall.
Teach the word “wall”. (课件出示:教材 P8 Let’s learn 板块中的
墙壁图及 wall 的相关内容)
Teach the pronunciation of the word “wall” with the words “all,
tall, small”.
T: Look at our classroom. What colour is the wall?
Ss: It’s white.
T: Look at Zoom and Zip’s new classroom. What colour is the wall?
S1: It’s white and blue.
4. Teach the new word “floor”.
Point to the floor and ask a question.
T: Is our floor white, too?
Ss: No, it’s yellow.
T: Good. The floor is yellow.
Teach the word “floor”. (课件出示:教材 P8 Let’s learn 板块中
的地板图及 floor 的相关内容)
Teach the pronunciation of the word “floor” with the word
“door” and read the word “floor”.
T: The floor is yellow in our classroom. What colour is the floor
of Zoom and Zip’s classroom?
S1: The floor is green.
5. Listen to the recording, read and act.
Play the recording. (课件出示:教材 P8 Let’s learn 板块的音频) Let
students listen to the recording and read after it. Remind students
to pay attention to the pronunciation and the intonation.
Ask students to act out the sentences in pairs.
Make a demonstration:
This is the new classroom. The door is orange. The computer is
black.
Then let students act out the sentences in pairs and show in class.
Practice the sentence structures “This is the new classroom.
The…is/are…”
Step 3: Practice
1. Talk about the classroom.
Teaching purpose
教师播放 Let’s learn 板
块的录音,学生听录音跟读。
引导学生按照正确的语音、
语调朗读单词或短语,并能
运用本节课所学的句型描述
教室里物品的颜色。
37
Ask students to fill in the blanks according to the picture. (课
件出示:教材 P8 Let’s learn 板块的图片)
Let students discuss in groups. Choose one student from each group
and show in class.
Check the answers.
Answers: door; floor; wall; fan; lights; teacher’s desk; computer
2. Play some games.
T: Now let’s play some games. If you do a good job, you can get
a sticker. Come on!
(1)Guessing words.
Take out the word cards of the objects in the classroom. Select
a card randomly from them and ask students to guess what it is.
(2)Watch, think and guess.
(课件出示:电脑图片)
T: Now, look, what’s this? We can see a part of the picture. Please
guess.
S1: Is it a TV?
T: No, it isn’t.
S2: It’s a computer.
T: Good job! You’re right. A sticker for you! Let’s go on.
…
(3)Make up the words.
Present the letters that can make up the words in random order.
(课件出示:几组被打乱字母的单词:1. alwl2. olfro3. eptocmru4. skde5.
anf ) Ask students to guess the words.
T: Look at these letters. Put the letters in correct order and we
can see the words. What are they?
T: Write down the words in your exercise book. Let’s go! Who is
the fastest? Come on!
Check the answers. Give out the stickers to the winner.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Colour and say.
Show the picture of “Colour and say”. (课件出示:教材 P8 Colour
and say 板块的图片)
T: This is a new classroom. It doesn’t have colours. Please colour
it and then say something about it. (课件出示:涂上颜色的教室图片)
Teaching purpose
通过短文填空练习来检
查 学 生 对 本 课 重 点 句 型
“The door is orange.”“The
lights are green.”以及名词单
复数的掌握情况。
Teaching purpose
通过“Guessing words”
这个游戏,让学生在一定范
围内猜测物品,不但可以复
习之前所学单词,也可以检
测学生是否会说本课新单
词,以此提高学生的参与兴
趣,活跃课堂气氛,激励学
生开口表达。
Teaching purpose
通 过 “ Make up the
words”这个游戏检测学生对
单词字形的把握程度,激发
学生的学习兴趣和参与的积
极性,同时达到可以听说、
认读新学单词的目的。
Teaching purpose
通过给无色彩的教室涂
色和画一个教室并涂色这两
个活动激发学生的创造力。
同时,使学生掌握如何将颜
色与物品联系起来进行表
达,让学生在应用中熟练掌
握所学单词,达到学以致用
的目的。
Ask students to colour the classroom in the book by themselves and
describe it as the demonstration.
2. Draw your dream classroom.
Divide students into several groups. Draw a classroom together and
colour it.
Choose one student from each group to introduce his/her classroom
in class.
3. Make the evaluation.
Choose the best group and give an award.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Copy the vocabulary “teacher’s desk, computer, fan, wall, floor”.
2. Talk about your room with your parents.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1 在学习新单词时以旧引新,利用 PPT 创设教学情境,不但能抓住学生的眼球,激发学生的学习兴趣,更
能直观地理解生词等新内容。
2 在教学过程中始终遵循“词不离句”的教学规律。
3 在教授新单词时,通过拆音等语音意识训练活动,让学生注意到单词的音节,能快速记忆单词。
4 在巩固拓展阶段,通过给无色彩的教室涂色和画一个教室并涂色这两个活动,激发学生的创造力,同时
让学生熟练应用所学单词进行表达,达到学以致用的目的。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s learn
· Be able to listen, speak and read the vocabulary “teacher’s desk, computer, fan, wall, floor.”
· Be able to describe the colours of various objects in the classroom adroitly.
Colour and say
39
·By finishing the activity of colouring and making oral expression, help students better understand
the meaning of the key vocabulary and provide students with the opportunity of personalized
expression.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to listen, speak and read the vocabulary “teacher’s desk, computer, fan, wall, floor”.
·Be able to describe the colours of various objects in the classroom adroitly.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the singular and plural forms of nouns correctly when describing the colours of
the objects in the classroom.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings and sing the song.
2. Do and say.
3. Lead-in.
1. Greetings and sing the
song.
2. Review the words.
3. Learn to describe
something in the
classroom.
Review the words they
have learned by a chant.
Lead students to
quickly enter the state
of English learning.
Presentation
Talk with students about some
objects in Zoom and Zip’s new
classroom.
Review the names and
colours of the objects in
the classroom.
Let students learn new
words in the scene
instead of presenting
words with word cards or
single pictures. Arouse
students’ interest in
learning. Make students
feel the meaning of the
objects. Help students
understand and master
the vocabulary.
1. Teach the new word
“computer” and the new
phrase “teacher’s desk”.
Describe something in the
classroom and let students
guess.
Learn the new word
“computer” and the new
phrase “teacher’s
desk”.
Guess and describe the
colour.
2. Teach the new word “fan”.
Learn the new word
“fan”.
Guess and describe the
colour.
3. Teach the new word “wall”.
Let students find where the fan
is in the classroom and teach
the word “wall”.
Find where the fan is and
learn the word “wall”.
4. Teach the new word “floor”.
Point to the floor and ask a
question.
Learn the new word
“floor” and describe its
colour.
5. Play the recording. Listen to the recording,
read and act out.
41
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Practice
1. Talk about the
classroom.
Present the picture of
“Let’s learn” and a
short essay. Let students
fill in the blanks.
Check the answers.
Complete the short essay.
Practice the sentences in
groups.
Show in class.
The exercise of
filling in the blanks
is used to check the
key sentence
structures of this
lesson.
2. Play some games.
(1)Guessing words.
(2)Watch, think and guess.
(3)Make up the words.
(1)Guess the words of the
objects in the classroom.
(2)Observe a part of a
picture and guess what it
is.
(3)Write down the words in
correct order.
Stimulate students’
interest in
learning. Improve
students’
enthusiasm for
participation.
Achieve the purpose
of listening,
speaking and reading
new words.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Colour and say.
Present the picture of
“Colour and say”.
Provide a demonstration
for students.
2. Draw your dream
classroom.
Let students draw a
classroom together in
groups and colour it.
3. Make the evaluation.
1. Colour the picture and
say something about it
with the key sentence
structures.
2. Draw and colour a
classroom together in
groups and introduce it.
3. Choose the best group and
give an award.
Stimulate students’
creativity and let
them know how to
associate colour
with objects to
express. Meanwhile,
lead students to
master the new
knowledge skillfully
in application, so as
to achieve the
teaching purpose.
Homework
1. Copy the vocabulary “teacher’s desk, computer, fan, wall, floor”.
2. Talk about your room with your parents.
3. Do the exercises.
The sixth period(第六课时)
Part B Read and write & Let’s check & Let’s sing
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Read and write
·能够读懂四组句子并完成判断正误的读后任务
·能够按意群和正确的语音、语调朗读四组句子
·能够在有意义的语境中抄写本单元的话题词汇并将句子填充完整
·能够综合运用本单元的核心词句
Let’s check
·能够熟练地听、说本单元 A、B 部分的核心句型
·能够听、说、认读本单元的核心词汇
·能够从图片信息中推测考查点,做到有意识地去听录音,听后完成判断任务
Let’s sing ·能够了解歌词意义,并能够清晰、准确地歌唱。
▶教学重点
1.能够按意群和正确的语音、语调朗读四组句子。
2.能够熟练地运用方位介词,并能够看图判断句子的正误。
3.能够在有意义的语境中抄写本单元的话题词汇并将句子填充完整。
▶教学难点
能够综合利用本单元的核心词汇进行替换并练习核心句型“—Where is…?—It is in/on/ under/ near
the…”。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2.PPT 课件、课文录音、视频材料、单词卡片等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Sing the song—We have a new classroom. (课件出示:教材 P10
Let’s sing 板块的歌曲音频)
3. Play a game—“What’s missing?” (出示课件)
Review the vocabulary “classroom, window, blackboard, light,
picture, door, teacher’s desk, computer, fan, wall, floor”.
4. Look and circle. (课件出示:教材 P10 Look and circle 部分中的
教室图片及内容)
T: Look at the picture. What’s in the classroom? Please read and
circle.
Check the answer.
Answer: BT: Text A is different from the picture. What’s the
difference? Let’s read Text A, then find the difference.
5. Lead-in.
Look and say. (课件出示:几组图片:1. 先呈现红钢笔,再呈现它在桌
子上;2. 先呈现一本绿色的书,再呈现它在书包里;3. 先呈现一把黄色的
椅子,再呈现它在课桌旁边;4. 先呈现一只黑色的猫,再呈现它在椅子下面)
T: Look! What’s this?
Teaching purpose
通过唱歌复习旧知识,
为新课学习营造轻松愉快的
氛围。
Teaching purpose
通过游戏和观察图片,
让学生复习已经学过的词
汇,为新课的学习做好知识
铺垫。
Teaching purpose
通过看图片以及问答的
方式让学生们回顾颜色单词
和方位介词,为下一步的阅
读做好铺垫。
43
S1: A pen.
T: What colour?
S1: Red.
T: Where’s the red pen?
S2: It’s on the desk.
…
Step 2: Presentation
1. Pre-reading.
Look and say: What’s in Zhang Peng’s classroom?
T: Now look at the PPT. (课件出示: 教材 P9 Read and tick or cross
的图片) This is Zhang Peng’s classroom. What’s in it?
S1: A green book, a yellow book, a green bag, a kite, a picture,
a blue pencil box…
2. While-reading.
(1)Ask and answer.
T: There are many things in Zhang Peng’s classroom. Now look at
the PPT, then answer the questions.
Q: Where is the green book?/Where is the kite?/Where is the
picture?/
Where is the blue pencil box?
Lead students to answer.
Ss: It is on the teacher’s desk./It is near the window./It is on
the desk./It is on the floor.
(2)Read and tick or cross. (课件出示:教材 P9 Read and tick or cross
中的相关内容,并呈现阅读提示 Tips: Read, find and circle the key words)
Read the four pairs of sentences carefully. Find and circle the
key words. Ask students to finish the task in the book.
(3)Check the answers together.
Answers: × √ × √
(4)Listen and read aloud.
Play the recording. Ask students to read after it correctly. Pay
attention to the pronunciation and the intonation.
(5)Who will be the reading star?
Choose some students to read the sentences. The student who reads
best will be the reading star.
3. Post-reading.
(1)Show the picture of “Look, choose and write”. (课件出示:教
材 P9 Look, choose and write 部分的图片) Ask students to say the things
in it.
Ss: A window, a desk, a chair, a picture, a bag, a computer and
a newspaper…
Teaching purpose
根据图片或话题预测文
本大意和潜在的词汇,活跃
学生的思维。
Teaching purpose
通过细读环节,初步培
养学生自主阅读来获取信息
和处理信息的能力,进而提
升学生的阅读技巧,让学生
比较扎实地掌握所学知识。
通过评比来提高学生对朗读
的兴趣,让学生从能读、会读
到规范、优美地朗读。
Lead students to ask and answer the questions with the sentence
structures “—Where is the bag/the newspaper/the computer/…? —It’s
in/under/near the…”
(2)Write down the words.
Write down the words to finish the sentences according to the
picture.
T: Pay attention to the spelling of the words. When we write
sentences, we should pay attention to capitalizing the first letter
and punctuation marks.
Answers: desk; chair; window
Step 3: Practice
1. Talk about our own classroom in groups of four.
T: Is the study clean or messy?
Ss: Messy.
T: Do you like the study?
Ss: No.
T: We all like clean and tidy places. So we should keep our classroom
clean and tidy. Look! This is our own classroom. Now talk about our
own classroom with your partners. You can use the sentence structures
“—Where is the…? —It is in/on/under/near the…”
Let students practice in groups and act out in class.
Then ask students to finish the sentences in the book.
Let students show the sentences.
2. Listen and tick or cross. (课件出示:教材 P10 Listen and tick
or cross 部分的相关内容)
T: Look at these pictures. The pictures are all about the classroom.
Let’s look at Picture 1. Who are in the classroom?
Ss: Chen Jie and Mike.
T: What are they doing?
Ss: Mike is cleaning the blackboard and Chen Jie is cleaning the
desks.
T: Good! They are cleaning the classroom. Now, look at Picture 2.
What can you see in this classroom? Ss: A blackboard, a teacher’s desk
and some desks and chairs.
T: Good job! What colour are the walls/the desks? What colour is
the floor/the blackboard?
Ss: …
T: This is the last picture. What’s in it?
Teaching purpose
通过联系实际的练习,
提高学生对本课句型的运用
能力。
Teaching purpose
在学生完成听力练习之
前,先引导他们观察题目中
的图片,获取信息。再去听
音判断,以帮助他们养成在
完成听力题目之前做好信息
储备的习惯。同时,这个活
动也帮助学生回忆本单元的
重点句型。
45
Ss: A fan and a window.
T: Where is the fan?
Ss: It’s near the window.
T: Now listen to the recording. Then tick or cross.
T: Show me your answers, please.
Answers: √ × √
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
Write about your dream classroom.
T: What’s your dream classroom like? Clean or messy? Please draw
a picture of your dream classroom. And describe your classroom with
the sentence structures “—Where is the…? —It is in/on/under/near
the…”. Please write them correctly in your exercise book.
Practice in groups. Choose the best one in each group, then let
him/her show in class.
T: Your dream classroom is clean and tidy. I like it. How to make
our classroom become our dream classroom?
Ss: Keep our classroom tidy and clean! Make our classroom
beautiful!
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Practice the sentences.
2. Write about your room with the sentence structures “—Where is the…? —It is in/on/under/near
the…”
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1 运用歌曲、游戏等手段复习本单元的单词,吸引学生的注意力,激发学生的学习兴趣,使复习效果事半
功倍,再通过听听力进一步复习已学单词句型,为下一步的阅读做好铺垫,让学生们能轻松地进入阅读。
2 在阅读这部分,从直观地看,到说,再到读,最后通过比赛的方式,让学生们对这一部分内容烂熟于心,这样
语言输入就完成了,再通过练习和拓展,完成了语言输出的过程。
3 学生在四线三格内书写单词和句子的时候,教师要适时地给予指导。
Teaching purpose
给学生自由想象的空
间,真正把语言做到活学、
活用之后,再运用到写作之
中,这是一个从输入到输出
的过程,提高学生的写作水
平和语言组织能力。
4 板书设计直观,突出重点单词和句型,起到了很好的辅助教学的作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Read and write
· Be able to read and understand four pairs of sentences and complete the post-reading task of
judging.
· Be able to read four pairs of sentences according to the correct pronunciation and intonation.
· Be able to copy the topic vocabulary of this unit and complete the sentences in the meaningful
context.
· Be able to use the key vocabulary and sentences of this unit synthetically.
Let’s check
·Be able to listen and speak the key sentence structures of this unit skillfully.
·Be able to listen, speak and read the key vocabulary of this unit.
·Be able to infer the examination points from the picture information, listen to the recording
consciously, and complete the judgement task after listening.
Let’s sing
·Be able to understand the meaning of the lyrics and sing clearly and accurately.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to read four pairs of sentences according to the correct pronunciation and intonation.
·Be able to use position prepositions skillfully and look at the picture to judge the correctness
or falseness of sentences.
·Be able to copy the topic words of this unit and complete the sentences in a meaningful context.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to replace the key vocabulary of this unit synthetically to practice the key sentence
structures “—Where is…? —It is in/on/under/near the…”
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Play the song.
3. Play a game.
4. Look and circle.
Show a picture and lead
students to understand the
picture.
5. Lead-in.
Show some pictures and ask
some questions.
1. Greetings.
2. Sing the song—We have
a new classroom.
3. Look at the PPT and say
the missing words.
4. Look at the PPT. Choose
the right answer.
5. Look at the PPT and say.
Review the vocabulary
and sentence structures
that students have
learned. Create a
relaxing and happy
atmosphere. Prepare for
the new lesson.
47
Presentation
1. Pre-reading.
Look and say.
Show Zhang Peng’s classroom,
and ask a question.
1. Look at the pictures.
And answer the question.
Activate students’
thinking by predicting
the main content and
possible vocabulary of
the text according to
pictures or topics.
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Presentation
2. While-reading.
(1)Ask some questions.
(2)Read and tick or cross.
Read the passage carefully.
Find and circle the key words.
(3)Check the answers.
(4)Listen and read aloud.
Play the recording. Ask
students to read after it
correctly.
(5)Select the reading star.
(1)Answer the questions.
(2)Read, find and circle the
key words. Finish the task
in the book.
(3)Check the answers.
(4)Listen and read aloud.
(5)Read the sentences.
Cultivate
students’ ability
of obtaining and
processing
information.
Improve students’
reading skills.
Consolidate the
knowledge that
students have
learned. Improve
students’ writing
ability.
3. Post-reading.
(1)Show the picture of the study
and ask students to say the
things in it.
(2)Ask students to write down the
words and finish the sentences.
(1)Look at the picture, and
answer the questions.
(2)Write the words “desk,
chair, window” in four
lines and three grids.
Practice
1. Let students talk about their
classroom in groups of four.
Talk about their classroom.
Work in groups.
Enhance students’
ability to use the
key sentence
structures by
working in groups
and listening
training.
2. Listen and tick or cross.
(1)Show the pictures on the PPT.
(2)Play the recording of “Listen
and tick or cross”.
Listen to the recording.
Then tick or cross.
Consolidation
&
Extension
Write about your dream classroom.
Let students draw and describe
their dream classrooms.
Choose the best one in each group,
then let him/her show in class.
Draw their dream classrooms.
Describe them with the key
sentence structures. Then
write them in their exercise
books. Practice in groups.
Improve students’
ability of
imagination and
writing. Achieve
the purpose of using
the language
flexibly.
Develop students’
emotional attitudes
and values.
Homework
1. Practice the sentences.
2. Write about your room with the sentence structures “—Where is the…? —It is
in/on/under/near the…”
3. Do the exercises.
49
Unit 2 My schoolbag
教材分析
本单元学习的主题是描述书包的颜色并说出书包里的教材及其他物品名称。教学内容主要
通过展示学生们的新书包、教材及文具物品,以及通过张鹏在失物招领处寻找丢失的书包的情
景,呈现本单元要学习的核心词汇和句型。教学重点是能够听、说、认读核心句型“—What’s
in your schoolbag? —An English book…”“—What colour is it? —It’s…”;能够听、
说、认读单词和短语“schoolbag, maths book, English book, Chinese book, storybook, candy,
notebook, toy, key”。
教学目标
知识与能力目标:
句型
·能够听、说、认读句型“—What’s in your schoolbag? —An English book…”“—What colour
is it? —It’s…”
·能够在情景中运用句型“What’s in your…?”询问某处有什么物品并做出回答
·能够在情景中运用句型“—What colour is it? —It’s…”询问并回答物品的颜色
·能够按意群朗读“I have two storybooks, three keys, some candies…”等句子
词汇
·能够听、说、认读单词和短语:schoolbag, maths book, English book, Chinese book,
storybook,
candy, notebook, toy, key
·能够正确使用上述单词和短语描述书包里的物品
·能够在有意义的语境中正确抄写上述话题词汇
语音
·能够掌握 i-e 的发音规则,即 i-e 在单词中发长音/aɪ/
·能够读出符合 i-e 发音规则的单词,并能根据发音拼写出符合 i-e 发音规则的单词
情感态度、文化意识、学习策略目标:
·学习教科书名称时,使学生了解教科书的重要性,要求他们爱护书本
·了解 Hope School(希望学校),Lost & Found(失物招领)的意思
·能够根据 i-e 的发音规则拼读单词,并能够根据 i 与 i-e 的发音规则拼写单词
课时安排
第一课时: Part A Let’s talk & Let’s play
第二课时: Part A Let’s learn & Let’s do
第三课时: Part A Let’s spell
第四课时: Part B Let’s talk & Let’s play
第五课时: Part B Let’s learn & Draw and say
第六课时: Part B Read and write & Let’s check & Let’s sing
The first period(第一课时)
Part A Let’s talk & Let’s play
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s talk
·能够通过观察和谈论 Let’s talk 板块的图片理解对话大意
·能够用正确的语音、语调及意群朗读对话,并能在小组中进行角色扮演
·能够在情景中运用句型“—What’s in your schoolbag? —An English book…”“I have
a new schoolbag. It’s black and white.”
·能够在语境中理解新词“schoolbag, English book, maths book, storybook”的意思,
并能够正确发音
Let’s play ·在趣味游戏中运用语言,操练并巩固句型“—What’s in your…? —It’s a/an…”
▶教学重点
1.能够理解和掌握重点词汇和核心句型。
2.能够在情景中运用句型“—What’s in your schoolbag? —An English book…”“I have a new
schoolbag. It’s black and white.”。
▶教学难点
能够在语境中灵活运用核心句型。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2.PPT 课件、视频、书包及各种教材等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Free talk.
T: I have a new bag. What colour is it? Guess!
S1: It’s red.
S2: It’s white.
…
T: Yes, you are right. It’s black! Wow! You’re lucky. Here’s
a sticker for you.
3. Let’s review.
Review the words about colours. Students look at the PPT and say
out the words quickly. (课件出示:不同颜色的方块)
4. Lead-in.
The teacher shows a colourless pencil box on the PPT. (课件出示:
一个无色的文具盒)
Let some students guess what colour it is.
Ss: …
Teaching purpose
通过与学生打招呼并自
由谈话拉近师生间的距离,
创造和谐愉悦的学习环境,
并引出本课生词 “wow”和
句型“It’s+表示颜色的形容
词.”。
Teaching purpose
在导入环节,通过猜颜
色引出两种颜色的表达方
法,并在操练过程中不断地
对学生进行第一单元的单词
really 的输入训练。
51
T: Really? (Click the pencil box.) Look! It’s blue and yellow.
The teacher must emphasize how to express two or more colours.
Show the other two kinds of colourless stationery pictures in turn
on the PPT and let students guess the colours. (课件出示:依次显示一
个无色的橡皮和一个无色的铅笔图片)
Step 2: Presentation
1. Learn the new vocabulary and sentence structures.
(1)Learn the new vocabulary: schoolbag, English book, maths book,
storybook.
(课件出示:一个黄色小猫形状的魔术包)
T: I have a magic bag.
Help students ask: Really?
T: Yes. It’s a cat. It’s yellow.
Write down the sentence structure “I have a/an…” on the
blackboard.
Show several kinds of stationery pictures. (课件出示:一个黄蓝
相间汽车形状的魔术文具盒) Practice the sentence structures “I have
a/an… It’s a/an… It’s…” with students.
T: Guess! What’s in the bag?
Let one student click the mouse.
Ss: Wow! It’s a pencil box! It’s a bus.
T: Good. A bus pencil box. So nice! What colour is it?
S1: It’s yellow and blue.
T: What’s in the pencil box? Who wants to click the mouse? (S2
clicks the mouse.)
Ss: Wow!
T: It’s a schoolbag in it! So magic! It’s a magic pencil box!
Write down the word “schoolbag” on the blackboard and teach the
word “schoolbag” (school + bag=schoolbag).
Ask some students to show their schoolbags and say “I have a
schoolbag. It’s a/an… It’s…” one by one.
In the same way, lead in the new vocabulary: English book, maths
book, storybook.
(2)Let students understand the sentence: It’s a fat panda!
T: I have a new schoolbag!
Ss: Really?
Show a real schoolbag to students. There are many things in the
schoolbag.
T: Look! It’s a cat! It’s yellow and white. What’s in the
schoolbag?
Ss: A pencil box, an English book, a maths book…
The teacher puts the things in the bag again.
Teaching purpose
在处理本课时新授对
话时,采用从处理局部语言
到呈现完整对话的方式。先
学习对话中出现的新词、新
句,为后面学习并理解对话
扫清障碍,然后再听对话,
通过设置的三个问题,检测
学生对对话的理解。
T: It’s a fat bag. It’s a fat cat! Cat, /k/-/æ/-/t/, /kæt/, fat,
/f/-/æ/-/t/, /fæt/.
Help students understand “fat” and “It’s a fat panda!”2Learn
the dialogue of “Let’s talk”.
(1)Present the pictures of “Let’s talk” on the PPT. (出示课
件)
T: Amy has something new, too. What’s it? Guess! A. A toy panda.
B. A panda schoolbag.
Ask students to underline the key sentence about the question in
their books.
(2)Listen to the dialogue and answer the question. ( 课 件 出
示:Let’s talk 板块的音频)
S1: A new schoolbag.
S2: It’s a panda.
S3: It’s a panda schoolbag.
Check the answer.
Answer: B
(3)Listen to the dialogue again and answer the questions.
T: What colour is the schoolbag? What’s in the schoolbag? Listen
to the dialogue again and answer the questions. Underline the key
sentences in your books about the questions.
Check the answers.
Answer 1: B
Answer 2: B
Step 3: Practice
1. Listen to the recording of “Let’s talk” and imitate.
Play the recording again. Let students read the dialogue after the
recording. Listen carefully and pay attention to the pronunciation and
the intonation.
2. Read and role play in groups.
T: Now, who wants to be Chen Jie? Who wants to be Amy? Let’s read
it in roles.
3. Act out the dialogue in roles.
T: Now let’s find the best actor or actress. Please come to the
front of the classroom and show the dialogue.
4. Fill in the blanks.
Teaching purpose
通过跟读模仿、分角色
表演对话和根据对话原文
填空,让学生掌握对话的语
言框架,为后面的运用拓展
做好准备。活动 What’s in
the pencil box?和 Let’s play
则是针对本课的重点句型
What’s in…? 进 行 巩 固 练
习,让学生能熟练使用该句
型进行问答。
53
Check the answers. (出示课件)
5. Activity: What’s in the pencil box?
(1)Ask and answer with the partner.
(活动说明:两人一组,每个人准备一个文具盒,在文具盒里装一些文具,
运用本课的核心句型进行对话。)
(2)Show time.
6. Let’s play. (课件出示:Let’s play 板块的图片)
T: Who are they?
Ss: Sarah and Zhang Peng.
T: Yes, they’re Sarah and Zhang Peng. They are playing a guessing
game. What’s in Sarah’s hand? Is it a pencil?
Ss: No. It’s an eraser.
Let students play the game in groups.
Act out in class.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Create a new dialogue.
Show three schoolbags on the PPT: A black and white football
schoolbag, a yellow and white cat schoolbag and a blue and red cap
schoolbag. (出示课件)
T: Do you like these schoolbags?
Lead students to answer: I like this schoolbag.
T: OK! Choose a schoolbag you like. Make a new dialogue with your
partner.
Show the language scaffolds on the PPT to help students make
dialogues.
Practice in pairs and report it in class.
2. Draw a new schoolbag and talk about it with your partner.
Students draw a new schoolbag, then talk about it in pairs.
Choose some groups to act out in class.
The teacher and students evaluate their performances together.
Teaching purpose
在巩固和拓展环节,设
置两个活动。第一个活动是
教师提供图片和语言支架,
学生编新对话,让学生能进
行初步的语言运用与交流;
第二个活动则是学生自己
设计书包,并与小伙伴使用
本课所学的句型进行对话,
充分发挥学生的自主性,培
养学生的创造性,提高学生
的综合语言运用能力。
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Practice the dialogue.
2. Talk about your schoolbag with your partner.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1 上课伊始,通过与学生自由谈话拉近师生间的距离,创造和谐愉悦的学习环境, 并自然而然地引出本课
表达物品颜色的句型。
2 在教学过程中遵循“词不离句,句不离篇”的教学原则,如“Really? What’s in…?”贯穿教学的各
个环节。
3 本课时教学采用从处理局部语言到呈现完整对话的方式。先学习对话中出现的新词,然后再听对话,并
通过问题,检测学生对对话的理解。
4 新单词是通过 PPT 展示的一个神奇的魔术包一个个地“变”出来的,牢牢地抓住了学生的眼球;新句型
的呈现则是通过实物书包和教师的相应动作,生动直观地帮助学生理解了“a fat panda”的含义。
5 通过形式多样的操练活动,一步步引导学生掌握本课的重点句型,并通过巩固拓展部分的两个活动训练
学生灵活运用语言的能力。
6 板书设计简洁,重难点突出,起到了很好的辅助教学的作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s talk
· Be able to understand the main idea of the dialogue by observing and talking about the pictures.
· Be able to read the dialogue with correct pronunciation, intonation and meaning group and act
out in groups.
· Be able to use the sentence structures “—What’s in your schoolbag? —An English book…”“I
have a new schoolbag. It’s black and white.” in the situations.
· Be able to understand the meanings of the new vocabulary “schoolbag, English book, maths book,
storybook” in context and pronounce them correctly.
55
Let’s play
· Practice and consolidate the sentence structures “—What’s in your…? —It’s a/an…” in fun
games.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand and master the key vocabulary and the key sentence structures.
·Be able to use the key sentence structures to communicate in the situations.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the key sentence structures flexibly to communicate in context.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Free talk.
3. Let’s review.
Show blocks of different
colours.
4. Lead-in.
Show several colourless
stationery pictures and let
students guess the colours.
1. Greetings.
2. Free talk.
3. Review the words about
colours.
4. Guess the colours.
Create a harmonious and
pleasant learning
environment. Review the
words about colours.
Lead in the new sentence
structure.
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Presentation
1. Teach the new words and the
sentence structures.
(1)Lead in and teach the new
vocabulary and sentence
structures.
(2)Let students understand the
sentence: It’s a fat panda!
(1)Learn the new vocabulary
and practice the sentence
structures.
(2)Understand the sentence:
It’s a fat panda!
First, learn the new
vocabulary and the
sentence structures
in the dialogue so as
to prepare for the
later learning and
understanding. Then,
test students’
understanding to the
dialogue by setting up
three questions.
2. Teach the dialogue of
“Let’s talk”.
Present the pictures of
“Let’s talk”. Give some
questions and play the
recording twice.
Check the answers.
Listen to the dialogue twice
and answer the questions.
Check the answers.
Practice
1. Play the recording.
2. Let students read in roles.
3. Let some students act out in
roles.
4. Let students fill in the
blanks.
5. Activity: What’s in the
pencil box?
6. Let’s play.
1. Listen to the recording
again and imitate.
2. Read and role play in
groups.
3. Act out the dialogue in
roles.
4. Fill in the blanks.
5. Ask and answer with the
partner and show in class.
6. Play the game and act out in
class.
Practice the main
sentences in
different ways.
Prepare for the next
part.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Create a new dialogue.
Show three schoolbags and
language scaffolds.
2. Draw a new schoolbag and talk
about it with your partner.
Make an evaluation.
1. Create a new dialogue
according to the language
scaffolds. Practice in paris
and report it in class.
2. Draw a new schoolbag and
talk about it with your
partner.
Act out in class.
Evaluate some students’
performances.
Use the sentence
structures learned in
this lesson to create
a dialogue. Give full
play to students’
autonomy, cultivate
their creativity, and
improve their ability
to use the language
synthetically.
Homework
1. Practice the dialogue.
2. Talk about your schoolbag with your partner.
3. Do the exercises.
57
The second period(第二课时)
Part A Let’s learn & Let’s do
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s learn
·能够听、说、认读单词和短语“schoolbag, maths book, English book, Chinese book,
storybook”
·能够熟练运用句型“What’s in your schoolbag?”来询问书包中各种书本的名称并
做出回答
Let’s do ·能够听懂指令,并做出正确的动作反应
▶教学重点
1.能够理解和掌握句型“What’s in your schoolbag?”及重点单词和短语“schoolbag, maths book,
English book, Chinese book, storybook”。
2.注意含有单词 “book”的短语“maths book, English book, Chinese book”及合成词“storybook”
的正确书写。
▶教学难点
1.能够熟练运用句型“What’s in your schoolbag?”来询问书包里各种书本的名称并做出回答。
2.能够熟练使用句型“Put…in/on/under/near…”。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2.PPT 课件、视频、单词卡片等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Lead-in
1. Sing a song.
T: Hello, boys and girls! Let’s enjoy the song My schoolbag. You
can sing the song gently with the music. (课件出示:歌曲《My schoolbag》)
2. Revision.
Review the dialogue of “Let’s talk”. (课件出示: Amy 的熊猫书
包)
T: Look! What’s this? Oh, It’s a panda. It’s Amy’s new…
Ss: Schoolbag.
The teacher writes down the word “schoolbag” on the blackboard.
T: Good. It’s Amy’s new schoolbag.
T: OK. Who wants to be Amy? Who wants to be Chen Jie?
Act out the dialogue in roles.
3. Lead-in.
Teaching purpose
通过欣赏歌曲,营造英
语学习氛围,吸引学生的注
意力,提高学生学习英语的
兴趣,并为后面学习新内容
做好铺垫。
T: Good job! Amy has a fat panda. Amy’s schoolbag is heavy. We
can ask Amy: Amy, What’s in your schoolbag?
Write down the sentence “What’s in your schoolbag?” on the
blackboard. Teach the word “schoolbag”.
T: Pay attention to the word “schoolbag”: “s” sounds /s/,
“ch” sounds /k/, “sch” sounds /sk/, “oo” sounds /u:/, school,
school, school, “a” sounds /æ/, bag, bag, bag, school +
bag=schoolbag.
Step 2: Presentation
1. Learn the new vocabulary.
(1)Watch the cartoon and answer. (课件出示:教材 P15 Let’s learn
板块的动画)
Play the cartoon for the first time.
T: What’s in Amy’s schoolbag?
Ss: Many books.
T: Right! Many books are in Amy’s schoolbag. So her schoolbag is
so heavy.
(2)Watch and do.
T: What books are in Amy’s schoolbag? Watch the cartoon again.
Then take out the right books of your schoolbags.
Check the answer on the PPT. (出示课件)
(3)Learn the new vocabulary: English book, Chinese book, maths book,
storybook.
①Learn “English book”.
The teacher shows an English book.
T: It’s an English book. Pay attention to “an”.
Write down “an English book” on the blackboard.
T: Pay attention to the first letter of “English”. The letter
“E” is the capital letter. It sounds /ɪ/. It is a vowel. So there is
an “an” before “English”. OK. Read after me: /ɪ/-/ŋg/-/lɪʃ/,
. Very good!
T: I say and you do. Show me your English book. Put your English
book on your head. Put your English book on your desk.
②Learn “Chinese book”.
The teacher shows two books.
T: I have two books. An English book and a Chinese book.
Write down “a Chinese book” on the blackboard.
T: Pay attention to the first letter of “Chinese”. The letter
“C” is the capital letter. Now read after me: “ch” sounds /tʃ/,
/tʃaɪ/-/ni:z/, .
T: Show me your English book and Chinese book. Put your Chinese
book on your English book.
③Learn “maths book”.
Teaching purpose
通过这个活动检查学生
是否初步建立起本节课书本
词汇的音、形、义的联系。
Teaching purpose
将 Let’s do 中的句型穿
插在 Let’s learn 板块的教学
中,教师引入相关指令语,
让学生听听做做,手、眼、
耳、脑并用,帮助学生更好
地记忆单词的意思与读音,
同时增加课堂的趣味性,活
跃课堂气氛。
59
T: S1, show me your schoolbag. What’s in your schoolbag? Let me
see! Oh, you have a maths book.
Write down “a maths book” on the blackboard.
T: Please look at my mouth and pay attention to the pronunciation
of the word “maths”: “m” sounds /m/, “a” sounds /æ/, “th” sounds
/θ/, “s” sounds /s/. The letter “m” sounds /m/. It is a consonant.
So there is an “a” before “maths book”.
T: Everybody, show me your maths book. Put your maths book on your
desk. How many books are there on your desk now?
Ss: Three books.
T: What are they?
Ss: An English book, a Chinese book and a maths book.
④Learn “storybook”.
T: Look at my schoolbag. What’s in my schoolbag? Please guess.
Ss: …
The teacher opens the schoolbag and says: A Chinese book, a maths
book, an English book and…
The teacher shows three storybooks and says: Storybooks. One
storybook, two storybooks, three storybooks.
Write down “three storybooks” on the blackboard. Lead students
to observe the structure of the word “storybook”.
T: This word “storybook” is a compound word. The words “story”
and “book” are not written separately. And what’s in my schoolbag?
Ss: A Chinese book, a maths book, an English book and three
storybooks.
T: Very good!
2. Look and match.
Look at the PPT and match the words with the pictures.
3. Listen to the recording of “Let’s learn”. (课件出示:教材
P15 Let’s learn 板块的音频)
Let students read after the recording. Listen carefully and pay
attention to the pronunciation and the intonation.
4. Let’s do.
(1)The teacher plays the recording sentence by sentence. (课件
出示:教材 P15 Let’s do 板块的音频) Students show the things they have
heard.
Teaching purpose
通过完成连线练习检查
学生对所学词汇的形义的掌
握程度,同时引导学生关注
名词的单复数形式。
Teaching purpose
教师播放录音,学生听
录音跟读。引导学生按照正
确的语音、语调朗读,并为
后面教学环节的展开做好准
备。
(2)The teacher repeats sentence by sentence. Students point out
the pictures in their books.
(3)Listen and do.
T: Class! Now, I say and you do. Show me your Chinese book/English
book/maths book/pencil box/eraser… OK, wonderful! Please listen and
do after the recording.
Play the recording again and let students do the corresponding
actions after the recording together.
Step 3: Practice
1. Play a game—“Loudly and quietly.”
Tips: The teacher hides the word card in a certain place. Ask one
student to find. If he/she comes near the word card, students speak
the word quietly. If he/she goes far away from the card, students read
the word loudly.
2. Play a game—“Simon says.”
(游戏说明:教师发指令前说 Simon says,学生则做此动作,发指令前没
有说 Simon says,学生则不做此动作。如:Simon says, show me your Chinese
book.则学生做此动作;如: Put your maths book in your schoolbag.则学
生不做此动作。这个活动可以以小组竞赛的形式进行。)
3. Play a game—“Sharp eyes.”
Show some pictures and options one by one, and let students choose
the correct option for each picture as quickly as they can.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. A guessing game.
Play the game in groups of four. One student hides a book in his/her
schoolbag. The others guess.
S1: What’s in my schoolbag? Guess!
S2: A maths book?
S3: …
S4: …
2. Play a chain game.
S1: What’s in your schoolbag?
Teaching purpose
通过三个有趣的游戏,
增加英语课堂的趣味性,复
习和巩固新词汇。
Teaching purpose
巩固拓展部分提供三个
游戏,旨在训练学生综合运
用新句型和新词汇的能力,
并能够将所学内容运用到真
实的语言情境中去,起到一
个知识内化的作用。
61
S2: A Chinese book.
S3: A Chinese book and a pencil box.
S4: …
3. A circling game.
T: Anna has a nice schoolbag. What’s in it? Let’s listen and
circle the things in Anna’s schoolbag. [课件出示:一个书包,一些书
本,一些文具(必须包含下面对话中出现的物品,再加上一些无关的物品)]
Students listen to the dialogue and circle the things.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Copy the new vocabulary and the sentences.
2. Talk about your schoolbag with your parents.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1 运用歌曲、PPT、游戏等多种教学手段吸引学生参与到各种教学活动中来,在轻松愉快的氛围中复习旧知、
学习新知。
2 将 Let’s do 中的句型穿插在 Let’s learn 板块的教学中,教师引入相关指令语,让学生听听做做,手、
眼、耳、脑并用,帮助学生更好地记忆单词的意义与读音,同时增加了课堂的趣味性,活跃了课堂气氛。
3 通过形式多样的游戏和操练活动,全面提高学生听、说、认读词汇的能力。
4 板书设计直观,突出重点词汇和句型,起到了很好的辅助教学的作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s learn
· Be able to listen, speak and read the vocabulary “schoolbag, maths book, English book, Chinese
book, storybook”.
· Be able to use the sentence structure “What’s in your schoolbag?” skillfully to ask and answer
the names of the various books in the schoolbag.
Let’s do
· Be able to understand the instructions and do the corresponding actions.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand and grasp the key vocabulary “schoolbag, maths book, English book, Chinese
book, storybook” and the sentence structure “What’s in your schoolbag?”
·Pay attention to the writing of the word and the phrases with “book”.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the sentence structure “What’s in your schoolbag?” adroitly to ask and answer
the names of the various books in the schoolbag.
·Be able to use the sentence structures “Put…in/on/under/near…” adroitly.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
&
Lead-in
1. Sing a song.
2. Revision.
3. Lead-in.
Lead in the new lesson
and teach the word
“schoolbag”.
1. Sing a song—My schoolbag.
2. Review the dialogue of “Let’s
talk”. Read and act out in
roles.
3. Listen to the teacher and learn
the word “schoolbag”.
Create an English learning
atmosphere by singing a
song. Review the content
of the last class, and lay
a good foundation for the
new lesson.
1. Teach the new
vocabulary.
(1)Play the cartoon and
ask a question.
(2)Watch and do.
(3)Teach the new
vocabulary.
(1)Watch the cartoon and answer.
(2)Watch and do.
(3)Learn the new vocabulary
“English book, Chinese book,
maths book, storybook”.
Through various games and
activities, let students
master the new vocabulary
from three aspects: sound,
shape and meaning. Lead
students to know the
singular and plural forms
of nouns. Activate the
atmosphere of the class.
2. Look and match.
Present a match game. Look and match.
Lead students to read the
vocabulary according to
the correct pronunciation
and intonation. Prepare
for the next step.
3. Listen to the
recording of “Let’s
learn”.
Play the recording.
Read after the recording.
4. Let’s do.
(1)Play the recording
sentence by sentence.
(2)Repeat sentence by
sentence.
(3)Listen and do.
(1)Show the things they have
heard.
(2)Point out the pictures in their
books.
(3)Listen and do after the teacher
and the recording.
63
Practice
1. Play a game— “Loudly
and quietly.”
2. Play a game—“Simon
says.”
3. Play a game—“Sharp
eyes.”
1. Play a game—“Loudly and
quietly”.
2. Play a game—“Simon says.”
3. Choose the correct option for
each picture as quickly as they
can.
Stimulate students’
interest. Consolidate the
new vocabulary in this
lesson through games.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. A guessing game.
2. Play a chain game.
3. A circling game.
1. Play the game in groups of four.
Hide and guess.
2. Play a chain game.
3. Listen to the dialogue and
circle Anna’s things.
Train students’ ability
to use language
synthetically through
games so as to achieve the
purpose of knowledge
internalization.
Homework
1. Copy the new vocabulary and the sentences.
2. Talk about your schoolbag with your parents.
3. Do the exercises.
The third period(第三课时)
Part A Let’s spell
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s spell
·能够感知并归纳 i-e 在单词中的发音规则,即 i-e 在单词中发长音/aɪ/
·能够读出符合 i-e 发音规则的单词
·能够根据单词的读音拼写出符合 i-e 发音规则的单词
▶教学重点
能够读出符合 i-e 发音规则的单词,并能根据单词的读音拼写出符合 i-e 发音规则的单词。
▶教学难点
能够根据单词的读音拼写出符合 i-e 发音规则的单词。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2.PPT 课件、视频等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Sing the song—My schoolbag. (出示课件)
3. Let’s chant.
T: What’s this?
Ss: A pig.
Teaching purpose
课前利用歌曲热身,创
设愉快的英语学习氛围。说
唱自编歌谣,复习字母 i 在
闭音节中的发音/ɪ/,并以谈
论同学们的书包来引出本课
新授部分的情境。
T: Yes, It’s a big pig. (Write down “big, pig” on the blackboard.)
How many pigs now?
Ss: Six.
T: Good. Six big pigs. (Write down “six” on the blackboard.)
Chant in groups. Let’s have a PK. The winner will get a red star.
4. Lead-in.
T: S1, show me your schoolbag. What’s in your schoolbag?
S1: A Chinese book, a maths book…
Talk about things in the schoolbags with several students.
Step 2: Presentation
1. Find the letters: i-e.
Find and learn the pronunciation rule of “i-e”.
(课件出示:Zoom 背书包的图片)
(1)T: Look! Zoom has a new schoolbag, too. Wow! It’s nice. (Write
down “nice” on the blackboard.)
Students read it after the teacher. The teacher underlines the
letters “i-e” and teaches /aɪ/.
(2)T: Zoom’s schoolbag is nice. So he likes it very much. (Write
down “like” on the blackboard.)
Students read it after the teacher. The teacher underlines the
letters “i-e”.
T: How does “i-e” sound? Yes, “i-e” sounds /aɪ/. Read after me,
/aɪ/-/aɪ/-/aɪ/.
Read like this: i-e/aɪ/-c/s/-ice/aɪs/, nice/naɪs/;
i-e/aɪ/-k/k/-ike/aɪk/, like/laɪk/.
(3)T: Guess! What’s in Zoom’s schoolbag?
Ss: An English book/A Chinese book/…?
The teacher clicks the mouse. Show a kite on the PPT. (出示课件)
Ss: Wow! It’s a kite.
T: Yes, It’s a kite. (Write down “kite” on the blackboard.)
Students read “kite” after the teacher. Then the teacher repeats
/aɪ/ and let some students try to underline the letters. (Reward
students with some red stars.)
Read like this: i-e/aɪ/-t/t/-ite/aɪt/, kite/kaɪt/.
(4)Click the mouse and enlarge the picture of the kite on the PPT.
(出示课件)
T: Look! There’s a secret on the kite. What is it? Yes, two numbers:
five and nine. (Write down “five, nine” on the blackboard.) Read like
Teaching purpose
教师在教学中通过拆
音、拼音和分类等语音意识
训练活动,引导学生观察、
发现并自己归纳 i-e 在单词
中的发音规则。
65
this: i-e/aɪ/-v/v/-ive/aɪv/, five/faɪv/; i-e/aɪ/-n/n/-ine/aɪn/,
nine/naɪn/.
(Reward students with some red stars.)
(5)T: Zoom has a nice kite in his schoolbag. He likes the kite very
much. He flies the kite all day. He’s hungry. He’s eating some rice.
( 课 件 出 示 :Zoom 正 在 吃 米 饭 的 图 片 ) ( Write down “rice” on the
blackboard.)
Let students underline “i-e” and read it. Then spell the word.
(Reward students with some red stars.)
Lead students to observe their common points: “i-e”, the vowel
letter “i” and a silent “e” at the end of the words, sounds the
same sound /aɪ/ with “i”. That is, “i-e” sounds /aɪ/ in the words.
2. Read and match.
T: Look at the PPT. Read the words and match with the pictures.
(课件出示:单词 like, kite, five, nine, rice 及其图片)
3. Read after the recording. (课件出示:教材 P16 Read, listen and
chant 部分的音频)
(1)Look at the pictures carefully and say something about the
pictures.
(2)Students listen to the recording.
(3)Students read after the recording.
(4)Students listen to the chant and circle the letters “i-e”.
Step 3: Practice
1. Read, listen and number. (课件出示:教材 P16 Read, listen and
number 部分的音频)
T: Turn to page 16 and finish the exercise of “Read, listen and
number”.
(1)The teacher teaches the word “fine” and students read the
words.
(2)Listen to the recording and number the words.
(3)Check the answers.
Answers: 1. pig 2. big 3. fine 4. nice 5. six 6. ice
2. Read and distinguish.
Read the words in each group and distinguish.
3. Listen, circle and write.
(1)Give an example.
T: Look at the first picture. What can you see?
Ss: “Five”.
T: Great! Now listen to the recording. (课件出示:“five”的音频)
What do you hear?
Teaching purpose
通过练习帮助学生按照
发音规则拼读单词、辨认词
形并完成单词的拼写。
Ss: /faɪv/.
T: Good job!
(2)Lead students to observe the pictures of this part and try to
predict the content of the listening text.
(3)Let students listen, circle and write. (课件出示:教材 P16 Listen,
circle and write 部分的音频) Remind them to pay attention to the words’
handwriting.
Answers: six big kite
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Try to read the following words.
Show some words with “i-e”, just like “time, wife, white, line,
bite, Mike, drive” on the PPT. (出示课件)
Let students try to spell these words. Then read them aloud.
2. Classify the given words.
T: Read the following words and classify them according to their
pronunciations. Discuss with your partners. Then report the results.
Check the answers.
Answers: /ɪ/: A C F J /əɪ/: B D E G H I K
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Try to find more words with “i-e” that sounds “/aɪ/”.
2. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1 课前歌曲及教师与学生谈论书包这一话题,都为创设本课新授部分的情境做准备。
2 在复习环节通过自编歌谣,复习字母 i 在闭音节中发/ɪ/音的规律,复习旧知,为后面学生辨别词形做准
备。
Teaching purpose
通过尝试利用发音规则
拼读单词和按读音将单词分
类这两个活动,巩固并检测
学生对本节课 i-e 的发音及
发音规则的掌握情况。
67
3 教师在教学中通过拆音、拼音和分类等语音意识训练活动,引导学生观察、发现并自己归纳 i-e 在单词
中的发音规则,很好地体现了课堂教学中以学生为主体的教学理念。
4 板书设计直观,重难点突出,起到了总结归纳的作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s spell
· Be able to perceive and generalize the pronunciation rule of “i-e” in the words.
· Be able to read the words that conform to the pronunciation rule of “i-e”.
· Be able to spell the words that conform to the pronunciation rule of “i-e” according to the
pronunciation of the words.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to read the words that conform to the pronunciation rule of “i-e” and spell the words
that conform to the pronunciation rule of “i-e” according to the pronunciation of the words.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to spell the words that conform to the pronunciation rule of “i-e” according to the
pronunciation of the words.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching
Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Play a song—My
schoolbag.
3. Teach students a chant.
4. Lead-in.
1. Greetings.
2. Sing a song—My schoolbag.
3. Learn a chant and review the sound
of “/ɪ/”.
4. Talk about things in the
schoolbags.
Create an English
learning
atmosphere.
Review the sound
of “/ɪ/”. Lead
in the new
lesson.
Presentation
1. Find the letters: i-e.
Create a situation and
present the words: nice,
like, kite, five, nine,
rice.
Teach the sound: /aɪ/.
Find the letters: i-e.
Learn the sound: /aɪ/.
Lead students to
observe, find and
summarize the
pronunciation
rule of “i-e”
in the words.
2. Read and match.
Present the words and the
pictures on the PPT. Let
students read and match.
Read the words.
Match the words with the pictures.
3. Read after the
recording.
Let students read after
the recording.
(1)Look at the pictures carefully and
say something about the pictures.
(2)Listen to the recording.
(3)Imitate after the recording.
(4)Listen to the chant and circle the
letters “i-e”. And learn to read
the word “fine”.
69
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Practice
1. Read, listen and number.
Teach the word “fine”.
Play the recording of
“Read, listen and
number”.
2. Read and distinguish.
Present some words on the
PPT.
3. Listen, circle and write.
(1)Give an example.
(2)Lead students to observe
the pictures of this part
and try to predict the
content of the listening
text.
(3)Let students listen,
circle and write. Remind
students to pay attention
to the words’ handwriting.
1. Turn to page 16 and
finish “Read, listen
and number.”
2. Read the words in each
group and distinguish.
3. Finish the exercise of
“Listen, circle and
write” on page 16.
Through practice, help
students spell the words
according to the
pronunciation rules,
recognize the shapes of the
words and complete the
spelling of the words.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Try to read the following
words.
Show some words with
“i-e”.
Let students try to spell
these words.
2. Classify the given words.
Present a group of words on
the PPT.
Check the answers.
1. Try to spell these
words.
Then read them aloud.
2. Read the words and
classify them according
to their
pronunciations.
Discuss with their
partners.
Report the results.
Check the answers.
Consolidate and test
students’ mastery of the
pronunciation and the
pronunciation rule of
“i-e” in this lesson.
Homework 1. Try to find more words with “i-e” that sounds “/aɪ/”.
2. Do the exercises.
The fourth period(第四课时)
Part B Let’s talk & Let’s play
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s talk
·能够通过观察和谈论 Let’s talk 板块的图片理解对话大意
·能够用正确的语音、语调朗读对话,并能在小组中进行角色扮演
·能够在情境中恰当运用句型“—What colour is it? —It’s…”问答颜色
·能够在情境中理解新词“lost, toy, notebook”的意思并能正确发音
Let’s play ·能够通过本板块提供的教学活动,操练并巩固本课的核心句型“—What colour is it?
—It’s…”
▶教学重点
1.能够理解新词并掌握重点句型。
2.能够在情景中恰当运用句型“—What colour is it? —It’s…”问答颜色。
▶教学难点
能够在情景中恰当运用句型“—What colour is it? —It’s…”问答颜色。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、视频等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Sing a song—My schoolbag. (出示课件)
3. Do the TPR action.
T: Where is your mouth/the door/your pen/…?
Ss: Here it is!
Step 2: Presentation
1. Lead-in.
T: Good job. Are you happy now?
Ss: Yes.
Show the main scene graph of Unit 2 on the PPT. (课件出示:教材
P12 主情景图中有关 Sarah 和 Amy 的图片)
T: Who are they?
Ss: Sarah and Amy.
T: Is Sarah happy?
Ss: No.
(The teacher shows a notebook.)
T: You’re right. Sarah is not happy, because she lost her notebook.
Write down “lost, notebook” on the blackboard.
T: Read after me, please. /l/-/ɒ/-/s/-/t/, /lɒst/. /n/-/əʊ-/t/,
/nəʊt/, the letter “e” is silent. /b/-/ʊ/-/k/, /bʊk/,
note/nəʊt/-book/bʊk/, notebook
.
Let students read after the teacher.
Teaching purpose
通过 TPR 活动,将学生
所有感官调动起来,全身心
地投入到英语学习中去,同
时提 前渗透 句型“Here it
is!”。
Teaching purpose
通过谈论主情景图,导
入本课话题,学习并理解新
单词“lost, notebook”。
71
2. Learn “Lost & Found, excuse me”.
(1)T: Sarah isn’t happy. She lost her notebook. Where can she find
it? Maybe she can go to the Lost & Found. (课件出示:失物招领处的画
面)
Write down “Lost & Found” on the blackboard.
Let students read after the teacher.
(2)Show the pictures of “Let’s talk” in Part B. (出示课件)
T: We can see Zhang Peng in this picture. Look carefully. Where’s
Zhang Peng?
Ss: At the Lost & Found.
T: Yes, he’s at the Lost & Found. Why is he here? Maybe he lost…
S1: …
S2: …
Listen and choose the right answer. (出示课件)
Check the answer.
Answer: B
T: How do you know the answer? Can you read the sentence in the
book out?
Ss: Zhang Peng says, “I lost my schoolbag.”
Let students read the sentence one by one.
T: Zhang Peng is a polite boy, because he says, “Excuse me. I lost
my schoolbag.”
Let students read this sentence one by one.
Present some scenes to practice “excuse me”. (课件出示:场景一:
向交警叔叔问路;场景二:借东西;场景三:请别人让路)
3. Learn the sentence structures “—What colour is it? —It’s…”
and the new word “toy”.
The teacher walks to S1.
T: Excuse me. Can I have a look at your schoolbag?
…
T: Oh, thank you. Your schoolbag is nice. It’s blue and yellow.
What’s in it?
(The student takes out the books and answers.)
S1: A maths book, a Chinese book…
T: Can I borrow your schoolbag for a moment? The teacher walks to
S2.
T: Excuse me. Can I have a look at your schoolbag?
…
T: Oh, thank you. What colour is it?
S2: It’s red.
Teaching purpose
教师设置问题一步步引
导学生观察并讨论 Part B
Let’s talk 板块的图片,引
出并学习新词及常用语。新
句型“—What colour is it?
—It’s…”的学习则是通过
实物创设情境,在真实的语
境中学习、理解。最后通过
听课文录音并回答预设的问
题来理解课文。
T: Can I borrow your schoolbag for a moment?
Write down the sentence structures “—What colour is it?
—It’s…” on the blackboard.
Let students read after the teacher. Then students read it one by
one.
…
The teacher gets several schoolbags in the same way.
T: Now I have some schoolbags here. But I forget their owners. Whose
schoolbags are on the teacher’s desk? Please come here.
T: What colour is your schoolbag?
S1: …
T: What’s in it?
S1: …
T: Oh, What’s this? It’s a toy. There is a toy in your schoolbag.
Can we take toys to school? No, we can’t. So you can’t take a toy
next time, OK?
S1: OK.
T: Here it is.
S1: Thank you!
The teacher writes down the new word “toy” on the blackboard.
T: Now read after me. Toy, /t/-/ɔɪ/, /tɔɪ/.
The teacher and students continue to ask and answer like this until
the teacher finds other schoolbags’ owners.
4. Get more details.
Listen to the recording and answer the questions. (课件出示:教
材 P17 Let’s talk 板块的音频) Underline the key sentences in the books.
Check the answers.
Answer 1: B
T: How do you know the answer?
S1: Zhang Peng says, “It’s blue and white.”
Answer 2: A
T: What’s in Zhang Peng’s schoolbag?
S2: An English book, two toys and a notebook.
Answer 3: Yes, he can.
T: Yes. Zhang Peng found his schoolbag. He thanks Miss White very
much. So he says, “Thank you so much!”
Repeat “so much”. Let students read and act out “Thank you so much!”
Teaching purpose
学会按照正确的语音、
语调朗读对话,并能在小组
中进行角色表演。在真实语
境中操练重点句型,帮助学
73
Step 3: Practice
1. Listen to the recording again and repeat.
Let students read the dialogue after the recording. Listen
carefully and pay attention to the pronunciation and the intonation.
2. Read the dialogue.
Let students read the dialogue in pairs.
3. Role play.
T: Let’s read the dialogue in roles. Group 1 and Group 2, you are
Zhang Peng. Group 3 and Group 4, you’re Miss White. Now read the
dialogue in pairs. Then act it out in class. I will find the best group.
The red star is for the best group!
4. Let’s play.
Ask students to guess what book it is according to the colours.
Finish the activity of “Let’s play”. (课件出示:教材 P17 Let’s play
板块的图片)
(1)T: Look, What’s this? Yes, It’s a storybook. What colour
is it? It’s green. What’s this? It’s a Chinese book. What colour
is it? It’s red…
Help students get to know all the books and their colours in
“Let’s play”. Then start the activity.
T: I have a new book. Guess, what is it? You can ask me the colour
of my new book. Then you can know it.
Make a model first.
T: I have a new book.
S1: What colour is it?
T: It’s yellow.
S1: It’s a Chinese book.
T: Yes. Now, please do it like this in pairs. I will find the best
pair. The red stars are for the winners!
(2)Show time.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Create a new dialogue.
Two students make a group to create a dialogue according to the
PPT.
2. Draw and talk.
Teaching purpose
通过两个活动培养学生
在真实的情境中运用所学新
词和新句型的能力,放手让
学生表达自己的真实情感,
发挥学生的自主性和创造
性。
Let students draw a new schoolbag and talk about it with their
partners like this:
S1: This is my new schoolbag.
S2: What colour is it?
S1: It’s…
S2: What’s in it?
S1: …
S2: It’s nice.
S1: Thank you.
Let several groups show in class. Reward some presents to the
winners.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Read the dialogue.
2. Act out the dialogue with your partner at the Lost & Found.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1 课前热身环节通过学生喜爱的与本课时教学内容相关的歌曲、TPR 活动,充分激发学生的学习兴趣。
2 本课时的教学以“失物招领”为主线创设情境,在情境中学习新知、巩固新知、运用新知。
3 在教学过程中通过师生、生生对话,在情景中习得知识,遵循了“词不离句,句不离景”的教学规律。
4 在真实语境中操练重点句型,帮助学生真正理解并掌握重点句型,学会灵活运用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s talk
· Be able to understand the main idea of the dialogue by observing and talking about the pictures.
· Be able to read the dialogue with correct pronunciation and intonation and then act out in groups.
· Be able to use the key sentence structures to ask and answer the colours properly in the situations.
·Be able to understand and pronounce the new words “lost, toy, notebook” in the situations.
Let’s play
·Be able to practice and consolidate the key sentence structures “—What colour is it? —It’s…”
through the teaching activities provided in this section.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand the new words “lost, toy, notebook” and grasp the key sentence structures.
75
·Be able to use the key sentence structures to ask and answer the colours properly in the situations.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the key sentence structures to ask and answer the colours properly in the situations.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
1. Greetings.
2. Sing a song—My schoolbag.
3. Do the TPR action.
1. Greetings.
2. Sing a song—My
schoolbag.
3. Do the TPR action with
the teacher.
Arouse students’
initiative by TPR.
Learn the sentence in
advance. Prepare for
the new lesson.
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Presentation
1. Lead-in.
Show the main scene graph
of Unit 2 and lead in the
new lesson. Teach the new
words “lost,
notebook”.
Look at the picture and
answer some questions.
Learn the new words
“lost, notebook”.
Lead in the new lesson by
talking about the main scene
graph. Help students know the
new words “lost, notebook”.
2. Teach “Lost & Found,
excuse me”.
Learn “Lost & Found,
excuse me”. Lead students to observe and
discuss the pictures through
setting questions. Help them
learn the new vocabulary and
the sentence structures by
creating situations and
understand the text by
listening to the recording and
answering the questions.
3.Teach the sentence
structure“—What colour
is it? — It’s…” and
the new word “toy”.
Learn the sentence
structures “—What
colour is it?
—It’s…” and the new
word “toy”.
4. Get more details.
Show questions. Play the
recording. Check the
answers.
Listen to the recording
and answer the
questions. Check the
answers.
Practice
1. Play the recording
again.
2. Let students read the
dialogue.
3. Role play.
4. Let’s play.
Show some pictures and
let students guess what
book it is.
1. Listen to the
recording and repeat.
2. Read the dialogue in
pairs.
3. Read in roles and act
out in class.
4. Look at the pictures
and guess.
Learn to read the dialogue with
correct pronunciation and
intonation. Act out in groups.
Practice the key sentence
structures in real context.
Help students understand and
master them.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Create a new dialogue.
2. Draw and talk.
1. Work in groups of two
and make a dialogue.
2. Draw a new schoolbag
and talk about it with
their partners.
Cultivate students’ ability
to use the key vocabulary and
the sentence structures in
real situations. Let students
express their true feelings.
Stimulate students’ autonomy
and creativity.
Homework
1. Read the dialogue.
2. Act out the dialogue with your partner at the Lost & Found.
3. Do the exercises.
The fifth period(第五课时)
77
Part B Let’s learn & Draw and say
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s learn
·能够听、说、认读单词“candy, key, toy, notebook”
·能够熟练运用句型“What’s in the schoolbag?”询问并描述书包中各种物品的名称
·在描述书包中的物品时能够正确使用名词的单复数形式
Draw and say ·复习并巩固 Part B Let’s learn 板块的主要句型“What’s in my/your schoolbag?”
以及单词“candy, key, toy, notebook”
▶教学重点
1 能够听懂、会说、认读单词“candy, key, toy, notebook”。
2 能够熟练描述书包中的各种物品。
▶教学难点
在描述书包中的物品时,能够正确使用名词的单复数形式。
▶教学准备
1. 预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、视频、贴纸、实物等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Sing the song—My schoolbag. (出示课件)
3. Revision.
Put the schoolbag in a plastic bag and show it to students.
T: Look, boys and girls! What’s this? … Yes, It’s my schoolbag.
It’s a nice schoolbag. What colour is it? What’s in it? Do you want
to know? Please guess! Come on, class! If you do a good job, you can
get a sticker. (Show students the stickers.)
T: What colour is my schoolbag?
S1: Green?
T: No, again!
S1: Orange?
T: Yes, you’re right! Here’s your sticker!
T: What’s in my schoolbag?
S2: A Chinese book?
T: No, again!
S2: An English book?
…
Step 2: Presentation
Teaching purpose
猜猜教师书包里有什
么,复习之前学过的关于书
本的词汇和询问颜色的句
型。
1. Teach the new words “notebook, toy, toys”.
(课件出示:上节课张鹏在失物招领处找到的蓝白色书包)
T: Look! Do you know this schoolbag? Whose schoolbag is it?
Ss: It’s Zhang Peng’s schoolbag.
T: Yes, It’s Zhang Peng’s schoolbag. He found it at the Lost &
Found. What’s in his schoolbag?
Ss: An English book, two toys and a notebook.
T: Are you right? Let’s check.
(课件出示: P18 Let’s learn 板块的插图)
T: Oh, yes, look! A notebook! Two toys!
(课件出示:将书包中的笔记本和两个玩具分别闪烁两下,接着在图片旁
边出现单词 notebook 和 toys,其中 toys 中的字母 s 用红色)
T: How many notebooks can you see in Zhang Peng’s schoolbag?
Ss: One.
T: Good, one notebook. Notebook, note-book, note/nəʊt/-book
/bʊk/, notebook . How many toys?
T: Let’s count. One, two. Two toys. Toy, oy/ɔɪ/, toy/tɔɪ/,
toys/tɔɪz/.
Write down the words “notebook, toy, toys” on the blackboard.
The teacher reads the words “toys” and “notebook” syllable by
syllable. Students follow the teacher and then practice reading the
words.
(课件出示:几种物品都从一个到多个)
Students read the words after the teacher for three times. Then
choose a group of words to read one by one like this: one boy, two boys,
three boys. One book, four books, five books.
2. Teach the new words “candy, candies, key, keys”.
(1)The teacher holds a candy in the hand.
T: Guess, What’s in my hand? It’s sweet and children all like
it.
Ss: …
T: Good! Look! It’s a candy. It’s a red candy. Candy, can/k æn/
-dy/di/, candy .
Write down the word “candy” on the blackboard.
The teacher reads the word “candy” syllable by syllable. Students
follow the teacher and then practice reading the word.
The teacher shows another candy.
T: What colour is it?
Ss: It’s blue.
T: Wonderful! Now, Let’s count. One candy, two candies. I have
two candies. One candy, two candies .
Write down the word “candies” on the blackboard.
Teaching purpose
在设定的情境中,以不
同方式呈现新单词,吸引学
生的注意力,使学生感受物
品的真实含义,并形成一个
小语境,帮助学生理解和掌
握单词。
79
The teacher reads the word “candies” syllable by syllable.
Students follow the teacher and then practice reading the word.
(2)The teacher shows students a schoolbag.
T: I have something in the schoolbag. Please ask with the sentence
“What’s in your schoolbag?”. And you can touch and take it/them out.
Then tell other students what it is/they are.
Write down the sentence “What’s in your schoolbag?” on the
blackboard.
S1: What’s in your schoolbag? (Touch in the schoolbag.) A notebook
and two candies.
T: Great! You’re right.
S2: What’s in your schoolbag? (Touch in the schoolbag.) …
S3: What’s in your schoolbag? (Touch in the schoolbag.) I don’t
know.
T: Take it/them out of the bag. Let’s have a look.
T: Oh, they’re keys.
The teacher shows one key and says slowly, “A key.”
The teacher shows two keys and says slowly, “Two keys.”
The teacher shows a bunch of keys and says, “I have many keys.”
Write down the words “key, keys” on the blackboard.
The teacher reads the words like this: k/k/-ey/i:/, key/ki:/,
keys/ki:z/. Students follow the teacher and practice reading the words.
Then read one by one.
Step 3: Practice
1. Listen to the recording and repeat. (课件出示:教材 P18 Let’s
learn 板块中单词的音频)
T: What’s in Zhang Peng’s schoolbag? Listen and repeat.
Play the recording. Let students listen to the recording and repeat.
Remind students to pay attention to the pronunciation and the
intonation.
2. Read the words and the sentences.
Let students read the words and the sentences in different ways.
Read freely. Read in pairs. Read together.
3. Play some games.
T: Now, Let’s play some games. If you do a good job, you can get
a sticker. Come on!
(1)Flash words. (课件出示:快速一一闪现 Part A 和 Part B 两部分所
学的词汇)
T: Look at the PPT and say the words as quickly as you can.
(2)Watch, think and guess.
The teacher shows a part of some pictures and asks: What’s this?
Students try to guess and answer.
Teaching purpose
教师播放单词部分的录
音,学生听录音跟读。引导
学生按照正确的语音、语调
朗读单词。
Teaching purpose
三个游戏活动目的不
同。第一个游戏检查学生对
新单词音形的掌握情况。第
二个游戏则是将单词含义与
单词图片结合的活动。第三
个游戏则是检查学生对单词
字形的把握程度,能否做到
拼读单词。三个活动以游戏
T: Good job! You’re right. Here’s a sticker for you! Let’s go
on.
…
(3)Make up the words.
Present the letters that can make up the words in random order.
Ask students to guess the words.
T: Look at these letters. Put the letters in right order and we
can see a word. What is it?
T: Write down the words in your exercise books. Come on!
Check the answers. Give out the stickers for the winners.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Listen and circle.
T: What’s in Amy’s schoolbag? Look at the PPT and listen carefully,
then circle.
2. Draw and say.
Draw a schoolbag and some things in the schoolbag.
Talk about the schoolbag like this:
A: What’s in your schoolbag?
B: Three keys, two toys and an English book.
Practice in pairs.
Choose some pairs to act out in class.
The teacher makes an evaluation.
▶板书设计
Teaching purpose
通过两个活动巩固本课
所学单词与句型,让学生在
应用中熟练掌握所学内容,
达到学以致用的目的。
81
▶作业设计
1. Read the new words to your parents and copy the words.
2. Practice reading the sentences.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1 以不同的方式呈现新单词,吸引学生的注意力,使学生感受物品的真实含义,并形成一个小语境,更有
利于学生理解和掌握单词。
2 在教学过程中,不是单纯地教单词,而是始终遵循“词不离句”的教学原则,使学生在语境中更容易理
解单词的含义。
3 在教授新单词的时候,通过拆音、拼音等语音意识训练活动,帮助学生快速记忆单词。
4 给学生一个想象的空间,让学生自己画书包及书包里装的物品,并谈论自己的新书包,培养学生的想象
力和交际能力。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s learn
· Be able to listen, speak and read the words “candy, key, toy, notebook”.
·Be able to use the sentence structure “What’s in the schoolbag?” to ask and describe the objects
in the schoolbag adroitly.
· Be able to use the singular and plural forms of nouns correctly when describing the objects in
the schoolbag.
Draw and say
·Review and consolidate the main sentence structures “What’s in my/your schoolbag?” and the
words “candy, key, toy, notebook”.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to listen, speak and read the words “candy, key, toy, notebook”.
·Be able to describe the objects in the schoolbag adroitly.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the singular and plural forms of nouns correctly when describing the objects in
the schoolbag.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Stages
Warm-up
&
Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Sing the song—My schoolbag.
3. Revision.
Show a schoolbag and let
students guess what colour it
is and what is in it.
1. Greetings.
2. Sing the song—My
schoolbag.
3. Revision.
Guess the colour of the
teacher’s bag and the
items in the bag.
Review the words and the
sentence structures
related to this lesson
by guessing the colour
of the teacher’s bag
and the items in the
bag.
Presentation
1. Teach the new word
“notebook, toy, toys”.
Show Zhang Peng’s schoolbag
and create a situation: Zhang
Peng found his bag. What’s in
his schoolbag?
2. Teach the new words “candy,
candies, key, keys”.
(1)Ask students to guess a
riddle: It’s sweet and
children all like it.
(2)Let students touch and guess.
1. Learn the new words
“notebook, toy, toys”.
2. Learn the new words
“candy, candies, key,
keys”.
(1)Guess a riddle and
learn the new words
“candy, candies”.
(2)Touch and guess objects
in the schoolbag and
learn the new words
“key, keys”.
Attract students’
attention by presenting
the new words in
different ways and let
them feel the real
meanings of the objects
in a set situation. Help
students understand and
grasp the new words.
83
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Practice
1. Play the recording.
2. Let students read the
words and the sentences.
3. Play some games.
(1)Flash words.
Show the words on the PPT.
(2)Watch, think and guess.
Show a part of the
pictures.
(3)Make up the words.
Show the letters in
random order.
1. Listen to the recording
and repeat.
2. Read the words and the
sentences.
3. Play some games.
(1)Flash words.
Say the words as quickly
as they can.
(2)Watch, think and guess.
Look at a part of the
pictures and guess the
words.
(3)Make up the words.
Lead students to read the
new words with correct
pronunciation and
intonation. Through three
different games,
stimulate students’
learning interest,
increase the initiative of
students’ participation
and achieve the purpose of
listening, speaking and
reading the new words.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Show the exercise on the
PPT.
Play the recording.
2. Let students draw and
say.
1. Listen and circle.
2. Draw and say.
Let students consolidate
the words and the sentence
structures learned in this
lesson and master the
content in the application
through the activities.
Homework
1. Read the new words to your parents and copy the words.
2. Practice reading the sentences.
3. Do the exercises.
The sixth period(第六课时)
Part B Read and write & Let’s check & Let’s sing
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Read and write
·能够读懂一组句子并完成选择正确图片任务
·能够按正确的意群和语音、语调朗读这组句子
·能够在有意义的语境中抄写单元话题词汇并将句子补充完整
·能够综合运用本单元的核心词句
Let’s check ·检测本单元 A、B 部分的核心句型
·考查单元核心词汇的认读
Let’s sing ·能够了解歌词意义并能够清晰准确地歌唱
▶教学重点
1.能够读懂一组句子并完成选择正确图片的任务。
2.能够按正确的意群和语音、语调朗读这组句子。
3.能够在有意义的语境中抄写单元的话题词汇并将句子补充完整。
4.能够综合运用本单元的核心词句。
▶教学难点
能够综合运用本单元的核心词句。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、录音或视频材料。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Sing the song—My schoolbag. (出示课件)
3. Play a game—“What’s missing?”
Review the words: schoolbag, maths book, English book, Chinese book,
storybook, candy, notebook, toy, key. (课件出示:schoolbag, maths book,
English book, Chinese book, storybook, candy, notebook, toy, key,
然后一个个随机消失)
Ask students to say the missing word quickly.
4. Lead-in.
Talk about the schoolbags with students:
T: What colour is your schoolbag?
S1: It’s blue.
T: What’s in your schoolbag?
S2: An English book, a maths book, three storybooks.
…
Step 2: Presentation
1. Pre-reading.
(1)Look and say.
T: I know what is in your schoolbag. Now, I have two schoolbags.
(课件出示:教材 P19 Read and circle 中的两个书包的图片) I have many
things in the two schoolbags. Look! What are these?
Show the things on the PPT. (课件出示: 教材 P19 Read and circle
中除书包以外的所有物品分类呈现)
Teaching purpose
通过唱歌,既能复习旧
知,又能为新课学习营造轻
松愉快的氛围。
Teaching purpose
引导学生观察图片,说
出学过的词汇,并学习二会
单词 cute,为后面的阅读做
铺垫。
Teaching purpose
通过游戏让学生们复习
已经学过的词汇,为新课的
学习做好知识铺垫。
Teaching purpose
通过谈论学生书包的颜
色和书包里的物品,复习本
单元的重要句型,并引出新
课。
85
Lead students to say: a storybook, two storybooks; a car; a ball;
some candies; some toys.
(2)Learn the word “cute”. (课件出示:带有熊猫的钥匙图片闪烁)
T: What are these?
Ss: Keys.
T: How many keys?
S: Three keys.
T: Yes. The keys are with a panda. I like the panda because It’s
cute. Do you like it?
Ask students to read after the teacher: cute, cute, a cute panda.
(课件出示:带有猴子的钥匙图片闪烁)
The teacher leads students to say: a cute monkey.
Ask students to read after the teacher: cute, cute, a cute monkey.
2. While-reading.
(1)Ask and answer. (课件出示:教材 P19 Read and circle 部分的两幅
图片)
(1)Ask and answer.
T: Look at Picture A. What’s in the schoolbag?
S1: Two storybooks, three keys, some candies, some toys and a cute
panda.
T: What’s in the schoolbag in Picture B?
S2: A storybook, two keys, some candies, some toys and a cute
monkey.
(2)Listen and underline.
T: Listen to the recording and underline the words about school
things.(课件出示:教材 P19 Read and circle 部分的音频)
(3)Read and circle.
T: Read the text, then circle the correct answer.
(4)Check the answer.
Answer: A
(5)Listen again and read after the recording.
T: Now, let’s listen to the recording again and read after it.
Make sure you can read the sentences correctly. Pay attention to your
pronunciation and intonation.
(6)Show time.
Students have a reading show. Choose several reading stars. The
reading stars can get presents.
3. Post-reading.
Look, choose and write.
(1)What is in it? (课件出示:教材 P19 Look, choose and write 部分
的图片)
T: Now we can see a desk. What’s in it?
S1: An egg, a pen, a notebook and three keys.
Teaching purpose
这部分的训练内容,主
要用来培养学生们的书写能
力。
Teaching purpose
在新授环节,初步培养
学生自主阅读获取信息和处
理信息的能力,引导学生掌
握阅读技巧。
Teaching purpose
通过比赛提高学生对朗
读的兴趣,让学生从能读、会
读到规范、优美地朗读。
T: Good. We must pay attention to the words “egg” and “notebook”.
The first letter of “egg” sounds /e/. It is a vowel. So we say “an
egg”. And “keys” is the plural form. We can’t say “three key”.
We must say “three keys”.
Let students turn to page 19 in the book and fill in the blanks.
Check the answers. (出示课件)
Let a student read it.
(2)What’s in your desk?
T: Now please look at your desk. What’s in your desk?
Ss: …
T: Good. Please fill in the blank on page 19.
The teacher can walk around and make sure students write the words
correctly.
Step 3: Practice
Let’s check.
(1)Listen and number. (课件出示:教材 P20 Listen and number 中的
四幅图片)
T: Look at these pictures. They are all school things. Now, look
at Picture 1. What can you see?
S1: A pen.
T: Good. It’s a red pen. And how about Picture 2? What’s it? And
what colour is it?
S2: It’s a green schoolbag.
T: Great! What can you see in Picture 3?
S3: I can see a red schoolbag.
T: Wonderful. And what’s in the red schoolbag?
S3: A storybook and some candies.
T: Good job! Now who can say something about Picture 4?
S4: I can see a pink schoolbag. A notebook and a maths book are
in the schoolbag.
T: Very good. Let’s listen and number. (课件出示:Listen and number
的音频)
Check the answers.
Answers: 3 1 2 4
(2)①Look and circle. (课件出示:教材 P20 Look and circle 部分的
文字与图片)
T: What’s in the schoolbag? Please read and circle. You can
underline the different school things in A and B first. Then look at
the picture and circle the correct answer. Check the answer and let
students read in groups.
Answer: B
②Read and fill in the blanks.
Teaching purpose
通过两个练习,提高学
生们的阅读能力,检测学生
对上节课可数名词复数这一
语法点的掌握情况。
87
Let students look at the picture on the PPT and try to fill in the
blanks.
Check the answers. (出示课件)
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Write about your schoolbag or your pencil box.
T: What’s in your schoolbag? What’s in your pencil box? Choose
one topic and write about it. You can write like this:
T: Please write down on your exercise books. Pay attention to the
capitalizing letter before a sentence and the punctuation after a
sentence.
Show some students’ sentences in class.
Check the answers with students.
The other students check in pairs.
2. Emotional education.
T: Is your schoolbag/desk tidy or messy? Please put away your school
things in time. Keep your schoolbag or desk tidy. It’s a good habit!
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Read the text to your parents.
2. Write about your desk in your bedroom.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1 热身环节通过歌曲、游戏活动复习已经学过的单词,为新课的学习做好知识铺垫。
Teaching purpose
培养学生的综合语言运
用能力,通过将语言内化并
运用,完成语言输入到输出
的过程。
2 在阅读教学之前,对语篇认真地进行分析,明确语篇的中心内容和知识要点,找出其中的重难点词汇和
句型,明确教学目标与重难点。在阅读过程中,初步培养学生自主阅读获取信息和处理信息的能力,引导学生
掌握阅读技巧。在阅读后,通过练习加强巩固学生的语言实际运用能力和书写能力。3 在教学过程中要注重培
养学生良好规范的书写习惯。
4 板书设计呈现本课的语言支架,对学生的阅读和书写起到了很好的辅助作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Read and write
·Be able to understand a group of sentences and complete the task of selecting the right picture.
·Be able to read this group of sentences according to the correct meaning group, pronunciation
and intonation.
·Be able to copy the topic vocabulary of this unit and complete the sentences in a meaningful
context.
·Be able to use the key words and the key sentences of this unit synthetically.
Let’s check
·Check the key sentence structures of Part A and Part B of this unit.
·Examine the recognition of the key vocabulary of this unit.
Let’s sing
·Be able to understand the meaning of the lyrics and sing clearly and accurately.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand a group of sentences and complete the task of selecting the right picture.
·Be able to read this group of sentences according to the correct meaning group, pronunciation
and intonation.
·Be able to copy the topic vocabulary of this unit and complete the sentences in a meaningful
context.
·Be able to use the core words and the core sentences of this unit synthetically.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the core words and the core sentences of this unit synthetically.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
89
Warm-up
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Play the song—My schoolbag.
3. Play a game: What’s missing?
4. Lead-in.
Talk about the schoolbags with
students.
1. Greetings.
2. Sing the song—My
schoolbag.
3. Play a game: What’s
missing?
4. Talk about the
schoolbags with the
teacher.
Use the song and the
game to create a
relaxing and pleasant
learning atmosphere,
review the words
learned, and prepare
for the new lesson.
Presentation
1. Pre-reading.
(1)Look and say.
Show the pictures and lead
students to say the words.
(2)Teach the word: cute.
(1)Look at the pictures
and say the words that
students have learned.
(2)Learn the new word:
cute.
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Presentation
2. While-reading.
(1)Ask and answer.
(2)Play the recording.
(3)Read and circle.
(4)Check the answer.
(5)Play the recording again.
(6)Show time.
Choose the reading stars and
give presents.
(1)Talk about Picture A
and Picture B.
(2)Listen and underline
the words about school
things.
(3)Read the text and
circle the correct
answer.
(4)Check the answer.
(5)Listen again and read
after the recording.
(6)Show time.
Read the text in class.
Observe the pictures and
review the words that
students have learned.
Learn the new word to
prepare for reading.
Cultivate students’
ability to obtain and
process information
through independent
reading and lead them to
master reading skills.
Improve students’
reading interest so as to
achieve the purpose of
reading normatively and
gracefully.
3. Post-reading.
Look, choose and write.
(1)What is in it?
Ask the question and finish
the writing task. Check the
answers.
(2)What’s in your desk?
Lead students to finish the
writing task. Make sure they
write correctly.
Answer the questions and
fill in the blanks. Check
the answers with the
teacher.
Practice
Let’s check.
(1)Listen and number.
Lead students to say
something about the pictures.
Play the recording. Check the
answers.
(2)①Look and circle.
②Read and fill in the blanks.
Show the text and a picture.
Check the answers.
(1)Say something about the
pictures. Then listen
and number.
(2)①Look at the picture
and circle the correct
answer.
Check the answer and
read in groups.
②Look at the picture and
try to fill in the
blanks.
Check the answers.
Improve students’
reading ability and help
them grasp the grammar
point of the plural forms
of countable nouns.
(续表)
91
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Write about your schoolbag
or your pencil box.
2. Emotional education.
1. Write about your
schoolbag or your
pencil box.
2. Keep a good habit!
Cultivate students’
comprehensive language
application ability.
Finish the process from
the input to the output of
language by internalizing
and using language.
Homework
1. Read the text to your parents.
2. Write about your desk in your bedroom.
3. Do the exercises.
Unit 3 My friends
教材分析
本单元学习的主题是向他人介绍自己的好朋友,对好友的性格和外貌特征进行描述。教学
内容主要是通过展示学生们介绍好友的情景来展开的。教学重点是能够听、说、认读核心句型
“—What’s his name? —His name is Zhang Peng.”“He’s tall and strong.”“Who’s he?”
“He has glasses and his shoes are blue.”;能够听、说、认读单词“strong, friendly, quiet,
hair, shoe, glasses”。
教学目标
知识与能力目标:
句型
· 能够听、说、认读句型“—What’s his name? —His name is Zhang Peng.”“He’s tall
and strong.”“Who’s he?”“He has glasses and his shoes are blue.”
·能够在情景中运用句型“—What’s his/her name?—His/ Her name is…”“—Who’s he/ she?
—He/ She is…”询问他人的姓名或身份,并能回答
·能够在情景中运用句型“He’s/ She’s…”“He/ She has…”描述人物的性格或外貌特征
·能够按照意群朗读“He has short hair. He has a big green bag. What is his name?”
等四组句子
词汇
·能够听、说、认读单词“strong, friendly, quiet, hair, shoe, glasses”
·能够正确使用上述单词描述人物的性格或外貌特征
·能够在有意义的语境中抄写上述话题词汇
语音
·能够掌握 o-e 的发音规则,即 o-e 在单词中发长音/əʊ/
·能够读出符合 o-e 发音规则的单词,并能根据发音拼写出符合 o-e 发音规则的单词
情感态度、文化意识、学习策略目标:
·能够了解外貌描述中的文化禁忌,如:不要对同学长得胖或戴眼镜等有歧视性语言
·能够根据 o-e 的发音规则拼读单词,并能够根据 o 与 o-e 的发音规则拼写单词
课时安排
第一课时:Part A Let’s talk & Let’s play
第二课时:Part A Let’s learn & Let’s chant
第三课时:Part A Let’s spell
第四课时:Part B Let’s talk & Let’s play
第五课时:Part B Let’s learn & Say and draw
第六课时:Part B Read and write & Let’s check & Let’s sing
93
The first period(第一课时)
Part A Let’s talk & Let’s play
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s talk
·能够在图片、PPT 和老师的帮助下理解对话大意
·能够用正确的语音、语调朗读对话,并能够在小组中进行角色扮演
·能够在情景中运用句型“—What’s his/ her name? —His/ Her name is…”询问他人
姓名并能够回答;能够在情景中运用句型“He’s/She’s…”“He/ She has…”描述人
物的性格和外貌特征
·能够在语境中借助图片等理解新词“friendly, strong, his”的意思,并能够正确发音
Let’s play
·通过观察 Let’s play 板块的图片,能够依照语言示范简单描述人物的外貌特征
·能够进一步巩固对核心句型“He’s/She’s…”“—What’s his/her name? —His/ Her
name
is…”的理解与运用
▶教学重点
1. 能够在情景中运用句型“—What’s his/ her name? —His/ Her name is…”询问他人姓名并能够回
答。
2. 能够在情景中运用句型“He’s/ She’s…”“He/ She has…”描述他人的性格和外貌特征。
▶教学难点
1. 能够在情景中灵活运用核心句型询问他人姓名并回答。
2. 能够熟练描述他人的性格和外貌特征。
3. 能够正确读出“Chinese, his”的尾音。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、卡片、一块幕布等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
T: Good afternoon, boys and girls. Today let’s be good friends,
OK?
Ss: OK.
The teacher shakes hands with a student and says, “Friends,
friends, good friends.” Then students shake hands with each other and
say what the teacher says.
Ss: Friends, friends, good friends.
T: Now, tell me, “Who is your good friend?”
S1: He/ She is…
S2: …
2. Let’s do.
Teaching purpose
由教师的问候和握手交
朋友的动作展开教学,营造
轻松、愉快的学习氛围,引
出本单元的话题。说唱 chant
和猜人游戏能够调动学生的
积极性,激发他们的语言表
达欲望,使学生快速地将精
力集中到课堂上。
Show the chant on the PPT. Play the music and chant with students.
(出示课件)
3. Play a guessing game.
Pull up a curtain. Ask some students to hide behind the curtain
and put their arms or legs out of the curtain in turn. Point to one
of them and let the other students guess who he/ she is.
T: Who’s he/ she?
Ss: He/ She is…
Step 2: Presentation
1. Learn the new sentences.
(1) The teacher makes a self-introduction with the sentence “My
name’s…” and asks a boy.
T: What’s your name?
Boy: My name is…
After the boy answers the question, the teacher introduces the boy.
T: His name is… He is…
(2) The teacher asks students, “What’s his name?”
(3) The teacher inspires other students to answer the question and
writes down the sentence structure “His name is…” on the blackboard.
Ask students to pay attention to the ending sound of the word
“his/hɪz/”.
(4) The teacher points to other boys one by one and lets students
do more exercises to master the language points.
T: What’s his name?
Ss: His name is…
(5) The teacher points to a girl and says, “She’s… Her name
is…”
Then the teacher asks students, “What’s her name?”.
Let students try to answer the question. Write down the sentence
structure “Her name is…” on the blackboard.
Ask students to pay attention to the ending sound of the word
“her/hə (r)/”.
The teacher points to another girl and asks, “What’s her name?”
Let students ask and answer in pairs with the sentence structures
“—What’s her name? —Her name is…”
2. Practice the new sentences.
Teaching purpose
通过层层递进的对话,
逐渐把主动权交给学生,不
仅能对已学句型“My name’
s…”进行巩固,同时可以导
入“his”,稍加点拨,加以
强化操练。学生能很快掌握
“his”的用法,加强知识结
构的前后联系。
Teaching purpose
语言就是在不断的听说
中习得,由“My name’s…”
导入,继而操练句型“His/
Her name is…”,再在此基础
上学会问答“What’s his/her
name?”,一步一步,水到渠
成。
95
(1)Show fuzzy pictures of the two people on the PPT. (课件出
示:学生熟悉的两个人的模糊图片,这两个人分别是男人和女人或者男孩和
女孩)
T: Look! He’s/ She’s my new friend.
Let students guess the names of the two people.
Lead students to ask the question “What’s his/her name?” Show
clear pictures of the two people and reveal the names.(出示课件) Write
down the sentence “What’s his/ her name?” on the blackboard. And
emphasize the distinction between “his” and “her”.
(2)Show some students’ pictures collected in advance on the PPT.
(出示课件)
T: Look! I have some pictures. Look at this picture. Who can tell
me his/her name?
Lead students to use the sentence structure “His/ Her name is…”
to answer.
Ss: His/ Her name is…
T: Is he/ she tall/ short?
Ss: Yes.
T: Is he/ she thin?
Ss: No, he/ she is…
Do the action to show “strong”. Then write down the word
“strong” and teach it.
T: str/str/-o/ɒ/-ng/ŋ/, strong/strɒŋ/.
T: He’s/ She’s tall and strong/short and thin. And he/she is
friendly.
Write down the word “friendly” on the blackboard. Mark “-ly”
with red chalk. Teach the word.
T: friend/frend/-ly/li/, friendly .
Ask students to read it and pronounce it correctly.
Introduce the etiquette of appearance description: Replace “fat”
with “strong”.
T: We usually don’t say he/ she is fat, but he/ she is strong.
3. Let’s talk.
(1)Show a picture of John on the PPT. (出示课件)
T: What’s his name?
Ss: His name is John.
Show a picture of John’s mum on the PPT. (出示课件)
T: She is John’s mother. What are they talking about?
Ss: … (Guess.)
T: They are talking about John’s new friend. Who is he/she?
(2)Show the questions one by one on the PPT.
①Does John have a Chinese friend?
T: We are all Chinese, because we are all from China.
Teaching purpose
通过上面几个环节全面
系统地学习本课的单词和句
型,让学生在小组中、在师
生操练中反复认知并再现新
句型,以完成教学目标。
Teaching purpose
通过课文图片和问题的
呈现,引导学生听录音并理
解对话内容。通过观看录像,
调动学生的视觉、听觉和记
忆力,提高他们参与语言活
动的积极性。
Point to the Chinese flag on the wall to help students understand
the word “Chinese”.
Then teach the word “Chinese”.
T: Ch/tʃ/-i/aɪ/-nese/ni:z/, Chinese .
②What’s John’s friend’s name?
③Is John’s friend tall and strong?
(3)Play the video of “Let’s talk” on the PPT. Let students
watch the video with questions. (课件出示:教材 P24 Let’s talk 板
块的视频)
Ask students to underline the sentences about the answers in their
books and answer the questions in class. Then check the answers
together.
4. Listen, read and act.
(1) Let students listen to the recording and read after it.(出
示课件)
(2) Lead students to act out the dialogue in pairs.
Step 3: Practice
1. Let’s play.
Show the picture of “Let’s play” on the PPT. (出示课件)
T: We have four new friends today. Can you introduce them to me?
Ss: His name is… He’s…/ Her name is… She’s…
T: Good. Now let me describe them, and you say out the names. She’s
tall and thin. What’s her name?
Ss: Her name is Lucy.
T: Where is she?
Ss: …
T: Yes, there she is. (Do the action to point at Lucy on the screen.)
Let students quickly name the characters according to the
teacher’s description. Finally point to the character and say the
sentence “Oh, there she/ he is.”
Then lead students to ask and answer in pairs. One describes and
asks, the other answers.
2. Play a game—“Find a friend.”
Divide students into groups of four. Let each student write down
a classmate’s name on the card. The back of the card is facing up.
Let a student in each group pick a card randomly and describe the student
on
the card one by one. The rest of the group guess who the student is
according to the description.
Make a model:
Teaching purpose
通过完成 Let’s play 和
“找朋友”活动,进一步巩
固对核心句型“He’s/
She’s…”“His name is…”
“—What’s his/her name?
—His/ Her name is…”的理
解和运用。
97
A: My friend is a boy. He’s thin. He has short hair. He likes maths.
Who’s he?
B & C & D: His name is…
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
Play a game—“Draw my friend.”
Present a passage on the PPT. Lead students to read the passage.
Then ask students to draw a portrait on the blackboard one by one. Each
one draws a brushstroke to complete the portrait.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Practice the dialogue.
2. Introduce the friend to parents with the key sentence structures.
3. Do the exercises.(见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 本课时主要学习描述他人的性格和外貌特征。课程开始,通过复习和巩固句型“My name is…”导入
新词“his, her”并稍加练习,学生能很快地掌握句型“What’s his/ her name?”并用句型“His/ Her name
is…”进行作答。
2. 活动设计丰富,易操作,且具备层次感,有效地提升了学生的核心素养。
3. 猜人和绘画活动活跃了课堂氛围,调动了学生的学习积极性,加强了师生交流。活动既有合作又有竞
争,取得了不错的教学效果。
4. 突出语用功能,联系学生的实际情况,设置多个环节,层层深入,帮助学生在真实情景中灵活地操练
所学语言。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s talk
· Be able to understand the meaning of the dialogue with the help of photos, PPT and the teacher.
Teaching purpose
通过学生喜欢的画画
活动,让他们发挥自己的绘
画技能,画出人物,并用本
课的核心句型做介绍,提升
语言运用的真实性。
· Be able to read the dialogue with the correct pronunciation and intonation. And be able to act
out
the dialogue in the groups.
· Be able to use the sentence structures to ask and answer the names and describe the characters
in situations.
· Be able to understand the new words “friendly, strong, his” in context and pronounce them
correctly.
Let’s play
· Be able to describe the characters’ appearances simply according to the language demonstration
by observing the pictures of “Let’s play”.
· Be able to further consolidate the understanding and application of the key sentence structures.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to ask and answer about names with the key sentence structures in real situations.
·Be able to use the key sentence structures to describe the characteristics of others in real
situations.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the key sentence structures flexibly to ask and answer about names in real situations.
·Be able to use the key sentence structures to describe the characteristics of others expertly.
·Be able to pronounce the ending sound of the tail of “Chinese, his” correctly.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Presentation
1. Learn the new sentences.
(1)Make a
self-introduction.
Ask a boy about his
name. Introduce the
boy.
(2)Ask students about the
(1) Listen to the teacher.
(2) Listen and answer the
name.
(3) Learn the sentence
structure “His name
is…” Pay attention to
the pronunciation of
Through progressive
dialogues, help
students review and
consolidate the
sentence structure
“My name’s…” and
quickly grasp the
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Let’s do.
Show the chant on the PPT.
Play the music and chant.
3. Play a guessing game.
1. Greetings.
2. Chant with the teacher.
3. Guess who’s behind the
curtain.
Create a teaching
atmosphere through
greetings and games.
99
boy’s name.
(3)Teach the sentence
structure “His name
is…”
(4)Let students do more
exercises.
(5)Teach the sentence
structures with the
girls’ names.
“his”.
(4) Do more exercises.
(5) Ask and answer in pairs
with the sentence
structures.
usage of “his,
her”. Enhance the
linkages of
knowledge.
2. Practice the new
sentences.
(1) Show fuzzy character
pictures and let
students guess the
names.
(2) Show pictures of some
students and ask
questions.
(1) Guess who the characters
in the pictures are.
Learn how to use “his”
and “her”.
(2) Practice the sentence
structures to introduce
others.
Make students learn
the vocabulary and
the sentence
structures of this
lesson synthetically
and systematically.
Let students
practice new
sentence structures
in various forms to
achieve teaching
aims.
3. Let’s talk.
(1)Show the pictures of
John and his mum and
talk about them.
(2)Show the questions on
the PPT. Interpret and
teach“Chinese”.
(3)Play the video of
“Let’s talk” on the
PPT. Check the
answers.
(1) Talk about the pictures
of John and his mum.
(2) Read the questions and
learn “Chinese”.
(3) Watch the video with
questions. Then answer
the questions and check
the answers.
By presenting texts
and questions, lead
students to
understand the
dialogue. By
watching the video,
let students take
part in the language
activity with
visual, auditory and
memory.
4. Listen, read and act.
(1)Play the recording.
(2)Lead students to act
out the dialogue.
(1) Listen to the recording
and read after it.
(2) Practice and act out the
dialogue in pairs.
Help students master
correct
pronunciation and
intonation.
Practice
1. Let’s play.
Show the picture and
give students an
explanation.
2. Play a game—“Find a
friend.”
1. Listen to the teacher and
answer his/ her
questions. Ask and answer
in pairs.
2. Play the game.
Practice the key
sentence structures.
Further strengthen
the understanding
and application of
them.
Consolidation Play a game—“Draw my Read the passage on the PPT. Increase the
&
Extension
friend.”
Show a passage on the PPT.
Draw a portrait on the
blackboard one by one.
authenticity of
language use.
Homework
1. Practice the dialogue.
2. Introduce the friend to parents with the key sentences.
3. Do the exercises.
The second period(第二课时)
Part A Let’s learn & Let’s chant
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s learn
·能够听、说、认读单词“tall, strong, short, thin, friendly, quiet”
·能够在情景中熟练运用句型“He’s/ She’s…”介绍人物的性格和外貌特征
·能够运用句型“Who is he/ she?”询问他人的姓名,并能回答
Let’s chant ·能够通过有节奏的说唱强化单词的音义联系,并增加课堂的趣味性
·能理解歌谣中对人物外貌和性格特征的描述,并能创编新的歌谣描述自己的朋友
▶教学重点
1. 能够掌握描述人物特点的词汇。
2. 能够用以上词汇简单描述他人的性格和外貌特征。
▶教学难点
1. 能够在情景中熟练运用句型“He’s…”介绍人物的性格和外貌特征。
2. 能够掌握单词“friendly, quiet”的发音。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、单词卡片等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Revision.
(1) Point to a boy and ask his name in rhyme. Ask students to answer
in rhyme, too.
T:(Clap hands.)What’s his name? What’s his name?
Ss: His name is… His name is…
T: What’s her name? What’s her name?(Clap hands and point to
a girl.)
Ss: Her name is… Her name is…
(2) Play a game—“I say, you do”. (课件出示:一段有节奏的背景
音乐)
Teaching purpose
以上节课中学习的询问
他人姓名的重点句型开始课
程,起到“温故”的作用。
同时,以带有游戏趣味的韵
句进行交流,能够极大地激
发学生的学习兴趣,让课堂
氛围更加热烈,更有益于学
生的英语学习。
101
T: Boys and girls, now I say, you do. Make yourself tall.
Ss: Tall, tall, tall. (Students stand up and say while they do it.)
T: Make yourself short. / Make your arms long. / Make your eyes
big. /…
Ss: Short, short, short! / Long, long, long! / Big, big, big! /…
3. Watch and act.
Play the video of “Let’s talk”. (课件出示:教材 P24 Let’s talk
板块的视频) Let students watch it and act out the dialogue in pairs.
4. Lead-in.
T: John has a good friend. I have a good friend, too. Do you want
to know what his/ her name is?
Step 2: Presentation
1. Learn the sentences.
T: I have a good friend in our class. He is a boy. He’s tall and
strong. He’s in Group 4. Guess! What’s his name?
Describe the appearance of a student in the class simply. If other
students can’t guess who he is, lead them to ask, “What’s his name?”
T: You can also ask me, “Who is he?”
Write down the sentences “What’s his name?” “Who is he?” on
the blackboard.
2. Let’s learn.
(1)Learn the words “tall, strong, short, thin”.
Ask a student to come to the front of the classroom and introduce
him as a good friend.
Then invite another student who is completely different from the
boy before. Ask other students to observe their differences in figure.
Lead in the words “tall, strong, short, thin”.
Show the word cards in turn. Teach these words. Ask students to
read after the teacher.
Let students point to the classmates and use the sentence structure
“He’s/ She’s…” to describe others.
(2)Learn the phrases “tall and strong, short and thin”.
Point to the tall and strong boy on the podium. Lead students to
say the sentences “He’s tall.” and “He’s strong.”
Then the teacher says “He’s tall and strong.” Ask students to
read the sentence after the teacher.
Practice the sentence “He’s short and thin.” in the same way.
(3) Learn the word “quiet”.
Teaching purpose
通过对上一节课内容的
角色扮演,复习旧知识,为
导入新课做好准备。
Teaching purpose
教师播放录音,学生听
录音跟读,训练其认真倾听
且在倾听过程中获取重要信
息的能力。让学生跟读,以
掌握单词的正确读音。
The teacher makes a gesture with the index finger to keep students
quiet and says the sentence “Be quiet!” Then show the word card
“quiet” and read it, qu/kw/-i/aɪ/-e/ə/-t/t/, quiet . Then
paste the card onto the blackboard. Help students understand the
meaning of the word “quiet”. Lead students to use the word “quiet”
to make sentences in the real situations.
(4) Learn the word “friendly”.
Show pictures of some activities on the PPT and ask, “Who is
friendly?”
Explain the exact meaning of the word “friendly” through the
movement or the expression.
(5) Play and watch.
Play the video of “Let’s learn” on the PPT.(课件出示:教材
P25 Let’s learn 板块的视频)Let students watch it.
Play it again. Ask students to imitate after it and read the words
and the sentences over and over again.
The teacher describes John with the sentences “I have a good friend.
He’s short and thin.”
Lead boys to ask, “Who is he?” Lead girls to guess who he is and
use the sentence “His name is John.” to answer.
Ask students to choose a person from the pictures of this section
and practice the dialogue in pairs. Then let students act it out.
Step 3: Practice
1. I point, you say.
Show the words at random on the PPT. (出示课件) Ask students to
say out the words quickly.
T: I will point to the words one by one on the PPT. Please say out
the words quickly. Let’s go! What’s this?
Ss: …
2. I say, you do.
The teacher speaks the words and asks students to perform
corresponding actions.
T: This time, I say, you do. When I say the word “tall”, please
do like this.(Raise the arms up.)When I say the word “short”, please
do
Teaching purpose
三组活动不断升级,将
新词的词义、词形及读音相
统一,保证学生能够正确认
读单词。这些活动会不断地
重复操练新词的读音,这有
助于他们熟练地掌握单词。
103
like this.(Put the arms down.)When I say the word “strong”, please
do like this.(Raise the fists up.)And this is for “thin”. (Put the
hands on the both sides of cheeks.) Are you ready? Let’s play.
3. I do, you say.
T: Now let’s exchange. I do, you say.
4. Let’s chant.
Show the pictures of Lily and Tim in the chant on the PPT. (课
件出示:教材 P25 Let’s chant 板块中的人物图片) Help students describe
Lily and Tim with the words they have learned and the sentence structure
“He/She is…”
Play the chant separately.(出示课件)Let students read the chant
after the recording.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Make a competition.
Let students chant in different ways to make a competition. Remind
students to do some actions while they’re chanting.
2. Create a new chant.
Encourage students to replace the adjectives in the chant according
to the true situations of friends. Create a new chant and perform it
in class.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Copy the words learned in this lesson five times in four lines and three grids.
2. Draw your parents and describe them in English.
3. Do the exercises.(见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 在韵句中,复习上一课的句型,极大地激发了学生的学习兴趣。
2. “我指你说”“我说你做”等一连串的活动贯穿授新和操练过程,尽可能地让学生的多种感官参与到
此学习过程中来,大大提高了学习效率。
3. 学习单词的目的就是能把单词灵活地运用到句子中去,使表达更加完整,同时把单词运用到句子中也
能巩固所学的单词,两者之间相辅相成,相互促进。
4. 板书设计清晰明了,重点突出,起到了很好的辅助作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Teaching purpose
通过观察人物的特征,
选择正确的词汇来形容他
们,帮助学生正确理解并使
用新学的词汇。
Teaching purpose
话题继续延伸,将创编
歌谣活动与实际相结合,鼓
励学生发挥自己的想象力和
主观能动性,培养他们的英
语思维。
Let’s learn
· Be able to listen, speak and read the words “tall, strong, short, thin, friendly, quiet”.
· Be able to use the sentence structure “He’s/She’s … ” to introduce the charcters’
personalities and appearances in situations.
· Be able to use the sentence structure “Who is he/ she?” to ask someone’s name and be able
to answer.
Let’s chant
· Be able to strengthen the phonetic connection of words and increase the interest of the lesson
through rhythmic chant.
· Be able to understand the description of the characters’ appearances and personalities in the
chant and create a new chant about friends.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Master the words that describe characters’ characteristics.
·Be able to simply describe the appearances and personalities of others with the above words.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the sentence structure “He’s/ She’s…” skillfully in real situations.
·Be able to master the pronunciations of the words “friendly, quiet”.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Revision.
Ask in rhyme and do the
actions. Play the game.
1. Greetings.
2. Answer in rhyme and do
the actions as the
teacher’s instruction.
This activity can
refresh the knowledge
learned before and
stimulate students’
interest in learning.
3. Watch and act.
Play the video of “Let’s
talk”.
4. Lead-in.
3. Watch it and act out the
dialogue in pairs.
4. Listen to the teacher.
Through role-playing
activities, review old
knowledge and lead in
new knowledge.
105
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Presentation
1. Learn the sentences.
Create a situation. Teach
the sentences “What’s
his name?” “Who is
he?”
Listen to the teacher’s
description and guess who he
is. Learn the sentences.
Introduce the new
sentences.
2. Let’s learn.
(1) Teach the words “tall,
strong, short, thin”.
(2) Teach the phrases and
lead students to say the
sentences to express the
appearance of the
character.
(3) Teach the word
“quiet”.
(4) Show pictures of
different activities on
the PPT to help students
understand the meaning
of “friendly”.
(5) Play the video of
“Let’s learn” on the
PPT.
(1) Learn the new words.
Make sentences to
describe classmates.
(2) Learn the phrases and
practice the sentences.
(3) Understand the meaning
of “quiet” and learn
how to use it.
(4) Understand the meaning
of “friendly” and
learn how to use it.
(5) Read the words and the
sentences repeatedly.
Practice the dialogue
and act it out.
Help students master
the correct
pronunciation of the
words by comparing,
observing and
listening.
Practice
1. I point, you say.
Show the words at random
on the PPT.
2. I say, you do.
Speak the adjectives.
3. I do, you say.
Do the actions.
4. Let’s chant.
Show the pictures of Lily
and Tim in the chant on
the PPT. Play the chant.
1. Quickly say out the words
on the PPT.
2. Do the corresponding
actions.
3. Say the corresponding
words.
4. Use the words and the
sentence structures they
have learned to describe
the characteristics.
Listen to the chant,
follow it and chant
together.
Get students to grasp
the words from shape,
meaning and
pronunciation
through three groups
of activities. Help
students understand
and use the new
vocabulary
correctly.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Make a competition.
Let students chant in
different ways to make a
1. Chant in different ways.
2. Create a new chant.
Act it out in class.
Extend the topic.
Combine the creative
activity with the
competition.
2. Create a new chant.
real situation.
Encourage students
to use their
imagination and
initiative.
Cultivate their
English thinking.
Homework
1. Copy the words learned in this lesson five times in four lines and three girds.
2. Draw your parents and describe them in English.
3. Do the exercises.
The third period(第三课时)
Part A Let’s spell
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s spell
·能够感知并归纳 o-e 在单词中的发音规则
·能够读出符合 o-e 发音规则的单词
·能够根据单词的读音拼写出符合 o-e 发音规则的单词
▶教学重点
1. 能够感知并归纳 o-e 在单词中的发音规则。
2. 能够读出符合 o-e 发音规则的单词。
▶教学难点
能够根据单词的读音拼写出符合 o-e 发音规则的单词。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、语音例词单词卡等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Lead-in
1. Enjoy a song.
Play the song—Friends. Ask students to sing after the recording.
(出示课件)
2. Let’s chant.
Play the chant for “i-e” in Unit 2 on the PPT. Get students to
chant together. (课件出示:教材 P16 Let’s spell 板块中 Read, listen
and chant 部分的 chant 内容)
Play the chant for short sound of “o” on the PPT. Get students
to chant together. (课件出示:PEP 三下教材 P40 Let’s spell 板块中
Listen,repeat and chant 部分的 chant 内容)
Teaching purpose
以歌曲来热身,可以使
学生在韵律中集中注意力,
并激发学生的学习兴趣,让
学生在轻松欢快的氛围中准
备本课内容的学习。吟唱两
首和 i-e 及 o 相关的歌谣,在
律动中复习 o 的短音发音规
律,为本节课的语音教学做
铺垫。
Teaching purpose
逐步出示语音例词,使
学生在语境中理解词汇的含
义。
107
Step 2: Presentation
1. Read the words.
T: Today, we have a new friend. Look!
Show the picture of Mr Jones on the PPT.(课件出示:教材 P26 Mr Jones
的图片)Lead in the words of this section.
T: Who is he?
Ss: He is Mr Jones.
T: Yes, he is Mr Jones. “j” sounds /dʒ/, “o-e” sounds /əʊ/,
“n” sounds /n/, “s” sounds /z/. Read after me.
Ss: …
Write down “Mr Jones” on the blackboard.
T: (Point at Mr Jones’ nose.) What’s this?
Ss: It is Mr Jones’ nose.
T: Yes, it’s his nose, nose, nose. n/n/-o/əʊ/-s/z/.Write down the
word “nose” on the blackboard.
T: Touch your nose, please.
Let students do the action.
Show another picture on the PPT.
T: And what’s in Mr Jones’ left hand?
Ss: It’s a note.
T: Good! We write notes on our notebooks. And this is Coke. (Point
at the Coke in Mr Jones’ right hand.) Do you like Coke?
Write down the words “note, Coke” on the blackboard.
Ask students to read after the teacher and practice in groups.
2. Find out the rules.
T: Look at these words on the blackboard. What can you find?
S1: They have the same letter “o”.
S2: They have the same letter “e”.
T: Yes. They all have “o-e”. The letter “e” at the end is silent.
What is the sound of the “o-e”? Let’s read and find.
The teacher reads each word slowly with students.
T: What is the sound?
Ss: …
T: Yes, it’s /əʊ/. Look at my mouth and read after me.
Lead students to summarize the pronunciation rule of “o-e”.
Present the rule on the PPT.
Teaching purpose
通过拼读,让学生自己
发现字母的发音规则,再模
仿口型,获得正确的发音方
式。
3. Read, listen and chant.
Ask students to look at the pictures of “Read, listen and chant”
carefully. Then play the recording of this part. (出示课件)
Let students listen to it carefully. Next, show the listening
material. (出示课件) Ask students to read it after the recording and
circle the words with “o-e”. At last, lead students to chant freely
with clapping their hands.
4. Act out.
Get students to act out the chant together.
Step 3: Practice
1. Guess the words.
The teacher says the four words one by one in silence. The students
guess the words by observing the teacher’s mouth and say them out
loudly.
2. Listen and do.
The teacher gives out the word cards to students and says the words
at random. The students listen to the teacher and raise up the
corresponding word cards.
3. Read, listen and tick.
Present the four groups of words on the PPT. (课件出示: 教材 P26
Read, listen and tick 部分的练习) Get students to observe them and
discuss the similarities and the differences.
Let students read the four groups of words. Remind students to pay
attention to the different pronunciations of “o” and “o-e”. “o-e”
sounds
/ əʊ/ in the open syllable, and “o” sounds /ɒ/ in the closed syllable.
Play the recording and ask students to choose the words they hear.
(课件出示:教材 P26 Read, listen and tick 部分的音频)
Play the recording again. Check the answers together with students.
Answers: 1. note 2. home 3. dog 4. lost
4. Listen, circle and write.
(1) Let students look at the pictures in this section and try to
predict the content of the listening.
(2) Let students look at the standard writing of the word “dog”
in the textbook. Then read the word.
T: d/d/-o/ɒ/-g/g/, dog/dɒg/.
Teaching purpose
学生先倾听韵句,初步
感受韵句内容。然后跟读,
获取正确的语音。自由吟唱
可以使学生以自己喜欢的方
式操练韵句,以达到熟练说
韵句的目的。
Teaching purpose
通过观察教师口型来猜
单词,有助于学生感受 o-e
在单词中的发音并掌握 o-e
的发音方法。
Teaching purpose
这个活动检验学生能否
听懂所学的语音例词,提高
学生的听音、辨音能力。
Teaching purpose
此活动将单词的读音与
词形结合起来,使学生在准
确辨音的基础上,区分并掌
握单词的词形。
Teaching purpose
学生先根据听到单词的
读音判断其属于闭音节还是
开音节,圈出相应的代表符
号,再在四线三格上写一写
单词。一方面可以体会单词
109
Lead students to find the letter “o” is in a closed syllable,
so “o” sounds /ɒ/ here.
(3) Play the recording of this section. (出示课件) Get students
to judge what they hear is the open syllable(o-e) or the closed syllable
(o).
(4) Let them circle the right answers, and write down the words
they hear.
Properly remind students to write English words correctly.
Answers: 1. dog 2. nose 3. mom 4. note
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Spell the words.
Show more words on the PPT, such as smoke, phone, joke… Ask
students to try to read the words according to the pronunciation rule
of “o-e”.
Show more words on the PPT, such as dog, box, fox… Ask students
to try to read the words according to the pronunciation rule of “o”.
2. Chant together.
(1)Show a chant on the PPT. Let students try to sing the chant.
(2)Act out the chant.
Give students some time to practice it. Encourage them to add their
own actions. Let them work in groups and choose the ways they like to
chant creatively.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Read “Let’s spell” three times after the recording.
Teaching purpose
通过韵句来完整呈现本
课的重点语音知识。让学生
在逐句的跟读中不断重复、
强调 o-e 和 o 在单词中的发
音,为总结并巩固其发音规
律奠定基础。
2. Do the exercises.(见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 本节语音课主要教学元音字母“o”在重读开音节中的发音规则。在教学音标时,充分调动学生的积极
性,让学生在不断地感知和练习中自己总结发音规律。
2. 通过“看口型猜单词”“听音找单词”“听音写单词”活动,将所学知识运用于实践中,提高学生参
与课堂学习的意识,调动其学习热情。
3. 通过听一听、读一读等多种形式来反复练习,让学生在听和读中找出发音规律及拼写规律,很好地培
养了学生的分析能力和归纳总结能力。
4. 通过创编 chant,将发音规则融入活泼的韵句中,降低了学生学习的难度。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s spell
· Be able to perceive and generalize the pronunciation rule of “o-e” in the words.
· Be able to read the words that conform to the pronunciation rule of “o-e”.
· Be able to spell the words that conform to the pronunciation rule of “o-e” according to the
words’ pronunciations.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to perceive and generalize the pronunciation rule of “o-e” in the words.
·Be able to read the words that conform to the pronunciation rule of “o-e”.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to spell the words that conform to the pronunciation rule of “o-e” according to the
words’ pronunciations.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Lead-in
1. Enjoy a song—Friends.
2. Let’s chant.
Play the two chants learned.
1. Listen to the song and
sing after the
recording.
2. Chant together.
Warming up with a song
can help students focus
their attention on the
rhythm and stimulate
students’ interest in
learning. Through
chanting, help students
review the
pronunciation rule of
“o”.
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Presentation 1. Read the words.
Play the PPT. Talk with
Watch the PPT and talk with
the teacher. Then read the
Present the example
words step by step.
111
students and lead in the
example words.
example words after the
teacher and practice in
groups.
Make students
understand the
meaning of the words
in the context.
2. Find out the rules.
Summarize the
pronunciation rule of
“o-e”.
Find out the pronunciation
rule of “o-e”. Imitate the
teacher’s pronunciation
and accent.
By spelling, let
students find out the
pronunciation rule
by themselves and get
the right way to
pronounce.
3. Read, listen and chant.
Play the recording of
“Read, listen and
chant” three times.
At the first time, listen
carefully. At the second
time, read after the
recording. At the third
time, chant freely.
Get students to
listen to the chant
and feel the content
of the chant. Then
repeat after the
recording to get the
correct
pronunciation.
4. Act out. Act out the chant together.
Get students to
practice the chant in
the ways they like to
help them speak the
chant fluently.
Practice
1. Guess the words.
Say the words one by one
in silence.
Guess the words by observing
the teacher’s mouth and say
them out loudly.
Help students feel
the pronunciation of
“o-e” in the words.
2. Listen and do.
Give out the word cards.
Say the words at random.
Listen to the teacher, and
raise up the corresponding
word cards.
Improve students’
ability of listening
and identifying
phonetic symbols.
3. Read, listen and tick.
Get students to observe
the similarities and the
differences of the four
groups of words.
Play the recording.
Check the answers.
Talk about the similarities
and the differences of the
words. Read the words.
Listen and choose the words
they hear. Check the
answers.
Enable students to
distinguish and
master the form of
words on the basis of
accurate
pronunciations.
4. Listen, circle and
write.
Play the recording and
instruct students to
complete the tasks.
Look at the pictures in this
section. Circle the right
answers, and then write down
the words.
Further experience
the pronunciation
rules of “o” and
“o-e” in the words
when they write.
Consolidation 1. Spell the words. Try to read the words Help students master
&
Extension
Show more words on the
PPT.
according to the
pronunciation rules.
the pronunciation
rules of the letter
“o” and “o-e”.
2. Chant together.
(1) Show a chant on the PPT.
(2) Lead students to
practice the chant in
groups.
(1) Learn to sing the chant.
(2) Act the chant out.
Consolidate the
pronunciation rules
of“o-e”and“o”
through chanting.
Homework 1. Read “Let’s spell” three times after the recording.
2. Do the exercises.
The fourth period(第四课时)
Part A Let’s talk & Let’s play
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s talk
·能够在图片、PPT 和老师的帮助下理解对话大意
·能够用正确的语音、语调朗读对话,并能够在小组中进行角色扮演
·能够在情景中恰当运用句型“He has…and his…”描述外貌特征
·能够在语境中理解新词“or, right, glasses, shoes”的意思,并能正确发音
·重点关注 glasses 和 shoes 的末尾-es 和-s 的发音
Let’s play ·能够根据语言支架创编对话,综合运用目标语言
·能够根据描述判断出与之相应的人物
▶教学重点
1. 能够理解对话大意。
2. 能够用正确的语音、语调朗读对话,并能够在小组中进行角色扮演。
3. 能够运用重点句型描述他人的外貌以及其他特征。
▶教学难点
1. 能够在语境中理解新词“or, right, glasses, shoes”的意思,并能正确发音。
2. 能够掌握单词“is/ are, has/ have”的用法。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、卡片等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Lead-in
1. Sing a chant.
Play the video of “Let’s chant” on page 25.(课件出示:教材
P25 Let’s chant 板块的视频)Get students to sing together.
Teaching purpose
以学生们熟悉的 chant
来开始课程,为学生营造一
个欢快的英语学习氛围,并
为下一环节的学习做好知识
准备。
113
T: Do you remember the chant about friends? Let’s sing the chant
together.
2. Lead-in.
Show three characters on the PPT. (课件出示:矮个男孩 John 穿蓝
色鞋子;双胞胎姐妹 Lucy 和 Lily,Lucy 高个子,穿红色鞋子,Lily 也是高
个子,穿黑色鞋子)
Lead students to find clues by asking the teacher to guess who the
teacher’s friend is.
Ss: Is your friend a boy?
T: No, she is a girl.
Ss: Is she tall?
T: Yes, she is.
Ss: Is she Lucy?
T: No. Look at the shoes. (Point to the shoes, and help students
know the meaning of “shoes”.)
Write down the word “shoes” on the blackboard and read it. Get
students to know “es” sounds /z/ here.
T: Her shoes are black. (Say the colour of the friend’s shoes.)
Ss: She is Lily.
T: Yes, you’re right. Lucy’s shoes are red. Lily’s shoes are
black. And we can say:
Her shoes are red. (Point at Lucy.)
Her shoes are black. (Point at Lily.)
His shoes are blue. (Point at John.)
Then write down the sentence structure “His/Her shoes are…” on
the blackboard.
Step 2: Presentation
1. Let’s talk.
(1) Show the pictures of “Let’s talk”. (课件出示:教材 P27 Let’s
talk 板块的图片) Talk about the dialogue with students. Ask students
to predict the main idea of the dialogue.
T: Who are they?
Ss: They are Mike and John.
T: What are they talking about? Guess!
S1: Maybe they are talking about friends.
S2: …
…
T: You know about my new friend. What about Mike’s new friend?
Who is he or she? Let’s listen to the recording with the questions,
underline the key sentences about the questions, then answer the
questions.
Teaching purpose
通过学生问、教师答的
猜人游戏,引出本课的重要
内容,使学生能够在语境中
理解本课的重点词汇,同时
理解重点句型的意思及用
法。
Teaching purpose
通过两轮问题的展示,
让学生对即将学习的内容充
满阅读兴趣。学生带着问题
听录音和看动画,一方面可
以集中注意力,另一方面可
以训练在倾听时抓住关键信
息的能力。听后的讨论使学
生能够更好地理解对话的内
容,并能正确理解新词汇的
意义。
Show the question and the pictures of different characters on the
PPT. (课件出示:张鹏、吴一凡和陈杰的图片)
Questions: Who is Mike’s new friend? A boy or girl?
Play the recording.(课件出示:教材 P27 Let’s talk 板块的音频)
T: Who is Mike’s new friend? A boy or girl?
Ss: A boy.
T: Who’s he? Zhang Peng?
Ss: No.
T: Is he Wu Yifan?
S: Yes. You’re right.
Write down the word “or” and the sentence “Who is he?” on the
blackboard, and teach them.
Tell students how to answer the questions with “or”.
(2)Show the questions on the PPT:
①Is Mike’s friend a boy or a girl?
②Is he tall and thin?
③Who is tall and thin, too?
④What colour are Wu Yifan’s shoes?
⑤Does he have glasses?
Show the picture and the word “glasses” on the PPT.(课件出示:
glasses 的相关内容)Teach the word and ask students to pay attention
to the pronunciation of “es”.
Play the cartoon on the PPT.(出示课件)Lead students to watch it
carefully and discuss the dialogue, then answer the questions.
T: Is Mike’s friend a boy or a girl?
Ss: A boy.
T: Is he tall and thin?
Ss: Yes. You’re right.
T: Who is tall and thin, too?
Ss: Zhang Peng.
T: What colour are Wu Yifan’s shoes?
Ss: His shoes are blue.
T: Does he have glasses?
Ss: Yes. He has glasses.
T: Yes. He has glasses. And I have glasses, too.
Write down the word “has”. Remind students to pay attention to
the usage of “has/ have”.
Point to the boy or the girl wearing glasses in the classroom. Lead
students to say the sentence “He/ She has glasses.”
2. Read after the recording.
Play the recording again. (出示课件) Ask students to follow it and
pay attention to the pronunciation and the intonation.
3. Act out in pairs.
Teaching purpose
通过播放对话录音,并
让学生跟读,保证学生能够
正确朗读对话内容。分角色
表演课文,一方面使学生能
够正确流利地朗读课文,另
一方面也能进一步熟悉重点
句型的表达。
115
Get students to read the dialogue freely. Then ask them to act it
out in pairs and find the best pair.
Step 3: Practice
1. Make a new dialogue.
Ask students to make a new dialogue with the main sentence
structures in this lesson and talk in pairs.
2. Guess! Who’s he/ she?
(1)Show several characters that students are familiar with in
turn on the PPT. Let students try to describe their characteristics
in groups.
T: Look at this man. Can you say something about him? Please have
a try.
Make a model:
T: He is a man. He is tall and thin. He has glasses. His shoes are
black. His bag is blue. Who’s he? Is he…?
Ss: … (If students are right, the teacher says, “Yes. You’re
right.”)
(2)Show time.
S1: He/ She is… He/ She has… His/ Her shoes are… His/ Her bag
is…
S2: …
3. Let’s play.
T: (课件出示:教材 P27 Let’s play 板块的图片及文字) Boys and girls,
we all have good friends. Look at the picture. Please talk about your
friends in pairs with the key sentence structures.
S1: He is a boy. He has… His shoes are… His bag is… What’s his
name?
S2: He is…
S1: Yes. You’re right. What about your friend?
S2: She is a girl. She has… Her shoes are… Her bag is… What’s
her name?
S1: …
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
“Little policeman/ policewoman”—Looking for the lost child.
Divide students into three groups. Select one student from each
group to play the role of the mother or father. Ask the selected student
to describe the physical feature of her/ his lost child and the others
help her/ him find the child.
Make a model with a student:
T (mother): Help me! I lost my baby.
S1: A boy or girl?
T: …
Teaching purpose
以游戏的方式进行重点
句型的练习,通过句型与人
物特征的匹配,使重点句型
的操练在真实语境中进行,
帮助学生能够真正理解并掌
握重点句型的意思及用法。
Teaching purpose
在游戏中操练,可以给
学生提供描述人物的机会。
教师给出语言支架,让学生
能够正确地使用所学词汇和
句型来描述人物的特征。
Teaching purpose
通过不同角色的描述与
猜测,让学生能够使用学过
的句型,并在交流过程中加
深对对话的理解。在完成“找
人”的活动中,可以加强目
标语的训练和加大语言的输
入和输出量。
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Read after the recording of “Let’s talk” three times.
2. Describe one of your best friends to your parents.
3. Do the exercises.(见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 由 chant 引入,引领学生进入课堂,激起学生的学习兴趣。紧接着由猜人游戏引出本课的重要句型。
2. 通过创设真实的情境,引导学生从听、说、演开始,到最后能运用所学语言,完成活动“寻找走失的
孩子”。
3. 教学中注重新旧知识之间的渗透,培养学生综合运用语言的能力。
4. 在实践中,注意分层教学,因材施教,用最有效的方式激发学生主动参与,培养他们独立思考和合作
探究的创新精神。
5. 板书设计清晰明了,重点突出,起到了很好的辅助作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s talk
· Be able to understand the main idea of the dialogue with the help of the pictures, the PPT and
the teacher.
· Be able to read the dialogue with correct pronunciation and intonation. And be able to role play
in groups.
· Be able to use the sentence structure“He has…and his…”properly to describe the appearance
characteristics in the situation.
· Be able to understand the meanings of the new words“or, right, glasses, shoes”in context and
pronounce them correctly.
· Pay attention to the ending sounds according to of the words“glasses”and“shoes”.
Let’s play
· Be able to create dialogues according to the language scaffolds and use the target language
synthetically.
· Be able to judge the corresponding characters according to the descriptions.
117
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand the main idea of the dialogue.
·Be able to read the dialogue with correct pronunciation and intonation and role play in groups.
·Be able to use the key sentence structures to describe the appearances and other characteristics.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to understand the meanings of the new words “or, right, glasses, shoes” in context
and pronounce them correctly.
·Be able to master the usage of the words“is/ are”and“has/ have”.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Lead-in
1. Sing a chant.
2. Lead-in.
Show three characters on the
PPT.
Talk about the characters with
students.
1. Sing a chant together.
2. Look for clues by asking
the teacher to guess who
the teacher’s friend
is.
The important content
of this lesson is
brought out through the
guessing game. Help
students understand the
meaning and the usage of
the sentence
structures.
Presentation
1. Let’s talk.
(1) Show the pictures and ask
questions. Then play the
recording. Teach the word
“or” and the sentence.
(2) Show the questions. Let
students watch the cartoon
carefully and discuss the
dialogue.
(1) Listen to the
recording carefully
and find out the
answers to the
questions. Learn the
word “or” and the
sentence.
(2) Learn the word
“glasses”. Watch the
cartoon. Understand
the dialogue and answer
the questions.
Train students to grasp
the key messages by
listening with the
questions.
Enable students to
better understand the
dialogue and understand
the meaning of the new
words.
2. Read after the recording.
Play the recording again.
Read the dialogue after
the recording. Pay
attention to the
pronunciation and the
intonation.
Ensure that students
can read the dialogue
correctly.
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Presentation 3. Act out in pairs.
Get students to read the dialogue
Read the dialogue freely.
Then act it out in pairs.
Enable students to read
the dialogue fluently
freely and then act out in pairs. and become more familiar
with the expression of
the key sentences.
Practice
1. Make a new dialogue.
Lead students to make a new
dialogue.
Make a new dialogue and
practice in pairs.
Help students better
grasp the sentence
structures of this
lesson.
2. Guess! Who’s he/ she?
(1) Show several characters in turn
on the PPT. Make a model to give
the language support.
(2) Show time.
Try to describe their
characteristics.
Practice in groups with
the language support.
Then figure out the
characters.
Show time.
Practice the main
sentences in the real
situations.
3. Let’s play.
Show the pictures and the sentence
structures on the PPT.
Practice in pairs with the
key sentence structures
to talk about friends.
Help students truly
understand and master
the meaning and the usage
of the key sentence
structures.
Consolidation
&
Extension
“Little policeman/ policewoman”
—Looking for the lost child.
Divide students into three groups.
Lead them to play the game.
Complete the tasks with
the key sentence
structures.
Through the description
and speculation of
different characters,
make students practice
the learned sentence
structures. Deepen the
understanding of the
dialogue during the
exchange process.
Enhance the training of
the target language and
increase the input and
the output of language.
Homework
1. Read after the recording of “Let’s talk” three times.
2. Describe one of your best friends to your parents.
3. Do the exercises.
The fifth period(第五课时)
Part B Let’s learn & Say and draw
▶教学内容与目标
119
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s learn
·能够听、说、认读短语“long hair, short hair, brown shoes, blue glasses, a green
bag”
·能够运用上述短语描述人物的外貌特征及衣着打扮
·能够理解不同的句型可以表达相同的意思,如“His glasses are blue.”也可以表达为
“He has blue glasses.”,提高学生灵活运用语言的能力
Say and draw ·通过活动,复习巩固重点句型“He has…”及 Let’s learn 板块所学的短语
·培养学生的口语表达能力和综合实践能力
▶教学重点
1. 能够听懂、会说、认读单词“hair, shoes, glasses”。
2. 能够听懂、会说、认读句型“He has…”“His…is /are…”。
▶教学难点
1. 能够熟练且正确地描述人物的外貌特征及衣着打扮。
2. 关注名词单复数的变化。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、单词卡片等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Lead-in
1. Sing a chant.
Play the chant in “Let’s chant” on page 25.(课件出示:教材
P25 Let’s chant 板块的 chant)Get students to chant together.
2. Lead-in.
Point to a student and ask other students to try to describe his/
her characteristics by using the key sentence structures they have
learned.
Step 2: Presentation
1. Create a situation.
(1) Show the outline of Sarah.(课件出示:Sarah 的外轮廓)
T: I have two new friends. Who are they? Guess! Now, let’s have
a look!
Ss: She is a girl. She is tall and thin.(Get students to describe
her characteristics.)
T: Look at her hair.(Point to her hair.)
Teach the word “hair/heə(r)/” and ask students to read it after
the teacher.
T: It’s long. (Show students the meaning of “long” by gestures.)
Her hair is long. She has long hair.
Teaching purpose
通过描述自己非常熟悉
的同学的特征,帮助学生回
忆、使用前几课时学习到的
重点词汇及句型,并为下一
步的学习做好铺垫。
Write down the sentence “She has long hair.” on the blackboard.
Ss: She is…
According to the description and the observation, let students
guess her name. Then show a complete picture of Sarah. (课件出示:
Sarah 的完整图像)
T: Oh, it’s Sarah. Sarah has long hair.
Teach the phrase “long hair” and the sentence “She has long
hair.” Point to the other girls with long hair in class, and practice
the sentence.
(2) Point to a girl with short hair in the class.
T: But she has short hair. (Show students the meaning of “short”
by gestures. Write down the phrase “short hair” on the blackboard.)
Point to a boy with short hair in the class and say out the phrase
“short hair”. Ask students to read the phrase while doing some actions.
Practice the phrase “short hair” and the sentence “He/ She has short
hair.”
T: Who has short hair in our class?
Get students to answer the question with the sentence “He/ She
has short hair.”
T: Yes. His/ Her hair is short.
Write down the two sentences, and ask students to make a comparison.
(3) Show the outline of Wu Yifan on the PPT. (课件出示: 吴一凡
的外轮廓) Lead students to say the sentences “He is a boy. His hair
is short. / He has short hair.”
Then present Wu Yifan’s green schoolbag and blue glasses on the
PPT. (课件出示:吴一凡的绿书包和蓝眼镜)
Teach the phrases “blue glasses, a green bag”.
Ask students to use the key sentence structures “He has…” or
“His…is/ are…” to introduce the boy.
S1: He has blue glasses. He has a green bag.
S2: His glasses are blue. His bag is green.
Present a complete picture of Wu Yifan.(课件出示:吴一凡的完整
图像)
T: (Point to the picture.) It’s Wu Yifan.
(4) Point to a boy in the class.
T: Look! What colour are his shoes?
Ss: …
T: His shoes are… And we can say, “He has…shoes.”
Then present some pictures of shoes in different colours on the
PPT. Lead students to say “…shoes”.
Write down the sentence “His/ Her shoes are…” “He/ She
has…shoes.” on the blackboard.
2. Let’s learn.
Teaching purpose
“hair”为学生新接触的
单词。将单词融入短语中,
以对比的方式使学生充分理
解新词的意思。教师通过真
实的情景,帮助学生用不同
句型表达同一种意思。
Teaching purpose
由谈论课本人物自然过
渡到谈论学生熟悉的班级同
学。激发学生运用所学知识
进行表达的欲望,学以致用,
操练本课时所学词汇与句
型。
Teaching purpose
形式多样的朗读训练可
以巩固和强化目标词汇和句
型。生生互动可以有效地提
升学生的学习热情,增强学
生的自信心,满足学生的成
121
T: My another friend is Wu Yifan. And he is Mike’s good friend,
too. Let’s listen and read.
(1)Show the picture of “Let’s learn” on the PPT. Play the
recording. (课件出示:教材 P28 Let’s learn 板块的图片及音频) Ask
students to read after it and pay attention to the pronunciation and
the intonation. Lead students to read the words together and have a
competition in different groups. For example: Group 1 PK Group 2, boys
PK girls.
(2)First, make a model with a student. Then lead students to ask
and answer in pairs.
(3)Ask some students to act out the dialogue.
3. Talk in class.
Show pictures of the other two characters in “Let’s learn” on
the PPT. (课件出示:教材 P28 Let’s learn 板块另外两个人物的图片)
Ask students to imitate the dialogue between Mike and Chen Jie and
discuss the appearances and other characteristics of the two
characters.
Make a model:
A: My friend has brown shoes.
B: It’s Amy. Her shoes are brown.
Step 3: Practice
1. Find friends.
The teacher takes out the prepared phrase cards and lets students
say the equivalent phrases of the card in groups.
Like this:
Group 1 shows the card “long hair”.
S1: Long hair.
S2: Short hair.
Group 2 shows the card “long arms”.
S1: Long arms.
S2: Short arms.
Group 3 shows the card “a red bag”.
S1: A red bag.
S2: A green bag.
2. Find and match.
The teacher shows photos of three cartoon characters with
descriptions on the PPT and ask students to find and match. (课件出
示:卡通人物及其相应描述)
3. Guess in groups.
Divide students into groups of four. Let students take turns
describing one member of the group and the others in the group guess
who he or she is.
Teaching purpose
在交流中使学生理解并
使用新授内容,为其能够自
由运用这些短语描述人物特
征奠定基础。
Teaching purpose
通过这个活动,使学生
能够真正自如地运用所学到
的短语和句型来描述身边朋
友的特征,从而达到掌握知
识的目的。
Make a model:
T: He is a boy. He has short hair. He has black glasses. He has
blue shoes. Who is he? Guess!
Ss: He is…/His name is…
4. Say and draw.
(1) Talk about the main scene picture of Unit 3.
Present the main scene picture of Unit 3 and talk about the picture.
(课件出示:Unit 3 主情景图)
(2) Say and draw.
Present the picture of “Say and draw”. (出示课件)
The rule: One person introduces the characteristics of his/her
friend. The other draws the corresponding character on the paper.
Make a model:
T: I have a friend. He has short hair. He has red glasses. He has
brown shoes…
Ask students to draw the boy.
Let students say and draw in pairs according to the rule. At last,
select the pair that performs best.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
Do a survey.
Show the form on the PPT. Let students investigate each other about
the length of their hair, the colours of the shoes and whether or not
have glasses in groups.
Ask students to report the results of the survey in the group after
completing the survey.
Make a model:
I have a friend. His/ Her name is… He/ She has…hair. His/ Her
shoes are… He/ She has/ doesn’t have glasses.
▶板书设计
Teaching purpose
整合运用所学语句谈论
主情景图,并延伸到听、说、
画活动。通过此活动,灵活
操练句型“He has…”并巩
固前面所学的短语。
Teaching purpose
通过引导学生完成调查
与汇报这个活动,巩固本课
的学习重点,突破难点,培
养学生综合运用语言的能
力。
123
▶作业设计
1. Read the vocabulary after the recording.
2. Describe a friend with the key sentence structures and write them down.
3. Do the exercises.(见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 本课是词汇和句型的新授课。新课教学前,通过歌曲和对话的方式帮助学生复习了上节课所学的知识,
为本节课做了铺垫。
2. 结合课件及师生互动讲授新知,将新授词汇融入句子教学中,既能帮助学生将词汇灵活地运用到句子
中,同时也能在句子中巩固所学词汇,二者相辅相成,互相促进。
3. 呈现本单元主情景图,通过画画让学生在玩乐中练习巩固词汇和句型,让英语课堂生动起来。
4. 在小组内完成调查报告,让学生能够运用所学语言去描述身边的朋友和亲人。
5. 板书设计清晰明了,重点突出,起到了很好的辅助作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s learn
· Be able to listen, speak and read the phrases “long hair, short hair, brown shoes, blue glasses,
a green bag”.
· Be able to use the phrases above to describe the character’s appearances and dress.
· Be able to understand that different sentence structures can express the same meaning and improve
students’ ability to use language flexibly.
Say and draw
· Be able to help students review and consolidate the key sentence structures and the phrases they
have learned in “Let’s learn” with the activity.
· Cultivate students’ oral expression ability and comprehensive practice ability.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to listen, speak and read the words “hair, shoes, glasses”.
·Be able to listen, speak and read the sentence structures “He has…”“His…is/are…”
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to describe character’s appearances and dress skillfully and correctly.
·Pay attention to the changes of singular nouns and plural nouns.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Lead-in
1. Sing a chant.
Play the chant on the PPT.
2. Lead-in.
Point to a student and ask
other students to describe
him/ her.
1. Sing the chant
together.
2. Describe the student’s
characteristics by
using the key sentence
structures they have
learned.
Through the chant and
the description, help
students review the
phrases and the
sentence structures
they have learned.
Presentation
1. Create a situation.
(1)Teach“hair, long hair”.
(2)Teach“short hair”.
(3)Teach “blue glasses” and
“a green bag”.
(4)Teach“brown shoes”.
Learn the new phrases and
practice the sentence
structures flexibly.
Make students fully
understand the meaning
of the vocabulary in a
comparative manner. And
help them know that we
can express the same
meaning with different
sentence structures.
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Presentation
2. Let’s learn.
(1) Play the recording of
“Let’s learn” on the
PPT.
(2) Make a model with a
student.
(3) Ask some students to act
out the dialogue.
(1) Listen carefully,
imitate and read the
words. And have a
competition in different
groups.
(2) Ask and answer in pairs.
(3) Act out the dialogue.
Various forms of
reading exercises
can consolidate and
strengthen the
target vocabulary
and the sentence
structures. And it
can effectively
improve students’
learning enthusiasm,
enhance their
confidence and
satisfy their sense
of achievement.
3. Talk in class.
Ask students to imitate
and discuss.
Imitate the dialogue
between Mike and Chen Jie.
Discuss the appearances and
the dress of the other two
characters.
Enable students to
understand and use
the phrases and the
sentences in
communication. Lay
125
the foundation for
students to freely
use these phrases to
describe
characters’
characteristics.
Practice
1. Find friends.
Take out the prepared
phrase cards.
2. Find and match.
Show the PPT and lead
students to finish the
task.
3. Guess in groups.
Make a model.
4. Say and draw.
Present the main scene
picture of Unit 3. Talk
about it. Then present
the picture of “Say and
draw”.
1. Read the cards and say
other phrases of the same
kind.
2. Find and match the
characters.
3. Practice the main phrases
and sentences in groups.
4. Talk about the main scene
picture of Unit 3. Then do
the activities.
Help students
practice the phrases
and the key sentence
structures flexibly.
Combine the
pronunciations with
the meanings of the
words to deepen
students’ memory.
Integrate the
sentence structures
and the phrases in
this unit.
Consolidation
&
Extension
Do a survey.
Show a survey form on the
PPT.
1. Do a survey in groups.
2. Report in the group.
Lead students to
consolidate the key
points of the course
and overcome the
difficulties by
completing the
survey and report.
Cultivate students’
ability to use
language
synthetically.
Homework
1. Read the vocabulary after the recording.
2. Describe a friend with the key sentence structures and write them down.
3. Do the exercises.
The sixth period(第六课时)
Part B Read and write & Let’s check & Let’s sing
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Read and write
·能够读懂四组句子并与图中的人物正确匹配
·能够按正确的语音、语调及意群朗读四组句子
·能够在有意义的语境中抄写单元的话题词汇并将句子补充完整
·能够综合运用本单元的核心词句
Let’s check ·通过看图,学会从图片信息中推测考查点,做到有意识地去听录音,听后完成排序任务
·能够养成良好的听力习惯,以持续提高学生的听力水平
Let’s sing ·能够了解歌词意义并能够清晰准确地歌唱
▶教学重点
能够运用所学词汇和句型简单地描述一位熟悉的朋友或同学。
▶教学难点
理解“What is his/ her name?”和“Who is he/ she?”的区别及联系。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、课文录音、视频等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision
1. Greetings.
T: Good morning/ afternoon, boys and girls.
Ss: Good morning/ afternoon, Mr/ Miss/ Mrs…
T: How are you today?
Ss: …
2. Revision.
(1) Free talk.
T: Who is tall and strong in our class?
Ss: …
T: Who has brown shoes in our class?
Ss: …
…
(2) Fill in the blanks.
Present the words of this unit on the PPT. Ask students to complete
the exercise as required.
Step 2: Presentation
Teaching purpose
通过运用前面课时中所
学的描述人物外貌特征及衣
着打扮的词汇和句型开始课
程,起到“温故”的作用,
能够极大地激发学生的学习
兴趣,让课堂氛围更加热烈,
更有益于学生的英语学习。
127
Read and write.
(1)Pre-reading.
①Play a game—“Create a supermodel”.
Draw the outline of a person on the blackboard. Ask students to
design his/ her appearance and clothes. Let each student say one
sentence. Draw the outline according to students’ descriptions until
a supermodel is created.
Ask students to look at the picture again. Let them try to make
descriptive sentences into a short paragraph.
②Guess: Who is my best friend?
Ask some students to use a complete paragraph to introduce their
good friend’s appearance and dress. Ask the other students to guess
who he / she is. Review and consolidate the key sentences learned in
this unit.
(2) While-reading.
①Show the picture and four groups of sentences of “Read and
match” on the PPT.(出示课件)
Let students observe the picture, underline the key words and
phrases and talk about it in class.
T: Look at these children, boys and girls. Who are they?
Ss: They’re Ben, James, Ann and Kate.
Write down the names on the blackboard and read them at the same
time.
T: Ben, pen—Ben, e/e/. James, name—James, a-e/eɪ/. Ann, ant—Ann,
a/æ/. Kate, cake—Kate, a-e/eɪ/.
Ss: … (Read after the teacher.)
T: Can you talk something about James?
S1: …
T: Who can talk about Ben?
…
②Complete the activity of “Read and match”.
Ask four students to read the four groups of sentences in turn.
The other students judge by what they hear.
Then check the answers together by letting students ask and answer.
Answers:1—James; 2—Ann; 3—Kate; 4—Ben
S1: He has short hair. He has a big green bag. What is his name?
S2: His name is James.
S3: She has long hair. She has orange shoes. What is her name?
S4: Her name is Ann.
Write down the sentence structures “He/She has…” “—What’s
his/her name? —His/ Her name is…” on the blackboard.
S5: She is tall. She is friendly. She has a blue hat. Who is she?
S6: She is Kate.
Teaching purpose
通过“创造超级模特”
的游戏,激发学生的表达欲
望,提高课堂参与度,并利
用已学词汇输出句子,让学
生自己将点(词汇)组合构
成面(语段)进行输出。
Teaching purpose
先让学生观察并讨论图
片内容,再根据句子来选择
正确的图片,培养阅读策略,
检验学生是否能够正确认读
并理解词汇及句型。
S7: He is short and thin. He has glasses. He is near the window.
Who is he?
S8: He is Ben.
Write down the sentence structures “—Who is he/she? —He/ She
is…” on the blackboard.
Lead students to understand the difference between “What is
his/her name?” and “Who is he/ she?”
T: What is his/ her name? We can only answer the name here. Who
is he/ she? We can answer the name, the job or the relationship with
the speaker here.
③Listen and repeat.
Ask and answer in pairs. One says the name of the character in the
picture. The other quickly retells the character’s descriptive text.
Then exchange to complete the exercise.
For example:
S1: Kate.
S2: She is tall. She is friendly. She has a blue hat.
(3)Post-reading.
①Observe and read.
Present the three pictures, the words and the phrases.(课件出
示:教材 P29 Look, choose and write 部分的文本与图片)Ask students to
observe the pictures and read the words and the phrases.
②Give language support, and talk with students.
T: (Point to the tall man.) Look at this man. He is…and… (Describe
with body language.)
Ss: He is tall and thin.
T: Who is this old man? He is Santa Claus. What does he have?
Ss: He has a red bag.
T: Yes, there are many gifts in the red bag. He has a red hat, too.
But there is no “hat” in the square frame. So we should fill “bag”
in the blank.
Does this girl have long hair or short hair?
Ss: She has long hair.
T: Great! Please choose the correct words or phrases to fill in
the blanks.
③Remind students to write the words or phrases correctly.
Comment on the completion of students. Correct writing errors in
time. Then check the answers together.
Answers: 1. tall; thin 2. bag 3. long hair
Ask three students to read the sentences in turn.
④Let students write a few sentences they have learned in this unit
to introduce a classmate. Next, let some students read the sentences
Teaching purpose
此活动帮助学生将读
音、词义及词形结合起来,
保证他们能够理解重点词汇
及句型的意思,并能够正确
运用。
129
they have written. The other students guess which students they’re
describing.
Comment on the completion of students. Correct writing errors in time.
Step 3: Practice
Let’s check.
(1) Listen and number.
Show the pictures of “Listen and number” on the PPT. (出示课
件)
Let students talk about the names, characteristics and other
features of the characters in the pictures.
S1: She is a girl. She has long hair and oranges shoes.
S2: He is a boy. He has short hair.
S3: He is a boy. He has long hair. He has brown shoes.
S4: He is a boy. He is tall and strong. He has glasses.
Play the recording. Remind students to grasp the key information
and complete the exercise of “Listen and number”.(出示课件)
Play the recording again to help students check the answers. (出
示课件)
Answers: 2-3-1-4
(2)Look and match.
Show the pictures of “Look and match” on the PPT.(出示课件)
Let students observe the pictures,and then describe the
characteristics of the characters in the pictures with the sentence
structures “He/ She is…”“He/ She has…”
T: Look at this girl in the first picture. What’s she like?
Ss: She has short black hair. She is quiet.
T: Good. What about this girl in the second picture? What do you
think about her?
…
Show the words and the phrases on the PPT.(出示课件)Let students
read them, and choose the right pictures to match.
Remind students that there is more than one word or phrase that
can match the same picture.
Check the answers.
Answers: 图 1: quiet 图 2: long black hair; glasses/ friendly
图 3: tall and strong; blue shoes; short brown hair 图 4: short and thin
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Let’s act.
Ask students to act out the words “tall, short, fat, thin,
quiet…”
2. Listen and do.
Give orders such as: Clap your hands. Stamp your feet. Wave your
arms. Shake your body…
Teaching purpose
先引导学生观察图片中
的内容,然后再听录音给图
片排序,使学生养成在完成
听力活动之前先获取习题信
息的习惯并检验学生是否可
以听懂本单元的重点句型。
Teaching purpose
通过让学生观察图片,
发散他们的思维,建立与所
学单词、句子的联系,检验
学生能否认读、理解词汇与
句型,并能运用这些知识进
行合适的表达。
Teaching purpose
以表演、欣赏、演唱、
创编歌曲等多种形式来回忆
本单元的重点词汇,达到总
结的目的。
Students do actions according to the orders.
3. Let’s sing.
(1) Play the song Friends.(出示课件)Get students to enjoy it
together.
(2) T: Listen again and answer. If your friend is tall and quiet,
what can you do?
Ss: Clap my hands.
(3) Students sing the song in pairs, then sing the song together.
(4) Make a new song with replacing the adjective and the verb
phrases of the song in groups.
Make a model:
If your friend is thin and funny, stamp your feet. If your friend
is thin and funny, stamp your feet.
If your friend is thin and funny, if your friend is thin and funny,
if your friend is thin and funny, stamp your feet.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Copy the key words learned in this unit five times.
2. Draw your parents and describe them in English.
3. Do the exercises.(见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 本课主要进行读、写练习,读、写的句子都是本单元的重点内容。
2. 采用与学生问答的方式展开本课时的重点内容,既减轻了学生的压力,也活跃了课堂气氛。
3. 在教学过程中,充分运用游戏、图片、录音等教学手段,让学生积极参与课堂活动,学生的参与意识
很强,完成的效果也不错。
4. 将难点进行细化,采用“单词—短语—句型”的方式化解难点。
5. 引导学生开展练习,操练句型,完成任务,加深了学生对句型的印象,也培养了学生继续学习英语的
兴趣。
6. 板书设计清晰明了,重点突出,起到了很好的总结作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Read and write
· Be able to read and understand the four groups of sentences and match them with the characters
correctly.
131
· Be able to read the four groups of sentences with the correct pronunciation and intonation.
· Be able to copy the topic vocabulary of this unit in the meaningful context and complete the
sentences.
· Be able to use the key vocabulary and sentences of this unit synthetically.
Let’s check
· Learn to predict the examination points from the picture information and consciously listen to
the recording and complete the task.
· Be able to develop good listening habits and improve students’ listening skills.
Let’s sing
·Be able to sing the song—Friends. Be able to understand the meaning of the lyrics and sing clearly
and accurately.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to simply describe a familiar friend or classmate by using the vocabulary and the sentence
structures they have learned.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Understand the difference and the connection between“What’s his/ her name?” and “Who is
he/she?”
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Revision.
Talk to students and show the
exercise.
1. Greetings.
2. Talk to the teacher.
Fill in the blanks.
Review the vocabulary
and the sentence
structures. Stimulate
students’ interest.
Lay the foundation for
the new lesson.
Presentation
Read and write.
(1) Pre-reading.
①Play a game—“Create a
supermodel.”
②Who is my best friend?
①Design appearance and
clothes and help the
teacher to draw a model.
Make descriptive
sentences into a short
paragraph.
②Some students introduce
their good friends with
a complete paragraph.
The other students guess
who he/ she is.
Stimulate students’
desire to express and
improve their
participation in class.
Increase students’
language output.
(2) While-reading.
Show the picture and four
groups of sentences of
“Read and match” on the
PPT.
Instruct students to observe
the picture, complete the
activity and retell the
text.
Talk about the picture in
class. Complete the
activity. And retell in
pairs.
Develop students’
observation skills
through the picture.
Cultivate their reading
strategies.
(3) Post-reading.
Lead students to complete
the activity of “Look,
choose and write”.
Observe the pictures. Read
the words and the phrases.
Then complete the activity
of “Look, choose and
write”.
Help students combine
word pronunciation,
word meaning and word
formation. Ensure that
they can understand the
meaning of the key
vocabulary and sentence
structures and can use
them correctly.
Practice
Let’s check.
(1) Listen and number.
Show the pictures of this
section. And play the
recording.
Discuss the names,
characteristics and other
features of the characters
in the pictures. Complete
the exercises of “Listen
Make students get into
the habit of obtaining
the information of the
exercises first before
they finish the
133
and number”. listening activities.
(2) Look and match.
Show the pictures, the words
and the phrases on the PPT.
Get students to observe the
pictures and read the words
and the phrases. Talk to
students.
Observe the pictures, and
describe the
characteristics of the
characters in the
pictures. Complete the
exercise of “Look and
match”.
Cultivate students’
divergent thinking.
Make sure students can
use the words, the
phrases and the
sentence structures
correctly.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Ask students to act out the
words.
2. Give orders.
3. Play the song—Friends. Lead
students to make a new song.
1. Act out the words.
2. Do corresponding
actions.
3. Enjoy the song. Make a
new song.
End the lesson with a
song. Let students
recall the key
vocabulary of this unit
through the song.
Homework
1. Copy the key words learned in this unit five times.
2. Draw your parents and describe them in English.
3. Do the exercises.
Recycle 1
教材分析
本单元是一个复习单元,主要复习 1~3 单元的核心知识点。该单元主要包含六个部分的内
容。
Read aloud 是在对话中复现 1~3 单元的主要句型及词汇。教材通过陈杰与 John 谈论书本和
好友的故事情景,使学生对所学词汇和句型的语义及语用情景加深记忆。
Connect and say 通过五个名字 Kate, Mike, Rose, Tim, Bob 串起 a, i, o 三个元音字母
的长短音,要求学生寻找含有相同发音的单词,并连线到城堡。
Look, listen and write 要求学生看图、听录音并填充三句绕口令,复习前三个单元所学
的语音知识。
Look and find 通过张鹏根据 Sarah 描述的人物特征连词找朋友的情景复习第三单元的核心
词汇和句型。
Read aloud and match the pictures 要求学生阅读两组对话,选择正确的图片匹配,并根据
图片提示续编对话。该活动旨在复习巩固 1~3 单元的主要词汇和句型。
Play a game 呈现的情景是:陈杰和 Mike 两人挑战登山, 途中一一回答遇到的问题,最先到
达山顶的人即为获胜者。通过此活动复习 1~3 单元的核心句型。
教学目标
知识与能力目标:
句型
·能够听、说、认读并在实际情景中运用 1~3 单元的核心句型
·能够在情景中运用句型 “What’s in your…?”询间并回答某处有什么物品;能够在情景中
运用句型“—Where is…? —It’s in/ on/ under/ near the…”询问并回答物品的位置
·能够在情景中运用句型介绍朋友的姓名、性格、外貌、穿着等,如“—What’s his/her name?
—His / Her name is…”“He’s/She’s…”“He / She has…”
·能够按意群朗读课文
词汇
·能够听、说、认读并在实际情景中运用 1~3 单元有关教室物品设施、书本文具及描述他人性
格、外貌、穿着的单词或短语
·能够在有意义的语境中抄写上述话题词或短语
语音
·能够掌握 1~3 单元中 a-e, i-e, o-e 的发音规则
·能够读出符合发音规则的单词,并能根据发音拼写出符合发音规则的单词
情感态度、文化意识、学习策略目标:
·能够体会同学之间互帮互助的友谊,加强人际交往的能力
·能够在游戏闯关的活动中,提高语言学习的积极性,增强灵活运用语言的能力
课时安排 第一课时: Read aloud & Connect and say & Look, listen and write
第二课时: Look and find & Read aloud and match the pictures & Play a game
135
The first period(第一课时)
Read aloud & Connect and say & Look, listen and write
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Read aloud
·能够理解对话大意;能够用正确的语音、语调朗读对话
·能够通过学习对话复习巩固“What’s in it?”“Who’s your friend?”“What’s her name?”
等句型, 并能作出回答
·能够在语境中理解“Your bag is so heavy.”“I know.”“I don’t know.”等句子的
意思,并能正确朗读
Connect and say
&
Look, listen
and write
·能够巩固学习 1~3 单元的语音知识,读出符合发音规则的单词
·能够根据发音规则将单词归类,完成连线及填充单词的任务
▶教学重点
1. 能够将 1~3 单元的核心语言融为一体,在具体情景中能自然熟练地运用。
2. 巩固学习 1~3 单元的语音知识。
▶教学难点
1. 能够用核心句型描述朋友的特征。
2. 能够根据发音规则读出符合发音规则的单词并能根据发音规则将单词分类。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、课文录音、视频等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Sing a song—Friends.
3. Sharp eyes.
Show the following vocabulary on the PPT one by one.
(课件出示:classroom, window, blackboard, light, picture, door,
teacher’s desk, computer, fan, wall, floor, schoolbag, maths, English,
Chinese, storybook, candy, notebook, toy, key, strong, friendly, quiet,
hair, shoe, glasses)
T: If you know the vocabulary, you can stand up and read it out.
4. Free talk.
Do Q & A on the topics of “classroom” “schoolbag” and
“friends”.
T: What’s in the classroom? / What’s in your schoolbag? / Who’s
your friend? What is he/ she like? Is he/ she tall /thin/…? /…
Ss: …
Teaching purpose
歌曲热身,激发学生的
学习兴趣;“眼疾口快”复习
学过的词汇,活跃课堂气氛。
Step 2: Presentation
1. Lead-in.
Show a schoolbag with some books in it.
T: Look at this schoolbag. What’s in it? Let’s have a look.
Lead students to answer: An English book, a maths book, a notebook
and ten storybooks.
Take all the books out of the schoolbag. Then put some school things
on the teacher’s desk and ask a student to come to the front.
T: Put the pen / pencil / ruler…in the schoolbag.
The student does as the teacher says.
T: Now show me the schoolbag.
(The schoolbag is too heavy for the student to carry.)
T: Let me help you. (Help the student raise the schoolbag.)
S1: Thank you.
The teacher asks more students to carry the schoolbag.
T: What do you think of this schoolbag?
Ss: So heavy.
T: Yes. The schoolbag is so heavy.
Let students read the word “heavy” after the teacher and help
them understand the sentence “Let me help you.”
T: We should help each other. Look! Chen Jie is helping John. (课
件出示:教材 P32 Read aloud 部分的图一)
2. Watch and answer.
(1) Look at the pictures and answer the question.
T: What’s in John’s schoolbag? (课件出示:教材 P32 Read aloud
部分的图二及图三)
Ss: Books.
(2) Watch the cartoon and answer the questions.
Show the questions on the PPT.
Then play the cartoon of “Read aloud”. (课件出示:教材 P32 Read
aloud 部分的视频) After students finish watching, check the answers by
talking to them.
T: Are they John’s storybooks?
Ss: No, they are his friend’s.
T: Oh! I know. I know they are his friend’s. (Emphasize “I know.”
with the head nodding.) But who’s his friend? I don’t know. (Emphasize
“I don’t know.” with a gesture and an expression.)
Ss: Sandy White.
Teaching purpose
教师通过问题引导学生
复习 1~3 单元的内容,再创
设情境让学生领会句子“Let
me help you. ” 和 单 词
“heavy”,让学生认识到遇
到困难时要互相帮助,为进
入 Read aloud 部分的话题做
好铺垫。
Teaching purpose
教师引导学生带着问题
观看文本动画,整体感知文
本,获取有用信息。
137
T: I know. John’s friend is Sandy White. So they’re Sandy White’s
storybooks.
Teach the sentence “They’re my friend’s storybooks.”
Show a picture of Sandy White.(出示课件)
T: Look! This is Sandy White. Do you know what her job is and what
she is like?
Ss: …
Check the answers and teach the sentences above.
Students read these sentences after the teacher.
Show the pictures of two pupils in the class. (出示课件)
T: Who is he/ she? Can you tell me something about him/ her?
(3) Watch the cartoon again, and then number the pictures.(课
件出示:教材 P32 Read aloud 部分的动画和六张打乱顺序的图片)
3. Read and act.
(1)Let students read after the recording and pay attention to
the pronunciation and the intonation.(课件出示:教材 P32 Read aloud
部分的音频)
(2)Let students practice the dialogue in groups.
(3)Choose some students to act out the dialogue.
Step 3: Practice
1. Connect and say.
(1)Let’s chant.(课件出示:Units 1~3 中 Let’s spell 板块的歌
谣)
(2)Show the pictures of the five children. (课件出示:教材 P33
Connect and say 部分的五个人物图片) Describe their appearances and read
their names.
T: Look at the pictures. I will say something about them. Listen
carefully. She is a girl. She has a blue hat. Who is she?
Ss: She is Kate.
T: Yes, she is Kate. Read after me, please. Kate.
Ss: Kate.
T: Pay attention to the sound of “a-e”. What is the sound of
“a-e”? It’s /eɪ/. Can you say any words like this?
Ss: Yes. Name.
T: What else?
Teaching purpose
引导学生按照正确的语
音、语调朗读对话,并能在
小组中进行角色表演。
Teaching purpose
通过引导学生关注元音
字母的发音,帮助他们回忆
相关的语音知识,为完成教
材中的活动做好准备。再请
学生说出人名中 a, i, o 字母
的发音,引导他们发现相同
字母在重读开音节与闭音节
里的发音是不同的。
Ss: …
T: Look at the two boys, one is Mike, the other is Tim. Please
compare the sounds of letter “i” in the words “Mike” and “Tim”.
The sound of “i-e” in “Mike” is /aɪ/. The sound of “i” in “Tim”
is /ɪ/. Can you say any words like these?
Ss: Yes. Like, win…T: Look, the clever girl is Rose. The boy with
glasses is Bob. Please compare the sounds of letter “o” in the words
“Rose” and “Bob”. The sound of “o-e” in “Rose” is /əʊ/. And
the sound of “o” in Bob is /əʊ/. Can you say any words like these?
Ss: Yes. Nose, dog…
(3)Listen and connect.
T: How does Kate go to the castle? You can connect the words that
have the same letter “a” and the same sound /eɪ/. Now listen and
connect. (课件出示:教材 P33 Connect and say 部分的音频)
T: Help the other children go to the castle in the same way.
Check the answers and read them.
Answer:
Kate—name—race—lake—game Mike—nine—fine—time—side
Rose—note—Jones—Coke—hope Tim—win—big—milk—fit
Bob—dog—Tom—hot—doll
(4)Play a match game.
T: Let’s play a match game. If I say /eɪ/, please say “name, Kate”
and so on. If I say /əʊ/, please say “Rose, note, Jones” and so on.
Are you ready? Let’s play!
2. Look, listen and write.
(1)Talk about the pictures.
①T:(课件出示:rice cake 和女孩 Kate 的图片)Look! What are they?
They are rice cakes. They are Chinese food. (Teach “rice cake”.) This
girl is Kate. Guess! What is she doing? (Do the action of making rice
cakes.)
Ss: She’s making rice cakes.
T: Yes. Kate likes to make rice cakes. (Teach this sentence.)
②T: (课件出示:bike 和 five mice 的图片) Look at these pictures.
This is a bike. They are mice. How many? One, two, three… Five mice.
“Mice” is the plural form of “mouse”. What do they do? (Do the action
of riding a bike.)
Ss: They ride a bike.
T: Is the bike nice?
Ss: Yes.
T: Five mice ride a nice bike. (Teach this sentence.)
③T:(课件出示:Mr Jones 和他的房子的图片)Wow, what a beautiful
house! This is Mr Jones’ home. Look, where is Mr Jones?
Teaching purpose
先引导学生初步认识单
词,正确地书写单词。在学
生比赛快速说出绕口令时,
感受到练习绕口令的乐趣。
培养学生的竞争意识,同时
锻炼他们的口语表达能力,
提高他们的语音准确度。
139
Ss: He’s at home.
T: What does he do?(Do the action of phoning.)
Ss: He phones.
T: Good. Mr Jones phones me at home. (Teach this sentence.)
(2)Listen to the recording, then fill in the blanks. (课件出
示:教材 P33 Look, listen and write 部分的音频)
T: You know the letters and the sounds well. Please look at the
pictures and listen carefully. Pay attention to the key words. Write
down the words you hear and fill in the blanks.
Check the answers, and read them.(课件出示:Look, listen and write
部分的答案)
T: It’s interesting, isn’t it? They are tongue twisters. Now,
read after the recording.
(3)Reading competition.
T: Now who can say the sentences more quickly? Let’s have a
competition.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. A group game.
T: John’s schoolbag is so heavy. There is an English book, a maths
book, a notebook and ten storybooks in it. Is your schoolbag so heavy?
What’s in your schoolbag? Let’s PK. Please ask and answer one by one.
For example:
T: What’s in your schoolbag?
S1: A Chinese book, a maths book… What’s in your schoolbag?
S2: …
2. A guessing game.
T: John has a friend, Sandy White. Do you have a good friend? Who
is your good friend? Please come to the front and tell us what your
good friend is like. The others guess. Let me do it first. I have a
friend in this class. She is tall. She has long hair. Her shoes are…
Her schoolbag is… Who is she?
Ask students to play the game with the demonstration.
3. Classify the words according to the pronunciation rules.
T: Look at the two words “dog” and “note”. When I say “dog”,
please say “one”. When I say “note”, please say “two”. If I say
a word like “dog”, you say “one”. If I say a word like “note”,
you say “two”. Let’s do it.
Teaching purpose
以比赛的形式来练习重
点句型的问答。这既可以帮
助学生复习相关知识,也可
以激发学生的学习兴趣,使
原本枯燥的操练变得有趣。
Teaching purpose
通过老师的示范,引导
学生描述自己的朋友让他人
猜一猜。这既考验参与介绍
同学的口语表达能力,又考
验其他同学能否听懂相关语
句,是否具有良好的观察能
力。
T: What do you find? The vowels in “a-e” “i-e” and “o-e” sound
long sounds.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Practice the dialogue.
2. Describe your parents with the sentence structures “He/ She is… He/ She has…”
3. Do the exercises.(见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 通过唱歌、玩游戏及师生对话的方式,带领学生复习了 1~3 单元所学的单词及短语,然后巩固了有关
教室、学习用品、朋友等话题的重点句型,为本部分的对话学习做铺垫。
2. 通过多媒体教学形式教学对话,然后学生们通过角色扮演的方式练习对话。
3. 通过听录音、看图片、唱歌谣等方式来回忆元音字母的发音规律。然后,通过城堡游戏巩固发音规律。
4. 通过小组竞赛、猜一猜以及找发音规律的方式,对本节课的知识加以巩固,学生的积极性被进一步激
发。整个教学过程以学生活动为主,充分体现了以学生为主体的教育理念,教学效果良好。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Read aloud
· Be able to understand the main idea of the dialogue and read the dialogue with correct
pronunciation and intonation.
· Be able to review and consolidate the sentence structures“What’s in it?”“Who’s your friend?”
“What’s her name?”by learning the dialogues and be able to answer them.
· Be able to understand the meanings of the sentences“Your bag is so heavy.”“I know.”“I don’t
know.”in context and read them correctly.
Connect and say & Look, listen and write
· Be able to consolidate the phonetic knowledge of Units 1~3 and read out the words that conform
to the pronunciation rules.
·Be able to classify the words according to the pronunciation rules, complete the tasks of connecting
and filling in the blanks.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to integrate the key language of Units 1~3 and use it naturally in specific situations.
·Consolidate the phonetic knowledge of Units 1~3.
141
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the key sentence structures to describe the characteristics of friends.
·Be able to read the words and classify them according to the pronunciation rules.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Sing a song—Friends.
3. Sharp eyes.
4. Free talk.
1. Greetings.
2. Sing a song.
3. Play the game.
4. Talk with the teacher
and answer the
questions.
Stimulate students’
learning interest.
Review the knowledge
that students have
learned.
Enliven the class
atmosphere.
Presentation
1. Lead-in.
Show a schoolbag with some
books in it. Teach the word
“heavy” and the sentence
“Let me help you.”
Review the words.
Learn the word “heavy”
and the sentence “Let me
help you.”
Create situations for
students to understand
the word and the
sentence. Let students
understand that when
they are in trouble,
they should help each
other. Pave the way for
the topic of “Read
aloud”.
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Presentation
2. Watch and answer.
(1) Show the pictures and
ask the question.
(2) Play the cartoon, then
ask questions.
(3) Play the cartoon again,
then let students number
the pictures.
(1) Look at the pictures and
answer the question.
(2) Watch the cartoon and
answer the questions.
(3) Watch the cartoon again
and number the pictures.
Lead students to
watch the cartoon
with questions. Help
them perceive the
text as a whole, and
obtain useful
information.
3. Read and act.
(1)Play the recording.
(2)Let students practice
the dialogue in
groups.
(3)Let students act out
the dialogue.
(1) Read after the
recording.
(2) Practice the dialogue in
groups.
(3) Act out.
Lead students to read
the dialogue
according to correct
pronunciation and
intonation.
Practice 1. Connect and say. (1) Chant together. Help students recall
(1) Let’s chant.
(2) Show the pictures of the
five children. Describe
their appearances and
read their names with
students.
(3) Play the recording.
(4) Play a match game.
(2) Guess the children’s
names by description,
then read their names.
(3) Listen and connect.
(4) Play a match game.
relevant phonetic
knowledge, and
prepare for the
completion of the
activities in the
textbook. Help them
find out the
difference of the
same letter in the
stressed open
syllable and the
closed syllable.
2. Look, listen and write.
(1) Lead students to
describe the pictures.
(2) Play the recording. Ask
students to fill in the
blanks.
(3) Reading competition.
(1) Describe the pictures.
(2) Listen and fill in the
blanks.
(3) Join in the reading
competition.
First, let students
feel the joy of
English tongue
twisters. Then, let
students practice
their oral
expression ability
through the
competition, and
improve their
pronunciation
accuracy.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Group game.
2. Guessing game.
3. Show some words.
1. Ask and answer.
2. Describe their friends
and guess.
3. Classify the words
according to the
pronunciation rules.
Review the phonetic
knowledge in Units
1~3 through the three
games. It not only
increases students’
interest in
learning, but also
improves their
language output
ability.
Homework
1. Practice the dialogue.
2. Describe your parents with the sentence structures “He/ She is… He/ She
has…”
3. Do the exercises.
The second period(第二课时)
Look and find & Read aloud and match the pictures
143
& Play a game
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Look and find
&
Read aloud and
match the
pictures
·能够通过观察、谈论对话部分的图片,理解对话大意
·能够按正确的意群和语音、语调朗读对话
·能够按要求完成图文配对等任务
Play a game ·能够根据实际情况熟练问答 1~3 单元所学的核心句型
▶教学重点
1. 复习描述他人外貌特征和性格特点的常用词汇和句型。
2. 复习表示建议的句型“Let’s…/ Let me…”的用法。
▶教学难点
1. 能够在情境中熟练运用核心词汇和句型描述他人的外貌特征和性格特点。
2. 能够在情境中熟练运用表示建议的核心句型。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、课文录音、视频等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Sing a song—Friends.
3. Play a game—“I say, you do”.
T: Let’s play. I say and you do. Open the door. / Turn on the light./
Close the window./ Put up the picture./ Clean the blackboard./Put your
pencil box in your desk./ Put your Chinese book on your English book./
Put your eraser near your pencil box./Put your maths book under your
schoolbag.
4. Free talk.
T: Do you have friends? How many friends do you have? What’s your
friend’s name? Is your friend a boy or a girl? Is he/ she tall? Is
he / she friendly? Does he/she have long hair? (Use the words or phrases:
quiet, friendly, tall, thin, small, glasses, brown shoes, a blue bag,
long hair, …)
Step 2: Presentation
1. Look and say.
Show the pictures of Fred, Kate, Ben and Ann.(课件出示:教材 P34
Look and find 部分 Fred、Kate、Ben 和 Ann 的图片)
Teaching purpose
以指令性活动来重现
1、2 单元的重点词汇,让学
生在活动中复习学过的重点
词汇,在快乐的氛围中进入
本课的学习。
Teaching purpose
通过与学生之间的自由
交谈,使学生在真实的语境
中交流有关朋友的外貌、性
格和衣着等特征,复习相关
知识。为下一环节的活动做
好准备。
Teaching purpose
通过让学生描述指定人
物的活动来复习、练习相关
知识,检验学生能否正确地
认读重点词汇并描述人物的
T: Look at these boys and girls. They are Fred, Kate, Ben and Ann.
Can you say something about them?
S1: This is Fred. He is tall. His hair is short and brown. He has
glasses. His shoes are red and white.
S2: This is Kate. She is tall. She has long hair. She has a blue
hat. She has brown shoes.
S3: This is Ben. He is short. He has short hair. He has a blue bag.
S4: This is Ann. She is short. She has long hair. She has yellow
shoes.
2. Look and find.
T: Sarah and Zhang Peng are talking about their good friends. Sarah
has a good friend. She asks Zhang Peng to guess who he is. Read the
sentences that Sarah says. Help Zhang Peng find Sarah’s good friend.
Ask students to read the sentences and find the correct friend.
Check the answer.
T: Who’s Sarah’s good friend?
Ss: He is…
Answer: Fred.
3. Pair work.
Let students use the words or the phrases in “Look and find”
correctly to describe the other three characters in the activity.
T: Choose one student of these to be your friend. Say something
about your friend. Let your partner guess who your friend is. Practice
your dialogue in pairs, please.
Make a model:
T: I have a good friend. She is friendly. She’s thin. She has a
blue hat and brown shoes. Who is she?
S1: She is Kate.
Step 3: Practice
1. Make a new chant.
T: It’s time for a chant. Let’s chant together.
Teaching purpose
通过韵句在轻松的氛围
中帮助学生复习总结本课时
的重点知识,激发学生的学
习兴趣。
145
T: Now please make a new chant about your friend. You can talk in
groups. Ask students to make their own chants. Then let some of them
show in class.
2. Play a game—“Guess who he/ she is!”
Show four photos of the students on the PPT. (出示课件) Everyone
has a schoolbag.
T: Now I will stand here with my back to you. You choose one of
them to the front. I ask some questions and you answer. And I guess
who it is.
Start like this:
T: Is it a boy? Does he have glasses? What colour is his schoolbag?
What colour are his shoes? His name is… Yes or no?
After giving a demonstration, let students play the game.
T: Now, who wants to try?
3. Read aloud and match the pictures.
(1) Present the Dialogue 1 and the two pictures of this part on
the PPT. (课件出示:教材 P34 Read aloud and match the pictures 部分
的对话一及其图片)
T: Look at the first picture. Who are they? Where are they? What
are they doing?
S1: They are Mike and John.
S2: They are in the classroom.
T: Yes. And they are cleaning the classroom. But in Picture 2, they
are talking about “What’s in the schoolbag?”
Play the recording.(课件出示:教材 P34 Read aloud and match the
picture 部分中对话一的音频)
T: Now listen to the recording and read after it. Then choose the
correct picture.
Check the answer. (Answer: Picture 1)
Present the Dialogue 2 and the two pictures of this part on the
PPT. (出示课件)
Play the recording and ask students to answer the questions. (课
件出示:教材 P34 Read aloud and match the pictures 部分中对话二的音
频)
①Who is the new student?
②What’s he like?
③Is he Mike’s friend?
T: Now listen to the recording again, and read after it. Then choose
the correct picture.
Check the answer. (Answer: Picture 2)
(2) Read and act out the dialogues.
(3) Make new dialogues.
Teaching purpose
通过游戏,使学生能够
根据相应的描述猜出同学的
身份。同时,也使学生在老
师的示范帮助下,学习如何
通过提问去获得相应的重要
信息。
Teaching purpose
通过活动,复习第一单
元和第三单元的相关重点知
识。学生既要能够认读相关
内容,又要可以听懂相关句
型,同时还要能够正确地表
达、交流。
T: There are other two pictures.(出示课件)Please make new
dialogues according to the other two pictures. Practice in pairs. Then
show to us.
Find the best group.
References are as follows:
①Ted: Oh, my schoolbag is heavy.
John: What’s in your schoolbag?
Ted: I have an English book, a maths book and two storybooks.
②Mike: John, this is Ted, my new friend. He’s a new student.
John: Nice to meet you.
Ted: Nice to meet you, too.
4. Play a game.
T: Everyone did a good job. Now let’s play a game. Look at the
picture. It’s a mountain. Let’s see who can climb the mountain fast.
How to climb it? Yes, you should answer the questions correctly. Let’s
see who the winner is.
(游戏说明:将全班学生分成几个小组,通过回答阶梯上的问题来进行
竞赛。可男生与女生比,小组之间比等。答对小组的小旗帜就向上移,看哪
个小组最先登上顶峰。)
For example: Competition between boys and girls.
Boy 1: What colour is your schoolbag?
Girl 1: It’s blue.
Girls climb a step up the mountain.
Girl 1: What colour is your English book?
Boy 2: Oh, sorry.
Boys can’t answer so they stay where they are.
Boy 2: Who’s your best friend?
Girl 2: …
(课件出示:教材 P35 Play a game 部分的图片及内容)
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Make dialogues.
Divide students into three groups and give the three topics “my
classroom” “my schoolbag” “my friends” to the three groups. Ask
each group of students to make a dialogue on the topic they are assigned
to.
Teaching purpose
通过问答问题竞赛,使
学生复习巩固 1~3 单元学习
过的重点句型。
Teaching purpose
通过创设真实的情境,
让学生根据自己的实际情况
编写对话并展示,培养学生
的综合语言运用能力。
147
2. Show time.
Ask some students from each group to act out the dialogues.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Practice the dialogues.
2. Do the exercises.(见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 本节课是综合复习课,主要帮助学生复习表示建议的句型“Let’s…/ Let me…”的用法、描述他人特
征的句型以及询问关于他人信息的问句。
2. 通过跟唱歌曲、“我说你做”的游戏互动及师生对话,引导学生复习了 1~3 单元所学的单词及短语,并
引出有关朋友话题的句型,为本部分的对话学习做铺垫。
3. 通过多媒体、口语交流和看图练习等多种形式,充分调动了学生的积极性,使学生在不知不觉中完成
复习任务,较好地实现了教学目标。
4. 复习活动设计多样化,语言由输入到输出,较全面地兼顾到各个单元的重点知识的梳理和归纳。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Look and find & Read aloud and match the pictures
· Be able to understand the main idea of the dialogue by observing the pictures and talking about
them.
· Be able to read the dialogues according to the correct pronunciation and intonation.
· Be able to complete the tasks as required.
Play a game
·Be able to skillfully ask and answer with the key sentence structures learned in Units 1~3 according
to actual situations.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Review the words, the phrases and the sentence structures that are used to describe people’s
appearances and personality characteristics.
·Review the usages of the sentence structures“Let’s/ Let me…”
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the key vocabulary and sentence structures to describe people’s appearances and
personality characteristics adroitly in situations.
·Be able to use the key sentence structures to express suggestions adroitly in situations.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Sing a song—Friends.
3. I say, you do.
4. Free talk.
1. Greetings.
2. Sing a song.
3. Do actions.
4. Answer the questions.
Cultivate students’
learning interest.
Review the knowledge
learned before.
Presentation
1. Look and say.
Show the pictures of “Look
and find”. Ask students to
describe Fred, Kate, Ben and
Ann.
2. Look and find.
Check the answer with
students.
3. Pair work.
Make a model to lead students
to finish the task.
1. Look at the pictures and
describe Fred, Kate, Ben
and Ann.
2. Read the sentences and
find Sarah’s friend.
3. Choose one from Fred,
Kate, Ben and Ann as a
friend and describe him/
her. Ask you partner to
guess who it is.
Review and practice the
relevant knowledge.
Test whether students
can read the key words
and the phrases
correctly, and describe
the appearances of the
characters.
Practice
1. Make a new chant.
Show a model on the PPT.
Make a new chant according
to the model. Show their
chants in class.
Help students review
the key knowledge.
Stimulate students’
learning interest.
2. Play a game—“Guess who he/
she is!”
Show four photos on the PPT.
Make a demonstration.
Guess who the person is.
Help students learn how
to get important
information by asking
questions.
149
3. Read aloud and match the
pictures.
(1)Finish the task of“Read
aloud and match the
pictures.”
(2)Read and act out the
dialogues.
(3)Make new dialogues.
(1) Look at the pictures
and answer the
questions. Listen to
the recordings and
choose the correct
pictures.
(2) Read and act out the
dialogues.
(3) Make new dialogues
according to the other
pictures.
Through the above
activities, review the
relevant key knowledge
in Units 1~3. Make sure
students can read the
relevant content,
understand the relevant
sentence structures and
express correctly.
4. Play a game. Ask and answer.
Review and consolidate
the key sentence
structures in Units
1~3.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Divide students into three
groups and let them make
dialogues.
2. Show time.
1. Make dialogues.
2. Act out the dialogues.
Cultivate students’
comprehensive language
application ability by
creating real
situations.
Homework 1. Practice the dialogues.
2. Do the exercises.
Unit 4 My home
教材分析
本单元学习的主题是家里的居室及相关设施。教学内容主要是围绕着家人和朋友间的家居
生活来展开。教学重点是能够听、说、认读核心句型“—Where is she? —She’s in the kitchen.”
“Open the door, please.”“Look! They’re in the door.”“—Is she in the…? —Yes, she
is./No, she isn’t.”“Where are the…?”“—Are they in…? —Yes, they are./No, they
aren’t.”;能够听、说、认读单词和短语“bedroom, living room, study, kitchen, bathroom,
bed, phone, table, sofa, fridge”。
教学目标
知识与能力目标:
句型
·能够听、说、认读句型“—Where is she? —She’s in the kitchen.”“Open the door, please.”
“Look! They’re in the door.”
· 能够在情景中运用句型 “—Is she in the…? —Yes, she is./No, she isn’t.”“Where
are the…?”“—Are they in…? —Yes, they are./ No, they aren’t.”询问物品或人物
的位置并作出相应判断
·能够在情景中运用句子“Open the door, please.”提出行动建议
·能够按意群朗读描述起居室(living room)的小文段
词汇
·能够听、说、认读单词或短语“bedroom, living room, study, kitchen, bathroom, bed, phone,
table, sofa, fridge”
·能够在有意义的语境中抄写单元话题词汇
·能够正确使用上述词汇描述家里的居室及物品设施
语音
·能够掌握 u-e 的发音规则,即 u-e 在单词中发长音/ju:/
·能够读出符合 u-e 发音规则的单词,并能够根据发音拼写出符合 u-e 发音规则的单词
情感态度、文化意识、学习策略目标:
·能够在生活中主动询问别人或对别人的询问能够热情应答
·能够感受到家的温馨,从而激发学生爱家、爱家人的情感
·能够主动收拾物品并摆放整齐,养成良好的生活习惯
·能够逐步做到见到符合 u-e 发音规则的单词能够拼读,听到符合 u-e 发音规则的单词能够拼写
课时安排
第一课时: Part A Let’s talk & Let’s play
第二课时: Part A Let’s learn & Let’s do
第三课时: Part A Let’s spell
第四课时: Part B Let’s talk & Ask, answer and write
第五课时: Part B Let’s learn & Let’s play
第六课时: Part B Read and write & Let’s check & Let’s sing
151
The first period(第一课时)
Part A Let’s talk & Let’s play
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s talk
·能够通过观察、谈论 Let’s talk 板块的图片,在图片、PPT 和老师的帮助下理解对话大
意
·能够用正确的语音、语调朗读对话
·能够在情景中运用句型“—Is she in the…?—Yes, she is./No, she isn’t.”询问
物品或人物的位置,同时作出判断
·能够在情景中恰当运用句型“—Where is she? —She’s in the kitchen.”
·能够在语境中理解新词汇“living room, study, kitchen”的意思,并能够正确发音
Let’s play ·能够通过本板块提供的教学活动,操练并巩固本课时的重要句型“—Is it in…?—Yes,
it is./ No, it isn’t.”
▶教学重点
1. 能够听懂、会说句型“—Where is she?—She is in the kitchen.”“—Is she in the…?—Yes, she
is./ No, she isn’t.”。
2. 能够听懂并使用词汇“living room, study, kitchen”。
3. 能够听懂、会读对话,并能分角色表演。
▶教学难点
能够在情景中正确使用句型“—Where is she/ it? —She/ It is…”来询问和描述人物或物品的位置;
使用句型“—Is she/ it in…? —Yes, she/ it is./ No, she/ it isn’t.”来询问人物或物品的位置,同
时作出判断。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、课文录音、视频等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Sing a song—Short vowel song.(课件出示:三下教材 P69 歌曲的
视频)
3. Free talk.
Review the sentence structures “—Where’s…? —It’s in / on /
under…”(课件出示:球在课桌不同方位的图片)
T: Where’s the ball?
Ss: It’s in/ on/ under the desk.
Ask and answer with other things.
T: Where’s the book/ pen/ pencil…?
Ss: It’s in/ on/ under…
Teaching purpose
通过歌曲激发学生的学
习兴趣,帮助学生在歌声中
复习询问位置的句型“—
Where is…? —It’s…”。
Teaching purpose
再通过互动问答的方
式,引导学生进一步操练,
为本课时的学习奠定基础。
Step 2: Presentation
1. Learn the new vocabulary.
(1)Present the picture of Amy’s home in the main scene.(课
件出示:Unit 4 主情景图中 Amy 家的图片)
T: Look, this is Amy’s home. Let’s go and have a look. This is
the bedroom/ study/ living room/ kitchen/ bathroom. So in Unit 4 we’ll
talk about “home”.
Write down the topic “Unit 4 My home” on the blackboard.
T:(Point to the bedroom.)Look! What can you see in this room?
Ss: A bed.
T: Great! We can see a bed in the room, bed + room=bedroom.
Write down the word “bedroom” on the blackboard and teach it.
T: Follow me: bed, bed, room, room, bedroom.
Practice the word “bedroom” in groups or one by one.
T:(Point to the study.)Is this a bedroom?
Ss: No, it isn’t.
T: It’s a study. We can see a computer on the desk. We can see
many books in the bookcase. We study hard in the study.
Write down the word “study” on the blackboard and teach it.
T: Please read after me. If I read it in a low voice, you read it
loudly. If I read it loudly, you read it in a low voice.
Teach the new vocabulary “living room, kitchen, bathroom” in the
same way as above.
T: Amy’s home is very nice.
(2)Present the pictures of a home and a dog.(课件出示:家庭
居室图和小狗在厨房的图)Talk with students.
T: Look! I have a dog. She’s cute. I love my dog. But I can’t
find her now. Oh! Where’s the dog? Is she in the living room/ bedroom/
study/ bathroom?
(Help students answer the questions.)
Ss: No, she isn’t.
T: Is she in the kitchen?
Ss: Yes, she is.
2. Let’s talk.
(1)Present the pictures of “Let’s talk” and lead students to
predict the main idea of the dialogue.(课件出示:教材 P38 Let’s talk
板块的图片)
T: Look, this is Amy’s home. What rooms can you see in the pictures?
Ss: I can see a bedroom, a living room, a study and a kitchen.
Teaching purpose
通过设置情景,让学生
在情景中熟悉新词汇和感知
新句型。通过猜测的方式让
学生练习一般疑问句及其答
语。
Teaching purpose
通过问题引导学生观察
并讨论图片,借助问题和图
片预测文本内容,使学生带
有目的性地去听录音。
153
(2) Present the questions about “Let’s talk” on the PPT.
Play the recording. (出示课件) Ask students to answer the questions
and underline the key words of the answers in their books.
T: What are Amy and Sarah doing?
Ss: They are looking for the cat.
Show the four pictures of “Let’s talk” in turn on the PPT. (课
件依次出示:教材 P38 Let’s talk 板块的四幅图片)
T: Amy and Sarah are in the bedroom. Is the cat in the bedroom?
S1: No, she isn’t.
T: Now they are in the living room. Is the cat in the living room?
S2: No, she isn’t.
T: Now they are in the study. Is the cat in the study?
S3: No, she isn’t.
T: The cat isn’t in the bedroom, the living room or the study.
Where is she?
Ss: She’s in the kitchen.
T: Very good!
(3) Read after the recording.
T: Boys and girls, let’s read the dialogue after the recording.
Please listen and read carefully.
(4) Read the dialogue in different roles.
(5) Act it out.
T: Now we’ll find the best actor or actress. Please come to the
front and show the dialogue.
Step 3: Practice
1. Recognize the pictures.
Present the pictures quickly. (课件出示:客厅、厨房和书房的图
片)
T: Say the words or the phrase quickly.
2. Let’s play hide-and-seek.
Ask students to play the game in pairs. Make a model with a student.
Let the student hide a pen when the teacher closes his/her eyes.
Then open the eyes and guess.
S1: I have a pen. It’s nice. Where’s my pen?
T: Is it on your desk? S1: No, it isn’t.
T: Is it in your desk? S1: No, it isn’t.
T: Is it under your desk? S1: No, it isn’t.
T: Is it in your hand? S1: Yes, it is.
T: Now, play hide-and-seek with your partner.
Teaching purpose
通过三个活动,使学生
能够充分理解对话内容,并
且能够正确地朗读对话。不
同形式的朗读活动使学生逐
步理解并掌握本课时的重点
句型,为其熟练表达奠定基
础。
Teaching purpose
通过 hide-and-seek 游戏
进一步巩固和练习新词汇及
句型“—Is it in the…? —
Yes, it is./ No, it isn’t.”。
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Let’s chant.
Make up a chant according to the dialogue of “Let’s talk”.
Change the words to adapt the chant. Then have a show.
2. Play a game—“Look for Xiaowu.”
(1)Present the picture of Xiaowu.(课件出示:小五在客厅看电视
的图片)Ask students to compete in groups.
T: Who is he? He’s Xiaowu. He is watching TV now. Oh, he’s missing!
Where is he? Let’s go and look for him.(课件出示:小五家的居室图)
(2) Read out the names of the rooms in groups.
Practice the vocabulary “bedroom, living room, kitchen, bathroom,
study”.
(3) Look for Xiaowu.
The group that finds Xiaowu first will be the winner.
Practice the sentence structures “—Is he in the…? —Yes, he is.
/ No, he isn’t.”“—Where is he? —He is in…”
▶板书设计
Teaching purpose
通过“寻找小五”的游
戏,充分调动学生的积极性。
让学生在情境中合理运用所
学句型,可以激发学生的英
语学习动力,并培养学生的
竞争意识。
155
▶作业设计
1. Practice the dialogue.
2. Practice the sentence structures “—Is she in the…? —Yes, she is. / No, she isn’t.” with
your partner.
3. Do the exercises.(见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 由歌曲视频引入,带领学生边唱边复习句型“—Where’s…? —It’s in/ on/ under…”,再在自由
谈话中巩固该句型,进而激发学生的兴趣,为新课做好铺垫。
2. 创设与现实生活及教材内容相近的语境,在特定语境中导入新词汇和句型,再自然地开展教学内容。
环环相扣,层层深入,让学生轻松地掌握教学重点。
3. 设计的活动形式丰富、易操作,且具备层次感,有效地提升了学生的核心素养。在教学过程中,以学
生为本,以解决问题为导向,引导学生自主学习。
4. 板书设计清晰明了,重点突出,起到了很好的辅助作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s talk
·Be able to understand the main idea of the dialogue by observing and talking about the pictures.
·Be able to read the dialogue with the correct pronunciation and intonation.
·Be able to use the key sentence structures “—Is she in the…? —Yes, she is./ No, she isn’t.”
to ask and judge the location of objects or characters in situations.
·Be able to use the key sentence structures “—Where is she? —She’s in the kitchen.” properly
in situations.
·Be able to understand the new vocabulary in context and pronounce correctly.
Let’s play
·Be able to practice and consolidate the key sentence structures by the provided teaching
activity.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand and speak the sentence structures “—Where is she? —She is in the
kitchen.” “Is she in the…? —Yes, she is./ No, she isn’t.”
·Be able to understand and use the key vocabulary “living room, study, kitchen”.
· Be able to understand, read and act the dialogue in different roles.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the key sentence structures correctly in situations to ask and describe the location
of characters or objects and make a judgement at the same time.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Sing a song—Short vowel
song.
3. Free talk.
Show some pictures. Ask some
questions.
1. Greetings.
2. Sing a song.
3. Answer the questions.
Cultivate students’
learning interest.
Review and consolidate
the sentence structures
“—Where is…?—It’s
in/ on/ under…” Lay
the foundation for this
class.
Presentation
1. Learn the new vocabulary.
(1)Present the picture of
Amy’s home. Teach the new
vocabulary“bedroom,
study, living room,
bathroom, kitchen”.
(2)Present the pictures of a
home and a dog. Talk with
students. Teach the new
sentence structures.
(1)Learn the new
vocabulary.
(2)Talk with the teacher.
Learn the new
sentence
structures.
Let students learn the
new vocabulary and
perceive the new
sentence structures in
the situation. Lead
students to practice
the general questions
and the answers by
guessing.
2. Let’s talk.
(1) Present the pictures. Ask
students to predict the main
idea of the dialogue and
describe the pictures
simply.
(2) Play the recording and ask
the questions.
(3) Play the recording again.
(4) Ask students to read the
dialogue in different roles.
(5) Ask students to act it out.
(1) Predict the main idea
and describe the
pictures simply.
(2) Listen to the
recording, then answer
the questions.
(3) Read after the
recording.
(4) Read the dialogue in
different roles.
(5) Act it out.
Help students
understand the content
of the dialogue and read
the dialogue correctly.
Lead them to master the
key sentence structures
of this lesson by
different forms. Lay
the foundation for
their skillful
expression.
Practice
1. Present the pictures.
2. Let’s play hide-and-seek.
Ask students to play the game
1. Say the new vocabulary
quickly.
2. Play hide-and-seek with
Further consolidate and
practice the new
vocabulary and sentence
157
in pairs. Make a model with a
student.
the partner. structures by the game
hide-and-seek provided
in this section.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Let’s chant.
Make up a chant according to
the dialogue of “Let’s
talk”.
2. Play a game—“Look for
Xiaowu.”
Show the pictures.
1. Make up a chant and have
a show.
2. Compete in groups.
Look at the pictures.
Read out the names of
the rooms in groups.
Look for Xiaowu by
asking and answering
with the key sentence
structures.
By making up a chant and
play the game, arouse
students’ enthusiasm
of learning English.
Lead students to
practice the sentence
structures actively.
Cultivate their sense
of competition and
responsibility.
Homework
1. Practice the dialogue.
2. Practice the sentence structures “—Is she in the…? —Yes, she is. / No, she
isn’t.” with your partner.
3. Do the exercises.
The second period(第二课时)
Part A Let’s learn & Let’s do
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s learn
·能够听、说、认读单词或短语“bedroom, living room, study, kitchen, bathroom”
·能够熟练运用句型“Where’s Amy?”“—Is she in the study? —Yes, she is.”进行
询问并作出回答
Let’s do ·能够听懂指令并根据指令语做出正确的动作
▶教学重点
1. 能够使用描述居室名称的重点词汇。
2. 能够在情景中运用重点句型询问人物或物品的位置并作出回答。
▶教学难点
能够听懂 Let’s do 中的指令并根据指令做出正确的动作;能够正确匹配居室和活动。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、卡片等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision
1. Greetings.
Teaching purpose
通过韵句激发学生的学
习兴趣,帮助学生复习 Let’s
talk 板块的内容。再通过游
戏复习重点句型“—Is it in
2. Let’s chant.
3. A guessing game.
(课件出示:钢笔在书包、文具盒、桌子或盒子等任一物品里的图片)
T: I lost my pen. Where’s my pen? Let’s look for it together.
Is it in the…? Guess!
S1: Is it in the box?
T: Yes, it is. / No, it isn’t.
…
Step 2: Presentation
1. Teach the new vocabulary and sentences.
(1)Teach the word “study”.
T: Where are my books? Look, they are in a room. (课件出示:书
房中有很多书的图片) I have many books in it. Oh, it’s a study! (课
件出示:study 的相关内容) (Write down the word “study” on the
blackboard and teach it.)
T: Follow me: study, st/st/-u/ʌ/-dy/di/, study .
Ss: … (Read it together, then read it one by one.)
T: What can you do in the study?
Ss: Read a book.
T: (课件出示:read a book 的相关内容) Do you like reading books?
Ss: Yes.
T: Let’s go to the study and read a book. Follow me: Go to the
study. Read a book.
Write down the phrase “read a book” on the blackboard and teach
the sentences “Go to the study. Read a book.”
(2) Teach the phrase “living room”.
Show a picture of a living room. (课件出示:客厅的图片)
T: Is this room a classroom?
Ss: No.
T: What’s this?
Ss: A living room.
T: Yes. This is a living room. (课件出示:living room 的相关内容)
Follow me: living room, li/lɪ/-ving/vɪŋ/, living ,
o/u:/-room/ru:m/, living room .
Teaching purpose
一方面,通过情景引入
新词汇,帮助学生借助图片
等理解新词汇的意思,并正
确发音。另一方面,一边学
习新词,一边把 Let’s do 板
块的内容有机结合起来,从
词汇到句子,层层递进,让
学生在轻松愉快的氛围中学
习新知。
159
Write down the phrase “living room” on the blackboard and teach
it.
Ss: … (Read it in groups.)
T: What can you see in the living room?
Ss: I can see a table, a sofa, a…and a TV.
T: Do you like watching TV? (课件出示:watch TV 的相关内容)
Ss: Yes.
T: Let’s go to the living room and watch TV.
Ss: OK.
T: Go to the living room and watch TV. Follow me: Go to the living
room. Watch TV.
Write down the phrase “watch TV” on the blackboard and teach the
sentences “Go to the living room. Watch TV.”
(3) Teach the word “kitchen”.
T: Oh, I read a book. I watch TV. Now I feel a little hungry. I
want to have a snack. (课件出示:have a snack 的相关内容) Follow me:
have a snack, have a snack. Do you want to have a snack?
Ss: Yes.
Write down the phrase “have a snack” on the blackboard and teach
it.
T: Oh, I can’t find any snacks. Where can we get snacks?
Ss: Kitchen.
T: Yes. ( 课 件 出 示 : kitchen 的 相 关 内 容 ) Follow me: kitchen,
ki/kɪ/-tch/tʃ/-en/ɪn/, kitchen .
Write down the word “kitchen” on the blackboard and teach it.
Ss: … (Read it one by one.)
T: Let’s go to the kitchen and have a snack. Follow me: Go to the
kitchen. Have a snack.
Teach the sentences “Go to the kitchen. Have a snack.”
(4) Teach the word “bathroom”.
T: Haha, I’m full. (Touch the belly and yawn, looking sleepy.)
I’m sleepy. Can I have a nap? (Help students understand with the
action.)
Ss: No, you’re dirty.
T: Yes. Let me take a shower. (课件出示:take a shower 的相关内
容)
Write down the phrase “take a shower” on the blackboard and teach
it.
T: Where can I take a shower?
Ss: Bathroom. (课件出示:bathroom 的相关内容)
T: Yes. Follow me: bathroom, ba/bɑː/-th/θ/-bath ,
bathroom .
Write down the word “bathroom” on the blackboard and teach it.
Teaching purpose
通过TPR活动形式增强
课堂的趣味性,提高学生参
与的积极性,强化单词读音
与词义的匹配。
Ss: … (Read it aloud or in a low voice.)
T: Let me go to the bathroom. Take a shower. Follow me: Go to the
bathroom. Take a shower. / Wash your face and hands. / Brush your teeth.
Teach the sentences “Go to the bathroom. Take a shower.”
(5) Teach the word “bedroom”.
T: Now, I’m clean and I’m tired. I want to have a nap. (课件
出示:have a nap 的相关内容)
Write down the phrase “have a nap” on the blackboard and teach
it.
T: Where can I have a nap?
Ss: Bedroom. (课件出示:bedroom 的相关内容)
T: Follow me: bedroom, e/e/-bed/bed/, bedroom .
Write down the word “bedroom” on the blackboard and teach it.
Ss: … (Read it in groups.)
T: Good. Follow me: Go to the bedroom. Have a nap.
Do the corresponding actions and let students learn the new
vocabulary above. Present the vocabulary “bedroom, living room,
bathroom” on the PPT.
T: Please read the words and the phrase together, and tell me what
you find.
Ss: …
T: Great! They are all rooms and they all have the same word
“room”.
2. Let’s learn.
(1)Show the pictures of “Let’s learn”. (课件出示:教材 P39
Let’s learn 板块的房间图片)
T: Look, it’s a nice home. That is Amy’s cat. Where is the cat?
Is she in the bedroom/ living room/ bathroom/ study/ kitchen?
Ss: …
T: Where is Amy? Let’s listen to the recording of “Let’s learn”
and answer the question.
(2) Listen and answer.
Play the recording of “Let’s learn” and ask the questions. (出
示课件)
T: Where is Amy? Is she in the bedroom/ living room/ bathroom/
study/ kitchen?
Ss: …
T: Amy is in the study. Where’s Amy’s dad? And where’s Amy’s
mum?
Ss: Is he/ she in the…?
Teaching purpose
通过提问激起学生的学
习兴趣,使学生在听录音时
更有目的性,听的时候会更
加认真。再在同样的情境中
进行对话练习,让学生能自
如地运用本课的句型。
161
(课件出示:点击学生问的房间,点进去看到爸爸在客厅,妈妈在厨房)
(3)Ask students to listen to the recording again and read after
it.
(4) Act out the dialogue.
Step 3: Practice
1. Play games.
(1) What’s missing?
Present the vocabulary “living room, bedroom, study, bathroom,
kitchen” on the PPT. Ask students to say the missing word or phrase
quickly.(出示课件)
(2) Guess words.
Show the back of the word cards. Ask students to guess what the
words or the phrases are. Students can say “Is it a…?”
2. Let’s do.
(1) Play the video of “Let’s do”. (课件出示:教材 P39 Let’s do
板块的视频) Ask students to read after the video.
(2) Let’s match.
T: Now, let’s match. I say the name of the room. You say what you
can do in it and do the action. Then practice in pairs.
3. Guess where Mike is.
Present the picture of Mike’s home. (课件出示:Mike 的家,猜他
在哪个房间,猜对了,点开房间看到 Mike)
T: Look, this is Mike’s home. We can see a living room, a bedroom,
a study, a bathroom and a kitchen in his home. But where is Mike? Let’s
guess! You can say “Is he in the…?”
S1: Is he in the living room?
T: No, he isn’t.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Talk about your home.
Present a picture of a new home. (课件出示:新家的图片)
T: Look, boys and girls! This is my new home. You can see a living
room, two bedrooms, a study, a bathroom and a kitchen in it. I can watch
TV in the living room. I can read a book in the study. I can have a
nap in the bedroom. I can take a shower in the bathroom. I can have
a snack in the kitchen.
Take out the picture of your home. Talk about your home with your
partners. Then introduce your home to us. (课件出示:句型 This is my
new home. You can see… I can…in…)
Divide students into three groups. Lead students to work in groups.
At last, ask some students to show in class.
2. Let’s sing.
Sing the song My home. (课件出示:教材 P44 Let’s sing 板块的歌
曲)
Teaching purpose
通过游戏进一步加深学
生对新授词汇的熟悉程度,
再结合句型来练习,使学生
更熟练地掌握并运用本课的
重点词汇和句型。
Teaching purpose
通过让学生将活动与居
室名称匹配起来,形成对于
新授词汇的立体记忆,以达
到牢固掌握动词短语与居室
名称的目的。
Teaching purpose
运用所学语言来描述自
己的家,既可以锻炼学生运
用语言的能力,也可以提高
学生参与英语学习的积极
性。
T: East or west, home is the best. We love our home. We love our
family.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Practice the words and the dialogue.
2. Design your ideal home, then introduce it to your parents.
3. Do the exercises.(见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 由韵句和游戏导入新课,引导学生复习上一课的内容,迅速抓住学生的注意力。
2. 通过情景引入新词,在词汇学习的环节,融入 Let’s do 板块的内容,让学生在轻松愉快的氛围中学
习和掌握新的知识。
3. 通过游戏的创设,将新知融入生活,以活泼的游戏形式帮助学生进一步巩固所学知识,让学生在玩中
学,学中玩。
4. 板书设计清晰明了,重点突出,起到了很好的辅助作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s learn
· Be able to listen, speak and read the vocabulary “bedroom, living room, study, kitchen,
bathroom”.
· Be able to use the sentence structures“Where’s Amy?”“—Is she in the study? —Yes, she is.”
to ask and answer adroitly.
Let’s do
· Be able to understand the instructions and do the correct actions according to the instructions.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to use the key vocabulary to describe the room names.
·Be able to use the key sentence structures to ask the location of characters or objects in
situations.
163
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to understand the instructions in “Let’s do” and do the correct actions according
to the instructions. And be able to match the rooms with the activities correctly.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Let’s chant.
3. A guessing game.
1. Greetings.
2. Read the chant
together.
3. Guess where the pen is.
Stimulate students’
interest in learning
and review the content
of “Let’s talk”
through the chant.
Review the key sentence
structures through the
game.
Presentation
1. Teach the new vocabulary and
sentences.
Teach the new vocabulary
“bedroom, living room, study,
kitchen, bathroom”. Teach
the content of “Let’s do”.
2. Let’s learn.
(1) Show the pictures of
“Let’s learn”.
(2) Play the recording of
“Let’s learn” and ask the
questions.
(3) Play the recording again.
(4) Ask students to act out the
dialogue.
1. Learn the new
vocabulary and
sentences.
2. (1) Talk about the
pictures.
(2) Listen to the
recording of
“Let’s learn” and
answer the
questions.
(3) Read after the
recording.
(4) Act out the
dialogue.
Lead in the new
vocabulary and
sentences properly.
Help students learn
them with the pictures
and activities. Help
students practice the
new vocabulary and
sentences in different
ways.
Practice
1. Play games.
(1) What’s missing?
Present the vocabulary.
(2) Guess words.
2. Let’s do.
(1) Play the video of “Let’s do”
and ask students to read
after the video.
(2) Let’s match.
3. Guess where Mike is.
1. (1) Say the missing word
or phrase quickly.
(2) Look at the back of
the word cards and
guess the words or
the phrases.
2. (1) Read after the
video.
(2) Match the
corresponding rooms
with the activities
and do the actions.
3. Guess where Mike is.
Deepen students’
impression of the new
vocabulary through the
games. Make students
master and use the key
vocabulary and sentence
structures of this
lesson more skillfully.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Talk about your home.
Present a picture and give a
demonstration first.
2. Play the recording of the song
My home.
1. Talk about their homes
in groups.
2. Sing the song My home.
Promote students’
ability of using the
language, and improve
their enthusiasm of
learning English.
Homework
1. Practice the words and the dialogue.
2. Design your ideal home, then introduce it to your parents.
3. Do the exercises.
The third period(第三课时)
Part A Let’s spell
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s spell
·能够感知并归纳 u-e 在单词中的发音规则
·能够读出符合 u-e 发音规则的单词
·能够根据单词读音拼写出符合 u-e 发音规则的单词
▶教学重点
1. 能够感知并归纳 u-e 在单词中发长音/ju:/的发音规则。
2. 能够读出符合 u-e 发音规则的单词。
▶教学难点
能够根据单词的读音拼写出符合 u-e 发音规则的单词。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、课文录音、视频等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Revision.
3. Let’s chant.
Teaching purpose
以 学 过 的 知 识 自 编
chant 进行热身,帮助学生唤
醒已有知识。
165
Step 2: Presentation
1. Find the same letters.
(1) Teach the word “cute”. (课件出示:一个漂亮的带白猫图案的
铅笔盒)
T: Oh, what a beautiful pencil box! There is a white cat on it.
The cat is so cute. Follow me:cute, cute, the cat is cute. Please make
a chant like: Cute, cute, … (课件出示:可爱的小狗、鸭子等图片)
Ss: Cute, cute, the dog is cute. Cute, cute, the duck is cute…
(2) Teach the words “excuse, use”.
T: Excuse me, I lost my pen. Can I use your pen?
Ss: Yes, of course.
T: Follow me: excuse, excuse, use, use.
Write down the words “cute, excuse, use” on the blackboard.
(3) Read and find out the rules.
T: Look at these words. Which letters are the same?
Ss: u-e.
T: Yes. The letter “e” at the end of the words is silent. What’s
the sound of “u-e”? Listen to the recording carefully.
Playing the recording of the words. (课件出示:单词 cute, excuse,
use 的发音)
Ss: /ju:/.
(4) Teach the sound of “u-e”.
2. Let’s read.
Help students try to read the words “mute, cute, tube, cube, muse,
fuse, mule, duke, huge” on the PPT. (出示课件)
3. Read, listen and chant.
(1) Look and think.
(课件出示:一只猫使用两个球的图片和两只猫使用三个球的图片)
T: Look at Picture 1: One cute cat uses two balls. Look at Picture
2: Two cute cats use three balls. So three cute cats use…
Ss: Three cute cats use four balls.
T: And four… And five…
Ss: Four cute cats use five balls. Five cute cats use six balls.
T: Good! Five cute cats are playing tricks.
(2) Let’s chant.
Play the video. (课件出示:教材 P40 Read, listen and chant 部分
的视频) Ask students to read the chant after the video together.
4. Let’s read and find.
Present the words “us, up, duck” on the PPT. (出示课件) Ask
students to find out the same letter in these words.
T: What’s the sound of “u” in these words? Listen to the
recording carefully. (课件出示:上述单词的音频)
Teaching purpose
先让学生通过观察发现
三个单词的共同点是 u-e,并
且发相同的音/ju:/。再通过
听录音跟读,让学生进一步
感知、体验发音,为下面的
拼读练习做准备。
Teaching purpose
通过变换不同的辅音字
母,让学生尝试读出新单词。
对含有 u-e 的单词的读音进
行强化训练,培养学生“见
词能读”的能力。
Teaching purpose
通过观察和跟读,引导
学生掌握字母 u 发短音的规
律,并能正确拼读一些单词。
Ss: /ʌ/.
T: Yes. U, u, /ʌ/, us, up, duck.
Let students read after the teacher and then read together.
(课件出示:bus, mum, cut, fun, nut, cup)
Ask students to try to read these words. Pay attention to the sound
of letter “u” in these words.
Step 3: Practice
1. Listen, circle and say.
Play the recording.(课件出示:教材 P40 Listen, circle and say
部分的音频)Ask students to listen and circle the words.
T: Look at these letters. There are many words in them. Listen and
find the words you hear. Then circle them.
Check the answers together. Read the words after the recording.
Answers: cute, cut, us, use, fun, tube, up, excuse, bus, mum, mule
2. Listen, circle and write.
(1) Listen to the recording and try to write the right words.
First let students observe the pictures carefully and make
predictions. Then play the recording and let students listen, circle
and write. (课件出示:教材 P40 Listen, circle and write 部分的音频) Pay
attention to the hand-writing.
(2) Check the answers.
Answers: duck, cute, up, use
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Play a game—“Pick apples from the tree.”
(课件出示:一棵苹果树,苹果上的单词有 tube, but, mule, duke, use,
cute, tune, rug, gun, cup, huge, plum, mud, refuse, luck, much;两
个篮子,一个是 u/ʌ/,一个是 u-e/ju:/)
Divide students into two groups. One group uses the basket “u/ʌ/”,
the other group uses the basket “u-e/ju:/”.
T: Now let’s have a competition. If you pick the apples quickly
and correctly within the limited time, you will be the winner.
Answers: u/ʌ/: but, rug, gun, cup, plum, mud, luck, much
u-e /ju:/: tube, mule, duke, use, cute, tune, huge, refuse
2. Read a story.
Show the story.(课件出示:一只猫和一头骡子的故事)
This is a cute cat. His name is Duke. Duke’s friend is Tube. Tube
is a mule. One day, Duke lost his cute cup. He was very sad. Tube helped
him look for the cup. Oh, it was under the rug. Tube picked up the cup
and gave it back to Duke. Duke was happy.
Teaching purpose
通过对比 u/ u-e 的发音,
强化 u/ u-e 的音—形对应关
系,同时培养学生“听音能
辨”的能力。
Teaching purpose
通过观察和书写单词,
培养学生根据发音规则拼写
单词的能力,能真正做到把
语音的学习落实到单词的拼
写上面,培养学生“听词能
写”的能力。
Teaching purpose
让学生在做游戏和任务
的过程中强化字母 u 和 u-e
在单词中的发音。
Teaching purpose
在故事中学习语音,将
语音与语境相结合,有助于
激发学生的学习兴趣,更好
的落实本课的语音知识。
167
Ask students to read the story in groups, and then read the story
one by one.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Read the words and the chant to your family.
2. Think about other words with “u” and “u-e”.
3. Do the exercises.(见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 创设了特定的语言情境,让学生在语境中学习和掌握语音知识,教学过程突出学生的自主性,鼓励学
生主动参与、独立思考并大胆总结和归纳发音规则。
2. 拼读结合的方式,在多层次的活动中练习了语音知识,更好地帮助了学生强化发音规则。
3. 由浅入深的语音学习,培养了学生的分析能力和举一反三的能力。
4. 自编 chant、师生互动和小组竞赛等形式,使原本枯燥的语音课变得生动起来。总之,这节语音课既发
展了学生的听、说、读、写的基本技能,又培养了学生的英语语感以及对听、说的感性认识。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s spell
· Be able to perceive and summarize the pronunciation rule of“u-e” in the words.
·Be able to read the words that conform to the pronunciation rule of“u-e”.
·Be able to spell the words that conform to the pronunciation rule of“u-e”according to the
pronunciation of the words.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to perceive and summarize the pronunciation rule of“u-e” in the words.
·Be able to read the words that conform to the pronunciation rule of“u-e”.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to spell the words that conform to the pronunciation rule of“u-e”according to the
pronunciation of the words.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Revision.
3. Let’s chant.
1. Greetings.
2. Read the words.
3. Chant together.
Review the knowledge
that students have
learned by making a
chant.
Presentation
1. Find the same letters.
(1) Teach the word “cute”.
(2) Teach the words “excuse,
use”.
(3) Read and find out the rules.
(4) Teach the sound of “u-e”.
Learn the words “cute,
excuse, use”.
Read and find out the
rules. Learn the sound of
“u-e”.
Conclude the
pronunciation rule of
“u-e”from the three
words. Prepare for the
spelling exercise.
2. Let’s read.
Show other words with “u-e”. Try to read the words.
Develop students’
ability of pronouncing
words by changing the
consonants of the
words.
3. Read, listen and chant.
Teach the chant and play the
video of it.
Learn the chant and read it
after the video together.
Review the words in the
chant.
Help students practice
the pronunciation of
“u-e” in sentences.
4. Let’s read and find.
Present the words “us, up,
duck”. Play the recording of
the words.
Find the same letter. Read
and find out the
pronunciation rule of
“u” in the words.
Through observation and
reading, help students
master the
pronunciation rule of
“u” and spell some
words correctly.
Practice
1. Listen, circle and say.
Play the recording.
Check the answers.
Listen and circle the
words.
Check the answers.
Read the words after the
recording.
Help students compare
the pronunciations of
“u” and “u-e”.
Strengthen the
corresponding
relationship between
sounds and shapes of
“u” and “u-e”.
2. Listen, circle and write.
Present the pictures and play
the recording.
Check the answers.
Observe the pictures and
make predictions.
Listen to the recording
and write down the words.
Check the answers.
Cultivate students’
ability of spelling
words according to the
pronunciation rules.
Consolidation
&
1. Play a game—“Pick apples
from the tree.”
1. Compete to pick apples.
2. Read the story in
Help students
consolidate the
169
Extension 2. Read a story.
Show the story.
groups. Then read the
story one by one.
pronunciations of “u”
and “u-e” in the
process of playing
games.
Practice the
pronunciation
enjoyably by reading
the story.
Homework
1. Read the words and the chant to your family.
2. Think about other words with“u”and“u-e”.
3. Do the exercises.
The fourth period(第四课时)
Part B Let’s talk & Ask, answer and write
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s talk
·能够理解对话大意;能够用正确的语音、语调朗读对话
·能够在情景中运用句型“Where are…?”“—Are they on/ near…?—Yes, they are./ No,
they aren’t.”询问物品的位置,同时作出判断
·能够在情景中恰当运用功能句“Open the door, please.”提出行动建议
Ask, answer and
write ·能够在游戏中进一步巩固和运用“询问复数物品的位置并作出应答”的句型
▶教学重点
1. 能够听懂、会说句型“Where are they?”“—Are they…? —Yes, they are./ No, they aren’t.”。
2. 能够理解并正确朗读课文对话,发音准确、语调自然。
▶教学难点
1. 能够在真实的语境中运用本课的句型来询问物品或人物的位置,并进行回答。
2. 能够正确使用单复数形式。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、课文录音、视频等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. A guessing game—“Where is my pen?” Teaching purpose
通过游戏和 chant 来复
习 A 部分的重点句型,帮助
学生唤醒他们的已有知识,
并为下一环节的学习做好准
备。
T: Look, it’s my pen. Now close your eyes, please.(将钢笔藏在
一个地方)Open your eyes, please. Where is my pen now? You can ask me
like this: Is it in/ on/ under… the…? Guess, please.
S1: Is it in the desk?
T: No, it isn’t.
…
3. Let’s chant.
Present the chant. Ask students to read together.
4. Lead-in.
(课件出示:一个球分别在椅子上面/旁边/下面;紧接着把一个球换成三
个)
T: Look! It’s a ball. Where is the ball?
Ss: It’s on/ near/ under the chair.
T: What are these?
Ss: They are balls.
T: Where are the balls? Guess!
Ss: Are they…?
…
Step 2: Presentation
1. Teach the new words and sentences.
(课件出示:教材 Unit 4 主情景图中 Amy 家的图片)
T: Amy can’t find her cat. Let’s help her! Is she in the kitchen?
Guess!
Ss: Yes, she is. / No, she isn’t.
T: Open the door. Let’s have a look! Follow me: Open the door.
(Help students understand the sentence with the action.)
Ss: …
T: The cat is near the table. Table, table, ta/teɪ/-ble/bl/,
table . Read after me.
Write down the word “table” on the blackboard and teach it.
T: (课件出示:table 与 desk 的对比图) We eat beside the table, the
desk is for studying and working.
(课件出示:教材 Unit 4 主情景图中 Amy 家的图片)
T: Look at the table. What’s on the table?
Teaching purpose
通过变换物品的数量对
物品的不同位置进行询问,
使学生感受单复数之间的区
别并复习介词,为新课的学
习做铺垫。
Teaching purpose
设置情景,让学生在语
境中熟悉新单词,感知新句
型。
171
Ss: …
T: (With a gesture.) Yes, it’s a phone. Phone, phone, ph/f/
-one/əʊn/, …
Ss: …
T: Now, Amy can’t find her crayons. Let’s help her! Are they in
the kitchen?
Ss: No, they aren’t. They are in the study.
T: Are they on the desk?
Ss: No, they aren’t. They are near the desk.
Write down the sentence structures “—Are they…? —No, they
aren’t.” on the blackboard and teach them.
2. Let’s talk.
(1) Look and predict.
Show the pictures of “Let’s talk” and lead students to predict.
(课件出示:教材 P41 Let’s talk 板块的图片)
T: Who are they?
Ss: John and his mother.
T: What’s in John’s hand in Picture 1?
Ss: Keys.
T: Follow me: k/k/-ey/i:/, key/ki:/, keys/ki:z/.
Write down the word “key” on the blackboard.
T: What are they talking about?
Ss: They are talking about the keys. They can’t find the keys.
(2) Watch the video and answer the questions.
Play the video and show the questions. (课件出示:教材 P41 Let’s
talk 板块的视频)
Ask students to underline the answers in the book.
(3) Watch the video again and check the answers.
T: Are the keys on the table?
Ss: No, they aren’t.
T: Are they near the phone?
Ss: No, they aren’t.
T: Where are the keys?
Ss: They’re in the door.
Write down the sentences “—Where are the keys? —They’re in the
door.” on the blackboard and teach them.
Step 3: Practice
1. Read and act.
Teaching purpose
通过提问和讨论图片激
发学生的阅读兴趣,引导学
生预测文本内容,培养学生
的观察能力和逻辑推理能
力,并使学生带着问题认真
观看视频,整体感知文本,
获取有用信息。
Teaching purpose
该部分三个活动使学生
能够充分理解文本内容,并
能够正确朗读对话。在不同
形式的朗读和表演活动中,
使学生逐步理解并掌握本课
时的重点句型,为其熟练表
达奠定基础。
(1) Ask students to read after the recording and pay attention to
the pronunciation and the intonation.
(2) Let students practice the dialogue in groups.
(3) Act out the dialogue.
2. Ask, answer and write.
(1) Show the picture of “Ask, answer and write”.(出示课件)
T: Look! Sarah writes a letter “p” in the circle on the desk.
It means “The pens are on the desk.” Please read what Sarah and Wu
Yifan say.
Read the dialogue of Sarah and Wu Yifan.
(2) Ask students to play the game in pairs according to the
dialogue.
T: Look at the picture. You can write k (keys), b (book), p (pens),
g (glasses) in the circles. Then your partner guesses where you write
them. Guess them like Sarah and Wu Yifan.
(3) Show the dialogues.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. A guessing game—“What is it? / What are they?”
T: (课件出示:书房场景图) Look at this picture. This is a study.
What can you see in the study?
Ss: …
T: Now, I will say a thing. Please guess what it is or what they
are. Listen carefully. They are near the phone. What are they?
S1: They are keys.
T: No, they aren’t.
S2: They are books.
T: Yes, they are books.
T: Please ask and answer in pairs as above. Which pair wants to
show your dialogue?
2. Play a game—“The cat catches mice.”
Divide students into four groups: red cat, white cat, black cat
and yellow cat.
T: A cat that catches a mouse is a good cat. There are three mice
in Amy’s home. Where are they? The group that can catch the most mice
is the winner.
(课件出示:老鼠在 Amy 家各个房间躲藏:1. 老鼠跑进卧室,藏在床底
下;2. 老鼠跑进客厅,藏在沙发后面;3. 老鼠跑进书房,藏在桌子底下;4.
老鼠跑进厨房,藏在门后面)
—Where are the mice?
—Are they in the…(bedroom/ living room/ study/ kitchen/
bathroom/…)?
Teaching purpose
为学生提供一个相对真
实的语境来运用重点句型,
帮助学生更好地掌握重点句
型,提高其口语表达能力。
Teaching purpose
通过两个游戏活动,创
设有趣的情景,让学生在特
定的语境中快乐地操练所学
的核心语言。
173
—Yes, they are. / No, they aren’t.
—Are they under/ behind/ near…the…(bed/ phone/ table/ door/…)?
—Yes, they are./ No, they aren’t.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Listen and imitate the dialogue for three times.
2. Do the exercises.(见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 教学过程中采用了以旧知带新知的学习方法,在复习单数形式的问句和答语的基础上,再进一步学习
复数形式的句型,从而使学生在掌握新知时有一个阶梯性的接受过程。
2. 利用多媒体先整体、再分段展开教学,通过问题引导学生的学习,帮助学生理解文本,并在文本中感
知新单词、新句型。
3. 教学活动形式多样、有趣、易操作且具备层次感,有效地激发了学生的学习兴趣,并帮助学生在真实
的情境中自然地使用所学语言。
4. 板书设计清晰明了,重点突出,起到了很好的辅助作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s talk
· Be able to understand the main idea of the dialogue and read the dialogue with the correct
pronunciation and intonation.
· Be able to use the sentence structures“Where are…?”“—Are they on/ near…?—Yes, they are./
No, they aren’t.”to ask and answer the location of objects in situations.
· Be able to use the functional sentence“Open the door, please.”appropriately in situations to
put forward action suggestions.
Ask, answer and write
· Be able to consolidate and use the sentence structures “Where are…?”“—Are they on/ near…?
—Yes, they are./ No, they aren’t.” in the games.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand and use the sentence structures “Where are…?”“—Are they on/near…?
—Yes, they are. / No, they aren’t.”
·Be able to understand and read the dialogue correctly with accurate pronunciation and natural
intonation.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the sentence structures of this lesson in real context to ask and answer the location
of objects or characters.
·Be able to use the singular forms and the plural forms correctly.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. A guessing game.
3. Let’s chant.
4. Lead-in.
1. Greetings.
2. Play a game.
3. Read the chant.
4. Answer the questions.
Help students review
prepositions, feel the
difference between the
singular forms and the
plural forms. Prepare
for the study of the new
lesson.
Presentation
1. Teach the new words and
sentences.
Learn the new words and
sentences.
Lead students to learn
new words and perceive
new sentence structures
by setting up the
situation.
2. Let’s talk.
(1) Look and predict.
Show the pictures.
(2) Play the video and ask the
questions.
(3) Play the video again and
check the answers. Teach the
sentences “—Where are the
keys?
—They’re in the door.”
(1) Look and predict.
(2) Watch the video and
answer the questions.
(3) Watch the video again
and check the answers.
Learn the sentences.
Ask questions to arouse
students’ reading
interest and make them
watch the video with
questions. Cultivate
students’ ability of
observation and logical
reasoning.
Practice
1. Read and act.
(1) Play the recording.
(2) Let students practice the
dialogue in groups.
(3) Let students act out the
dialogue.
(1) Read after the
recording.
(2) Practice the dialogue
in groups.
(3) Act out the dialogue.
Let students gradually
understand and master
the key sentence
structures in this
lesson, and lay the
foundation for their
skillful expression.
2. Ask, answer and write.
(1) Show the picture.
(2) Ask students to play the game
in pairs.
(3) Ask students to show the
(1) Look at the picture and
read the dialogue.
(2) Play the game in pairs.
(3) Show the dialogues.
Provide a real context
for students to use the
key sentence structures
to help them master the
knowledge better and
175
dialogues. improve their oral
expression ability.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. A guessing game—“What is
it? / What are they?”
2. Play a game—“The cat
catches mice.”
1. Work in pairs.
2. Work in groups.
Through the two
activities, create
interesting situations
for students to
practice and use the key
language they have
learned enjoyably.
Homework 1. Listen and imitate the dialogue for three times.
2. Do the exercises.
The fifth period(第五课时)
Part B Let’s learn & Let’s play
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s learn
·能够听、说、认读单词“bed, phone, table, sofa, fridge”
·能够熟练运用句型 “—Where are the keys? —They’re…”询问物品的位置并作出回
答
Let’s play ·在游戏中进一步巩固 Let’s learn 板块学习的家居设施名称,并用方位词描述它们的位
置
▶教学重点
1. 能够听懂、会说、认读单词“bed, phone, table, sofa, fridge”。
2. 能够运用句型“—Where are the keys? —They are…”询问物品的位置并作出回答。
▶教学难点
能够熟练且正确地运用句型“—Where are the keys?—They are…”询问并回答物品的位置。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、课文录音、视频等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Let’s do.
Play the video of “Let’s do” on page 39 in the book.
Ask students to read loudly and act at the same time.
3. Lead-in.
The teacher does the actions and asks students to guess.
T: Now, I do and you say. Guess what I do and where I am.
Teaching purpose
通过猜一猜的游戏,复
习房间词汇及相关短语,帮
助学生唤醒他们的已有知
识,并为下一环节的学习做
好准备。
Ss: Watch TV. / Read a book. / Have a snack. / Have a nap. / Take
a shower. You are in the living room/study/kitchen/bedroom/bathroom.
Step 2: Presentation
1. Learn the new words.
Present a picture of a home. (出示课件)
(1) Review the word “key”.
T: This is my home. It’s big. I have a living room, a study, a
bedroom, a kitchen and a bathroom. Do you want to visit my home?
Let’s go. First, let me open the door. Oh, no! Where are the keys?
Are they in my bag? No. Are they in my pocket? Yes, they are. Look,
they are my keys. Now, let’s open the door.
(2) Teach the words “sofa, table, phone”.(课件出示:客厅的图
片)
T: This is my living room. It’s big. What’s in the living room?
Ss: A TV is in the living room.
T: Yes. And? A sofa is in the living room, too. It has a sofa, a
green sofa. Follow me: sofa, sofa, a green sofa. Sit on the sofa.
Write down the word “sofa” on the blackboard and teach it.
T: Now, let’s sit on the sofa. (Do the corresponding action.)
T: And? A table is in the living room, too. A table, a yellow table.
Follow me: table, table, a yellow table. Eat at the table.
Write down the word “table” on the blackboard and teach it.
T: Now, let’s eat at the table. (Do the corresponding action.)
T: Look! What’s on the table?
Ss: A phone is on the table.
T: Follow me: phone, ph/f/-one/əʊn/, phone/fəʊn/. Answer the
phone.
Write down the word “phone” on the blackboard and teach it.
T: Now, let’s answer the phone. (Do the corresponding action.)
(3) Teach the word “bed”.(课件出示:卧室的图片)
T: This is my bedroom. It’s small. What’s in the bedroom?
Ss: Some books, a desk, a chair and a bed.
T: Yes, it has a bed, a blue bed. Follow me: bed, bed, a blue bed.
Sleep in bed.
Write down the word “bed” on the blackboard and teach it.
T: Now, let’s sleep in bed. (Do the corresponding action.)
(4) Teach the word “fridge”.(课件出示:厨房的图片)
T: Let’s go to the kitchen. What’s in the kitchen?
Ss: A…
T: A fridge. Follow me: fridge, fr/fr/-i/ɪ/-dg/dʒ/, fridge/frɪdʒ/.
Open the fridge.
Write down the word “fridge” on the blackboard and teach it.
Teaching purpose
通过情景引入新词,将
单词与情景结合起来学习,
再在游戏中巩固,使学习更
加轻松愉快,从而达到更好
的学习效果。
177
T: Let’s open the fridge. (Do the corresponding action.) Oh, a
lot of food is in the fridge.
2. Let’s learn.
(1) Present the picture of “Let’s learn” and talk about it. (课
件出示:教材 P42 Let’s learn 板块的图片,遮住钥匙的位置)
T: John can’t find his keys! He is looking for the keys. Where
are the keys? Guess!
S1: Are they on the table?
T: No, they aren’t. Look at that table. A phone is on the table.
S2: Are they on the bed?
T: No, they aren’t. Look at that bed. A teddy bear is on the bed.
…
(2)Watch the cartoon and answer the question.(课件出示:教材
P42 Let’s learn 板块的视频)
T: Watch the cartoon and answer the question: Where are the keys?
Ask students to underline the key sentence of the answer.
T: Where are the keys?
Ss: They’re on the fridge.
T: Yes, they’re on the fridge.
Write down the sentences “—Where are the keys? —They’re on the
fridge.” on the blackboard.
Ask students to read the sentences together or one by one.
(3) Listen to the recording and repeat it.
Step 3: Practice
1. Sharp eyes.
(课件出示:单词 sofa, bed, fridge, table, phone 的卡片逐个出现)
T: If you know the word, you can stand up and read it.
2. Hide-and-seek.
(课件出示:两只小猫躲进了 Amy 家的客厅)
T: Where are the cats? They’re on/ near/ under…
3. Let’s play.
Present the picture of “Let’s play”.(出示课件)
T: Now let’s play a game “Sentence Chain”. Three students make
up a group. For example:
S1: Look at that room.
S2: Look at that room. It has a blue bed.
S3: Look at that room. It has a blue bed. The bed is near the window.
Ask some groups to act it out.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Design a dream home.
Divide students into four groups. Ask students of every group to
design a dream house together. A student can be chosen from the group
Teaching purpose
通过设置找钥匙的环
节,将学生带入情境之中。
通过熟悉的生活场景激发学
生的学习热情,让学生轻松
地掌握本课时的重点词汇及
句型。
Teaching purpose
通过不同形式的小游
戏,对新学的单词进行操练,
充分调动学生的多种感官。
既能活跃课堂气氛,又能培
养学生的记忆能力和竞争意
识。
Teaching purpose
通过让学生自己设计并
介绍房子来培养其综合语言
运用能力,同时增强学生对
家的热爱之情,适时进行情
感态度价值观的渗透。
to introduce the house as the demonstration. At last, select the most
beautiful house.
2. Make a summary.
(课件出示:一张含有桌子、椅子、电话、床、沙发、冰箱、钥匙等物品
的房间图片)
T: Now review the new words. I point, you say. Look at the picture.
Where’s the sofa/ bed/ fridge/ table/ phone? Where are the chairs/
keys?
Ss: It’s/ They are…
T: I have a warm home. I love my home. What about you?
3. Enjoy the song—My home.
Play the video of the song. (课件出示:教材 P44 Let’s sing 板块
的歌曲)
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Listen to the recording and read the new words and sentences.
2. Introduce your room to your family or friends.
3. Do the exercises.(见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 这是一节单词和句型的新授课,用 Let’s do 这种说做结合的活动来热身,既活跃了氛围,又起到了
很好的承前启后的作用。
2. 将单词融入情景中教学,加深了学生的理解和记忆,再通过游戏加以巩固,学习效果明显。
3. 句型操练设计形式多样,以学生为本,层层递进,语言从输入再到输出,完成顺利。
4. 生动的课件素材,良好的师生互动和活跃的课堂气氛使本节课的教学任务顺利完成。
179
5. 板书设计清晰明了,重点突出,起到了很好的辅助作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s learn
· Be able to listen, speak and read the new words “bed, phone, table, sofa, fridge”.
· Be able to use the sentence structures “—Where are the keys?—They’re…” to ask and answer
the location of objects.
Let’s play
· Further consolidate the names of home facilities learned in “Let’s learn” and use location
words to describe their locations in the game.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand, speak and read the new words “bed, phone, table, sofa, fridge”.
·Be able to use the key sentence structures “—Where are the keys?—They’re…” to ask and answer
the location of objects.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the key sentence structures “—Where are the keys?—They’re…” to ask and answer
the location of objects skillfully and correctly.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Let’s do.
Play the video.
3. Lead-in.
Do some actions.
1. Greetings.
2. Read loudly and act.
3. Guess and say.
Review the words and
related sentence
structures. Help
students awaken their
existing knowledge.
Prepare for the next
step.
Presentation
1. Learn the new words.
Present a picture of a house.
Review the word “key” and
teach the new words “sofa,
table, phone, bed, fridge”.
Review the word “key”
and learn the new words
“sofa, table, phone, bed,
fridge”.
Learn the words in
combination with the
situation. Make
learning easier and
more enjoyable.
2. Let’s learn.
(1) Present the picture of
“Let’s learn” and talk
about it.
(2) Play the cartoon and ask the
question.
(3) Play the recording and ask
students to repeat it.
(1) Talk about the
picture.
(2) Watch the cartoon and
answer the question.
(3) Listen to the
recording and repeat
it.
Stimulate students’
enthusiasm for learning
and make students
easily master the key
words and the sentence
structures of this
lesson by setting up the
situation of looking
for the keys.
Practice
1. Sharp eyes.
2. Hide-and-seek.
3. Let’s play.
Present the picture of
“Let’s play”. Ask some
groups to act it out.
1. Read the new words.
2. Play hide-and-seek.
3. Three students make up
a group. Play a game
“Sentence Chain”.
Cultivate students’
memory and sense of
competition.
Review and practice the
words and sentences in
the game.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Design a dream home.
2. Make a summary.
3. Play the song—My home.
1. Talk about the dream
house in groups.
2. Review all the words of
this lesson.
3. Enjoy the song—My
home.
Develop students’
comprehensive language
skills by designing and
introducing the house.
Strengthen students’
emotion of loving home.
Homework
1. Listen to the recording and read the new words and sentences.
2. Introduce your room to your family or friends.
3. Do the exercises.
The sixth period(第六课时)
Part B Read and write & Let’s check & Let’s sing
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Read and write
·能够读懂描述起居室的小短文,完成图片与文字的连线以及描述钥匙位置的任务
·能够按意群和正确的语音、语调朗读小短文
·能够在有意义的语境中抄写单元的话题词汇并将句子补充完整
·能够综合运用本单元的核心词句
Let’s check ·检测本单元 A、B 部分的核心句型
·考查单元核心词汇的认读和意义的理解
Let’s sing ·能够了解歌词的意义并且能够清晰准确地歌唱
▶教学重点
1. 能够听懂、会说、认读本单元的重点词汇。
2. 能够完成阅读、判断、匹配等活动,正确理解、运用本单元的重点句型。
▶教学难点
能够在有意义的语境中抄写单元的话题词汇并将句子补充完整。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、课文录音、视频等。
▶教学过程
Teaching purpose
以歌曲来热身,使学生
在韵律中集中注意力,激发
181
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Enjoy the song—My home.
Play the song of “Let’s sing”. (课件出示:教材 P44 Let’s sing
板块的歌曲)
3. Sharp eyes.
Present the vocabulary “bedroom, living room, study, kitchen,
bathroom, key, sofa, bed, fridge, table, phone” one by one. (出示
课件) Ask students to read them out.
Write down the vocabulary on the blackboard.
4. Revision.
Present the picture of “Let’s learn” on page 42. (出示课件)
Talk about the picture with students.
T: This is a bedroom. It has a blue bed. The bed is near the window.
A teddy bear is on the bed.
Step 2: Presentation
1. Pre-reading.
Present the picture of Wu Yifan’s living room. (课件出示:教材
P43 Read and write 板块中吴一凡家的客厅图片)
T: Look, this is Wu Yifan’s living room. What are in the living
room?
Ss: A TV, a table, a fridge, a phone and a sofa.
T: Where is the TV?
S1: It’s on the wall.
T: Where is the phone?
S2: It’s on the table.
T: Where is the fridge?
S3: It’s near the table.
T: Oh, the living room is clean and tidy.(课件出示:教材 P43 Read
and match 左侧的物品图片) There are some books and pens, a bag and a
pair of glasses. Guess! Where are the books? Where are the pens? Where
is the bag? And where are the glasses?
Ss: …
2. While-reading.
(1) Present the passage of “Read and write”. (出示课件)
Ask students to read the passage carefully. Pay attention to
underlining the key phrases of the questions.
T: Where are the books? Where are the pens? Where is the bag? Where
are the glasses? Now put these things in the right places.
Answer the questions and match.
Teaching purpose
通过让学生描述图片中
房间内的物品摆设,复习前
面学过的句型,同时为后面
的阅读做铺垫。
Teaching purpose
通过观察和描述图片,
复习本单元的词汇和句型,
为本课的阅读做准备。
Teaching purpose
通过细读环节,培养学
生自主阅读获取信息和处理
信息的能力,进而提高学生
的阅读技巧,让学生扎实地
掌握所学知识。
(2) Check the answers with students.
Answers: 1. The books are on the sofa.
2. The pens are on the fridge.
3. The bag is under the table.
4. The glasses are near the phone.
T: Wu Yifan can’t find his keys. Can you help him? Where are the
keys?
Ask students to look at the picture of Wu Yifan’s living room again
and find the keys. (出示课件)
Ss: They are near the sofa.
(3) Listen to the recording and repeat it.
①Read after the recording.
②Read the passage together.
③Repeat the text.
3. Post-reading.
(1) Look, choose and write. (课件出示:教材 P43 Look, choose and
write 中第一部分的图片及练习)
Let students read the vocabulary “living room, bedroom, kitchen,
bathroom, study” first.
T: Let’s go and visit other rooms. Look at Picture 1. Answer the
questions: Where is the sofa? Where is the picture?
Ss: The sofa is in the living room. The picture is on the wall.
It’s in the living room, too.
T: Look at Picture 2. Where is the bed? Where are the chairs?
Ss: The bed is in the bedroom. The chairs are in the bedroom, too.
T: Great! Let’s finish the exercises.
Finish the exercises and check the answers.
Answers: The sofa is in the living room. The chairs are in the
bedroom.
(2) Write about your room. (课件出示:整洁的客厅图片与脏乱的客
厅图片)
T: Which room do you like? … Yes. Picture 1. East or west, home
is the best. We must keep our home clean and tidy. After visiting Wu
Yifan’s home, you may have some ideas about your room. Now write about
your room in your book.
(课件出示:Look, choose and write 中第二部分的图片及练习)
Let students read the words “phone, sofa, table, chairs, fridge,
bed” together first.
Teaching purpose
先引导学生观察图片中
的内容,然后再根据自己观
察到的图片中的物品位置来
选择正确的词汇进行填空,
检验学生能否正确理解句
子、认读词汇。最后让学生
选择正确的词汇填写句子来
介绍自己的房间,让学生在
运用中巩固所学知识。
183
T: When you write sentences, you should pay attention to
capitalizing the first letter, the punctuation marks and the spelling
of words. After that, please share your ideas with your partner. Let’s
do it!
Answers: The TV is in the living room. The books are in the study.
(3) Listen and tick or cross.
①Present the pictures of “Listen and tick or cross”. (课件出
示:教材 P44 Listen and tick or cross 部分的图片)
T: Can you see the glasses in the first picture? Where are they?
S1: …
T: Can you see the keys in the second picture? Where are they?
S2: …
T: Where are the books in the third picture?
S3: …
T: Where is Mike?
S4: …
②Listen and tick or cross.
T: Now, please listen and tick or cross. (课件出示:教材 P44 Listen
and tick or cross 部分的音频) Pay attention to the key words.
③Check the answers.
Listen to the recording again and check the answers together.
Answers: √ × √ ×
Step 3: Practice
Look and tick.
(1) Present the pictures of “FOR RENT” of “Look and tick”.
(出示课件)
T: “For rent” means “出租”. What can we know from the ads?
Please discuss with your partner.S1: It has two bedrooms, a living
room, a kitchen and two bathrooms in the first “FOR RENT”.
S2: It has a bedroom, a living room, a kitchen and a bathroom in
the second “FOR RENT”.
(2) Present the picture of the house in “Look and tick”. (课
件出示:教材 P44 Look and tick 部分中右边房子的图片)
T: Look at the picture. How many rooms are there? What are they?
Ss: Four rooms. A bedroom, a living room, a kitchen and a bathroom.
T: Now, look and tick. Which is right? Show me your answer, please.
(3) Check the answer.
Answer: The second “FOR RENT” is right.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Introduce your home.
Present a picture of a home and introduce it. (课件出示:房子的
居室图)
Teaching purpose
在完成听力练习之前,
先引导学生观察图片,获取
有用信息并推测考查点,做
到有目的地听录音,培养学
生听前预测的习惯,进而提
高听力水平。
Teaching purpose
该活动旨在检验学生的
认读和理解能力。引导学生
自主观察图片并描述图片,
帮助学生复习本单元的重点
词句,同时对学生进行有效
的练习技巧指导,注重对学
生学习方法的培养。
Teaching purpose
创设真实的情境,让学
生根据自己的实际情况画出
图片,编写文段并展示,培
养学生的综合语言运用能
力。给学生自由想象的空间,
真正地实现活学活用。
T: Boys and girls, this is my home. What about your home? Please
draw and introduce your home.
This activity is carried out in groups. There are six students in
each group. Choose the best one from the groups and then take part in
the class competition. At last, select the best one to show.
2. For rent.
Choose some pictures of students’ homes and show them in class.
T: Great! These houses are pretty. Now I’m going to rent these
houses. Which house do you need? Please choose it and give your reasons.
The house with the largest number of choices will be rated as the most
popular house today.
Make a model: I like this house. It has a living room, a bedroom,
a study, a kitchen and a bathroom…
3. Let’s sing.
(1) Learn the new sentences.
T: (课件出示:一台电视机) What’s this?
Ss: It’s a TV.
T:(课件出示:鼠标点击电视机,电视机消失)Oh! Where has the TV gone?
Where can it be? (Do actions to help students understand the sentences.)
T: Is it in the living room? (课件出示:没有电视机的客厅图片)
Ss: No, it isn’t.
T: Is it in the bedroom? (课件出示:有电视机的卧室图片)
Ss: Yes, it is.
T: It’s in the bedroom with me.
Present the pictures of the phone and the sofa. (课件出示:电话
和沙发的图片) Practice the sentence structures in the same way as
above: Where has the telephone/ sofa gone? Where can it be?
(2) Listen to the song—My home.
(3) Listen to the song again, and sing along with it.
(4) Sing the song together.
▶板书设计
Teaching purpose
通过图片及教师提问等
方法帮助学生逐步学习并理
解歌曲中的难点句型,调动
学生学习的积极性。
185
▶作业设计
1. Read the text three times, then repeat it.
2. Draw and write about your home.
3. Do the exercises.(见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1.本课是本单元的最后一课,是一节复习课,教学内容包括听力、阅读等形式,本节课注重以多样化的活
动引导学生在各种语境中完成本单元的复习。
2.突出学生学习的主体地位,注重对学生学习方法的指导,包括读的指导、听的指导和写的指导。
3.在阅读这部分时,从直观地看,到问答,再到跟读,让学生们对文段内容逐步熟悉,通过阅读问题,训练了
学生在语篇中捕捉不同类型信息的能力。
4.充分利用现代化教育技术辅助教学,如出示图片帮助学生理解句意,充分利用多媒体的示范教学功能,
起到正确的指向作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Read and write
· Be able to read and understand the passage of describing the living room, match the pictures
with the text and complete the task of describing the position of the keys.
· Be able to read the passage according to the sense group and the correct pronunciation and
intonation.
· Be able to copy the topic vocabulary of this unit and complete the sentences in meaningful context.
· Be able to use the key vocabulary and sentence structures of this unit synthetically.
Let’s check
· Check the key sentence structures of Part A and Part B of this unit.
· Check the recognition and understanding of the key vocabulary of this unit.
Let’s sing
·Be able to understand the meaning of lyrics and sing clearly and accurately.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand, speak and read the key vocabulary of this unit.
·Be able to complete reading, judgement, matching and other activities. Understand and use the
key sentence structures of this unit correctly.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to copy the topic vocabulary of this unit and complete the sentences in a meaningful
context.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Enjoy the song—My home.
Play the song.
3. Sharp eyes.
Present the vocabulary.
4. Revision.
Show the picture and talk
about it with students.
1. Greetings.
2. Enjoy the song—My home.
3. Read out the vocabulary.
4. Talk about the picture.
Review the key
vocabulary and the
sentence structures
of this unit by
singing, reading,
listening and
speaking. Prepare
for the later
reading.
Presentation
1. Pre-reading.
Present the picture of Wu
Yifan’s living room.
Look at the picture and talk
about Wu Yifan’s living
room.
By observing and
describing the
picture, review the
key vocabulary and
the sentence
structures of this
unit to prepare for
the reading of this
lesson.
2. While-reading.
(1) Present the passage and
ask the questions.
(2) Check the answers.
(3) Play the recording. Let
students repeat the
text.
(1) Read the passage and put
the things in the right
places.
Answer the questions and
match.
(2) Check the answers.
(3) Read after the
recording, then repeat
the text.
Cultivate students’
ability of obtaining
and processing
information by close
reading. Improve
students’ reading
skills.
3. Post-reading.
(1) Look, choose and write.
Ask the questions and
check the answers.
(2) Write about your home.
(3) Listen and tick or
cross.
(1) Read the vocabulary and
finish the exercises.
Check the answers.
(2) Write about their own
homes.
(3) Listen to the recording,
then tick or cross.
Check the answers.
Check whether
students can
understand the
sentences and read
the words correctly.
And let students
consolidate their
knowledge by writing
sentences.
Practice Look and tick. (1) Talk about “FOR RENT”. Test students’
187
(1) Show the two “FOR
RENT”.
(2) Present the picture of
the house.
(3) Check the answer.
(2) Talk about the house.
(3) Give the answer and
check it.
ability of reading
and understanding
words. Lead students
to observe and
describe the
pictures
independently. Help
students review the
key vocabulary and
sentences of this
unit. Develop
students’ learning
methods.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Introduce your home.
2. For rent.
3. Let’s sing.
1. Introduce their homes.
2. Design a renting house
and choose one “For
rent” in groups.
3. Learn to sing the
song—My home.
Cultivate students’
comprehensive
ability of using
language. Give
students the space of
free imagination to
study and use the
language flexibly.
Homework
1. Read the text three times, then repeat it.
2. Draw and write about your home.
3. Do the exercises.
Unit 5 Dinner’s ready
教材分析
本单元学习的主题是用餐。教学内容主要是围绕着用餐的各种情景来展开的。教学重点是
能够听、说、认读核心句型“What’s for dinner?”“—What would you like (for…)? —I’
d like some…, please.”“—Would you like…? —Yes, please./No, thanks. I can use…”;
能够听、说、认读单词“beef, chicken, noodles, soup, vegetable, chopsticks, bowl, fork,
knife, spoon”。
教学目标
知识与能力目标:
句型
·能够听、说、认读句型“What’s for dinner?”“—What would you like (for…)? —I’d
like some…, please.”“—Would you like…? —No, thanks. I can use…”
·能够在情景中运用句型“—What would you like (for…)? —I’d like…”征求并表达用
餐意愿
·能够在情景中运用句型“Help yourself.”“—Would you like…? —Yes, please./No, thanks.
I can use…”提出用餐建议和餐具使用建议,并恰当回应
·能够在情景中运用句型“What’s for dinner?”询问用餐的食物
·能够按意群朗读“—What would you like for dinner, John? —I’d like some beef, please.”
等三组句子
词汇
·能够听、说、认读单词“beef, chicken, noodles, soup, vegetable, chopsticks, bowl, fork,
knife, spoon”
·能够正确使用上述单词表达用餐意愿和餐具使用情况
·能够在有意义的语境中抄写上述话题词汇
语音
·能够掌握-e 的发音规则,即-e 在单词中发长音/ i: /
·能够读出符合-e 发音规则的单词,并能够根据发音拼写出符合-e 发音规则的单词
情感态度、文化意识、学习策略目标:
·了解用餐礼仪,能够对用餐建议作出恰当反应
·初步了解中西方餐饮文化的差异
·能够根据-e 的发音规则拼读单词,并能够根据-e-与-e 的发音规则拼写单词
课时安排
第一课时: Part A Let’s talk & Let’s survey
第二课时: Part A Let’s learn & Let’s play
第三课时: Part A Let’s spell
第四课时: Part B Let’s talk & Let’s play
第五课时: Part B Let’s learn & Let’s do
第六课时: Part B Read and write & Let’s check & Let’s sing
189
The first period(第一课时)
Part A Let’s talk & Let’s survey
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s talk
·能够理解对话大意
·能够用正确的语音、语调朗读对话
·能够在情景中运用句型“—What would you like (for…)? —I’d like (I would like)
some…, please.”征求并表达用餐意愿
·能够在情景中恰当运用功能句“What’s for dinner?”
·能够在语境中理解新词“dinner, soup, vegetable, ready”的意思,并能够正确发音
Let’s survey ·能够在采访活动中进一步巩固和运用征求用餐意愿及表达用餐意愿的句型,并进一步巩固
和运用食物类词汇
▶教学重点
1.能够听懂、会说句型“—What would you like (for…)? —I’d like (I would like) some…, please.”
“What’s for dinner?”。
2.能够听懂、会读单词“dinner, soup, vegetable, ready”。
3.能够听懂、会读对话,并能够分角色表演。
▶教学难点
能够在情景中正确使用句型“—What would you like (for…)? —I’d like (I would like) some…,
please.”来征求并表达用餐意愿。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、单词卡片、人物头饰、厨师帽、食物及饮品图片、价格标签等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Sing a song—Let’s have a picnic today. (课件出示: PEP 三上
教材 P54 的歌曲动画)
3. Revision.
(1)Sharp eyes.
Show the words about food and drinks one by one. (课件出示:egg,
juice, bread, milk, water, fish, rice, cake 依次快速出现,再消失)
T: If you know the word, you can stand up and read it aloud.
(2)Drive a train.
Show the words above and review the word “fish” with pictures.
(课件出示:1. 已学的食物及饮品单词 egg, juice, bread, milk, water, fish,
rice, cake。2. 出示三张图片,图片一:一盘鱼肉,教学 fish;图片二:两条
同一种类的鱼,教学 fish;图片三:两条不同种类的鱼,教学 fishes)Let
Teaching purpose
通过这两个活动,让学
生在轻松愉快的氛围中复习
已学过的食物及饮品单词。
同时,游戏活动引入用餐话
题,自然地创设真实、有效
的教学情景。
students work in groups of six. Ask every student in the group to ask
and answer questions in turn. Make a model:
T: Oh, I’m hungry. I’d like some bread and milk. What would you
like?
S1: I’d like some… What would you like?
S2: I’d like some… What would you like?
S3: …
Step 2: Presentation
1. Talk about dinner.
(1)Show a picture on the PPT. (课件出示: 一幅图,画面显示太阳落
山了,钟表显示 18:00)
T: Look! It’s 6:00 in the evening. It’s time for dinner. Guess
what “dinner” means.
Ss: 晚餐。
T: Yes. I’m hungry. What’s for dinner? (Show the word card.)
Dinner, dinner, /d/-/ɪ/-/n/-/ə (r)/, / /.
Write down the sentence “What’s for dinner?” on the blackboard
and teach it.
(2)Show a picture on the PPT. (课件出示: 一张餐桌,学生每提问一
次“What’s for dinner?”,餐桌上就出现一种食物,依次为 fish, rice, egg,
soup, vegetable)
Ss: What’s for dinner?
T: Some fish/rice/eggs.
Ss: What’s for dinner?
T: Some soup. (Show the word card.) Soup, soup, /s/-/u:/-/p/,
/su:p/, some soup.
Write down the word “soup” on the blackboard and teach it.
Ss: What’s for dinner?
T: Some vegetables. (Show the word card.) Vegetable, vegetable,
/vedʒ/-/tə/-/bl/, / /, some vegetables. Pay attention to the
pronunciations of “v/v/” and “s/z/”.
Write down the word “vegetable” on the blackboard and teach it.
Show the picture of the table with the food mentioned above. (课
件出示:摆放着上述食物的餐桌图片)
T: Oh! Dinner’s ready! I can eat now. (Show the word card.) Ready,
ready, /r/-/e/-/d/-/i/, / /. Dinner’s ready!
Write down the sentence “Dinner’s ready!” on the blackboard and
teach it.
T: What would you like for dinner?
Write down the sentence “What would you like for dinner?” on the
blackboard and teach it.
S1: I’d like some…
Teaching purpose
设置情景,让学生在情
景中学习新单词,感知新句
型。
191
Write down the sentence “I’d like some…” on the blackboard.
Lead more students to answer the question “What would you like for
dinner?” by using this sentence structure.
2. Let’s talk.
(1)Talk about Picture 3 of “Let’s talk” and predict the main
idea of the dialogue. (课件出示:教材 P48 Let’s talk 板块的图三)
T: (Point to the picture.) Wow, a lot of delicious food! Dinner’s
ready! What’s for dinner?
Ss: Some soup, some bread, some fish and some vegetables.
T: Look at the food. I’m hungry. I’d like some bread. Are you
hungry? What would you like?
S1: Yes. I’m hungry. I’d like some…
S2: …
T: Mike is hungry, too. What would he like?
(2)Watch the video and answer the questions.
Show Picture 1 of “Let’s talk”. (课件出示:教材 P48 Let’s talk
板块的图一)
T: Where are Mike and his mother?
Ss: They are in the kitchen.
T: Mike is hungry. What would Mike like for dinner? Let’s watch
the video. Underline the key sentence of the answer in your books.
Play the video and let students get the key sentence. (课件出示:
教材 P48 Let’s talk 部分的音频)
T: What would Mike like?
Ss: Some soup and bread. Mike says, “I’d like some soup and bread,
please.”
T: What would Mike’s dad like for dinner? Let’s watch the video
again. Underline the key sentence of the answer in your books.
Play the video again and let students get the key sentence. (出
示课件)
T: What would Mike’s dad like?
Ss: Some fish and vegetables. Mike’s dad says, “Some fish and
vegetables, please.”
(3)Read after the video.
T: Boys and girls, let’s read the dialogue after the video. Please
listen to it and read carefully.
Play the video again and ask students to read after it and try to
imitate the pronunciation and the intonation. Then let students read
together and read freely.
(4)Read the dialogue in different roles. Then act out the dialogue.
T: Now we’ll find the best actor or actress. Please come to the
front and show the dialogue.
Teaching purpose
通过各项活动,使
学生能够充分理解课文
内容,并且能够正确朗
读课文。在不同形式的
读和表演活动中,使学
生逐步理解并掌握本课
的重点句型,为其达到
熟练表达奠定基础。
Teaching purpose
教师播放录音,学
生听录音跟读。引导学
生按正确的语音、语调
及意群朗读对话,并能
够进行角色扮演。
Take out some headdresses and ask some students to act out the
dialogue.
(5)Retell the dialogue according to the blackboard-writing and the
pictures of “Let’s talk”.
Make a model first and then lead students to retell the dialogue
without their textbooks.
Step 3: Practice
Let’s survey.
(课件出示:教材 P48 Let’s survey 板块的表格及以下句型)
T: Suppose it’s time for dinner. What would you like for dinner?
Let’s make a survey.
Let students do the survey in groups of four.
Make a model:
T: S1, what would you like for dinner?
S1: I’d like some fish and rice.
T: S2, what would you like for dinner?
S2: I’d like some bread and milk.
T: …
S3: …
T: S1 would like some fish and rice. S2 would like some bread and
milk. S3…
Ask each group to choose a reporter to interview the other three
students, fill in a form and report the results to the whole class.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Make a new dialogue.
Ask students to imitate the text to make a new dialogue.
(1)Make a model.
(2)Let students imitate to work in groups of three. Then make a
new dialogue in groups.
(3)Show time.
Ask some groups to act out their dialogues.
2. In the restaurant.
Teaching purpose
教师让学生先模仿练
习对话,再创设在餐厅点餐
的情景,层层深入,为学生
创建真实的语言运用环境,
以此巩固本节课的重点内
容,同时达到学以致用的目
的。
Teaching purpose
通 过 完 成 调 查 活
动,进一步巩固练习新
单词及核心句型,在创
设的语境中提高学生的
语言运用能力,使学生
能够熟练运用所学语言
询问及表达用餐意愿。
193
(课件出示:一家餐厅的背景和句子“Don’t waste food.”)
Take out a prepared chef cap, some pictures of food and drinks and
the relevant price tags. Let students act as customers or a cook.
(1)Make a model.
T: Look! What do I do? Yes, I’m a cook. I can cook delicious food.
Please come to my restaurant for dinner. My restaurant’s rule is
“Order as much as you can eat. Don’t waste food.”
T: Welcome to my restaurant! What would you like for dinner?
S1: I’d like…
T: Here you are. Ten yuan, please.
S1: Thank you!
(2)Let students work in groups.
(3)Show time.
Ask some groups to act out.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Read the dialogue of “Let’s talk” five times.
2. Ask your parents with the key sentence structures and write their answers down.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 在课前热身阶段,活动丰富,有歌曲,有游戏,有表演,让学生在轻松的环境中迅速进入英语学习的
状态,同时也起到了承上启下的作用,为新课做好了铺垫。
2. 设计与生活相近、与课文内容也相关的语境,导入新单词和句型,再自然地引出课文。环环相扣,层
层深入,让学生轻松地掌握课文内容。
3. 呈现的活动设计丰富,操练形式多样,且具有连贯性、层次性。学生积极主动参与,参与面很广,体
现了以学生为主体的教学原则。学生不仅从中学到了新知识,更拓展了思维,效果非常明显。
4. 板书设计清晰明了,重点突出,起到了很好的辅助作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s talk
· Be able to understand the general idea of the dialogue.
· Be able to read the dialogue with the correct pronunciation and intonation.
· Be able to use the sentence structures “—What would you like (for…)? —I’d like (I would
like) some…, please.”in situations.
· Be able to use the sentence “What’s for dinner?” in situations properly.
· Be able to understand the new words in context and pronounce them correctly.
Let’s survey
· Be able to further consolidate and use the sentence structures of asking for and expressing the
will to eat in the interview activities. And further consolidate and use the vocabulary of food.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand and speak the sentence structures “—What would you like (for…)? —I’d
like (I would like) some…, please.” “What’s for dinner?”
·Be able to understand and read the words “dinner, soup, vegetable, ready”.
·Be able to understand, read and act out the dialogue in different roles.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the sentence structures “—What would you like (for…)? —I’d like (I would
like) some…, please.” to ask for and express the will to eat in situations.
▶Teaching Procedures
195
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Sing a song—Let’s have a
picnic today.
3. Revision.
(1)Sharp eyes.
(2)Drive a train.
1. Greetings.
2. Sing a song.
3. Revision.
Play the games.
Help students review
the words easily in the
song and the games, and
prepare to learn the new
content.
Presentation
1. Talk about dinner.
Teach the new words and the
sentence structures.
Learn the new words. Have a
preliminary understanding
of the new sentence
structures.
Set the situation. Let
students learn the new
words and perceive the
new sentence structures
in the situation.
2. Let’s talk.
(1)Show the third picture of
“Let’s talk” and ask
students to talk about it.
(2)Play the video and ask the
questions.
(3)Let students practice the
dialogue in different ways.
(1)Talk about the picture.
(2)Watch the video and
answer the questions.
(3)Read after the video.
(4)Read the dialogue in
different roles. Act out
the dialogue.
(5)Retell the dialogue.
Understand the content
of the text and read the
text correctly.
Understand and master
the key sentence
structures of this
lesson in different
forms of reading and
performing activities.
Practice
Let’s survey.
Let students do the survey in
groups. Make a model.
Assign investigation tasks
and do the survey in groups.
Report the results to the
class.
Further consolidate and
practice the new words
and sentence structures
through doing the
survey.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Make a new dialogue.
Ask students to imitate the
text to make a new dialogue.
(1)Make a model.
(2)Let students imitate to
work in groups of three and
make a new dialogue.
(3)Show time.
2. In the restaurant.
(1)Make a model.
(2)Let students work in
groups.
(3)Show time.
1. Imitate the text to make
a new dialogue in groups.
2. Act as customers or a
cook. Work in groups and
show in class.
Consolidate the key
content of this lesson
and transform the
knowledge into ability
by making a new dialogue
about ordering in the
restaurant.
Homework
1. Read the dialogue of “Let’s talk” five times.
2. Ask your parents with the key sentence structures and write their answers down.
3. Do the exercises.
197
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Presentation
1. Teach the new words and the
sentence structures.
(1)Lead in and teach the new
vocabulary and sentence
structures.
(2)Let students understand the
sentence: It’s a fat panda!
(1)Learn the new vocabulary
and practice the sentence
structures.
(2)Understand the sentence:
It’s a fat panda!
First, learn the new
vocabulary and the
sentence structures
in the dialogue so as
to prepare for the
later learning and
understanding.
Then, test
students’
understanding to the
dialogue by setting
up three questions.
2. Teach the dialogue of
“Let’s
talk”.
Present the pictures of
“Let’s
talk”. Give some questions
and play the recording twice.
Check the answers.
Listen to the dialogue twice
and answer the questions.
Check the answers.
Practice
1. Play the recording.
2. Let students read in roles.
3. Let some students act out in
roles.
4. Let students fill in the
blanks.
5. Activity: What’s in the
pencil box?
6. Let’s play.
1. Listen to the recording
again and imitate.
2. Read and role play in
groups.
3. Act out the dialogue in
roles.
4. Fill in the blanks.
5. Ask and answer with the
partner and show in class.
6. Play the game and act out in
class.
Practice the main
sentences in
different ways.
Prepare for the next
part.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Create a new dialogue.
Show three schoolbags and
language scaffolds.
2. Draw a new schoolbag and talk
about it with your partner.
Make an evaluation.
1. Create a new dialogue
according to the language
scaffolds. Practice in
paris and report it in
class.
2. Draw a new schoolbag and
talk about it with your
partner.
Act out in class.
Evaluate some students’
performances.
Use the sentence
structures learned
in this lesson to
create a dialogue.
Give full play to
students’autonomy,
cultivate their
creativity, and
improve their
ability to use the
language
synthetically.
Homework
1. Practice the dialogue.
2. Talk about your schoolbag with your partner.
3. Do the exercises.
The second period(第二课时)
Part A Let’s learn & Let’s play
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s learn
·能够听、说、认读单词“beef, chicken, noodles, soup, vegetable”
·能够熟练运用句型“—What would you like? —I’d like some…”征求和表达用餐意
愿
Let’s play ·能够模拟餐馆中顾客点餐时与服务员之间的对话,并且能够快速找到食物图片或判断图
片的正确性
▶教学重点
1. 能够听、说、认读单词“beef, chicken, noodles, soup, vegetable”。
2. 能够在真实或虚拟的情景中熟练运用句型“—What would you like? —I’d like some…”征求和表
达用餐意愿。
▶教学难点
能够熟练运用所学单词及核心句型进行简单的点餐活动。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、卡片等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Let’s chant. Teaching purpose
韵句既可以激发学生的
学习兴趣,又可以复习上节
课 Let’s talk 板块的内容。再
通过游戏复习所学有关食物
或饮品的单词和数词,激活
学习背景,为学习新知识做
199
Let students change the words of food to make a new chant.
3. Sharp eyes.
Review the words of food and drinks. (课件出示: apple, 10 apples,
banana, 12 bananas, egg, 5 eggs, bread, milk, rice, juice, fish 依次
快速出现并消失)
T: If you know the word or the phrase, you can stand up and read
it aloud.
Step 2: Presentation
1. Teach the new words.
Show a picture of a restaurant. (出示课件)
(1)T: Welcome to my restaurant—Fresh Restaurant. We have lots of
yummy food. This is the menu. (课件出示: 教材 P49 Let’s learn 板块
的菜单) Let’s have a look! The rice is one yuan. The fish is…
Ss: The fish is ten yuan. The juice is five yuan. The milk is two
yuan. The bread is one yuan.
(2)Teach the word “noodles”.
T: Good! Guess what these are. They’re usually long and white.
(Show the back of the card.) Yes, they’re noodles. Noodles/ /,
n/n/-oo/u:/-dle/dl/-s/z/, noodles/ /. (课件出示: 图片一: 筷子
夹一根面条,出示单词 noodle;图片二:一碗面条,出示单词 noodles)
Put the word card of “noodles” on the blackboard and write down
this word. Ask students to read and chant after the teacher with some
actions.
T: Noodles, noodles, long noodles. I like noodles. If you’d like
some noodles, you can say, “I’d like some noodles. Yummy, yummy!”
What would you like?
Ss: I’d like some noodles. Yummy, yummy!
T: Look! There are many kinds of noodles. (课件出示:各种面条的
图片) We have egg noodles, vegetable noodles, beef noodles and chicken
noodles. Eggs and noodles are egg noodles, so vegetables and noodles
are vegetable noodles.
(3)Teach the word “vegetables”. (课件出示:一个西红柿,一根黄
瓜,一个南瓜)
T: Look! Are they fruit?
Ss: No.
T: They are vegetables. Vegetable/ /,
ve/ve/-ge/dʒ/-ta/tə/ -ble/bl/, vegetable/ /.
Put the word card of “vegetables” on the blackboard and write
down this word. Ask students to read and chant after the teacher. Let
students pay attention to the change of singular and plural forms.
T: Vegetable, vegetable, green vegetables, red vegetables, yellow
vegetables… I like vegetables. What would you like?
Ss: I’d like some vegetables. Yummy, yummy!
Teaching purpose
创设情境,利用餐馆这
个环境来引出本课的重点知
识。用菜单这一餐馆中常见
的重要物品来引出食物类词
汇,帮助学生为接下来的学
习做好词汇的积累工作。
(4)Teach the word “beef”.
T: Beef noodles are very yummy. Beef is from the cow. (课件出
示:牛和牛肉的图片)I like beef. Do you like beef?
Put the word card of “beef” on the blackboard and write down this
word. Ask students to read and chant after the teacher.
T: Beef/bi:f/, b/b/-ee/i:/-f/f/, beef/bi:f/. I like beef. What
would you like?
Ss: I’d like some beef. Yummy, yummy!
(5)Teach the word “chicken”.
T: Chicken is very yummy, too. We often eat chicken in the KFC.
Do you like chicken? (课件出示:鸡肉的图片)
Put the word card of “chicken” on the blackboard and write down
this word. Ask students to read and chant after the teacher.
T: Chicken/ /, ch/tʃ/-i/ɪ/-ck/k/-en/ɪn/, chicken/ /. I
like chicken. What would you like?
Ss: I’d like some chicken. Yummy, yummy!
(6)Teach the word “soup”. (课件出示:各种汤的图片)
T: (Point to the picture of soup.) What’s this? It’s soup.
Soup/su:p/, s/s/-ou/u:/-p/p/. Look! There are many kinds of soup in
my restaurant. What are they?
Ss: They are egg soup, vegetable soup, fish soup, beef soup and
chicken soup.
T: I like fish soup. What would you like?
…
2. Watch the cartoon and answer the question.
(1)T: It’s 6:00 o’clock in the evening. It’s time for dinner.
My restaurant is open now. Welcome to Fresh Restaurant. This is the
menu. (课件出示: 教材 P49 Let’s learn 板块的菜单) What would you like?
S1: I’d like some beef, please.
T: You should eat some rice, noodles or bread. Or you won’t be
full.
(课件出示:标示出菜单中的主食:rice, noodles, bread)
S1: I’d like some beef and rice, please.
T: OK. Twenty-one yuan, please. Oh, look! Zoom and Zip are in my
restaurant. What would Zoom like? Guess!
S1: Maybe some…
S2: Maybe some…
…
T: Maybe! Let’s watch the cartoon and answer “What would Zoom
like?”
Play the cartoon of “Let’s learn”. (出示课件) Ask students to
read after it.
(2)Let students read the dialogue again and answer the question.
Teaching purpose
继续创设情境,结合情
境练习本课句型,再在上一
课的句型基础上加上食物的
价格,让学生将食物与价格
建立起联系,为之后的对话
创编做好准备。教师播放
Let’s learn 板块的录音,学生
听录音跟读,引导学生按照
正确的语音、语调朗读对话。
通过在小组中创编并分角色
表演对话,激发学生的兴趣,
然后挑选小组,全面呈现操
练结果,巩固本课的重点句
型,强化语言知识点。
201
Check students’ answers and lead students to make an introduction
according to their answers. It can be done like this: Zoom says, “I’d
like some vegetables, please.”
(3)Read and act.
①Play the recording again and ask students to read after it. (出
示课件)Lead students to try to imitate the pronunciation and the
intonation of the recording. Let them read together and read freely.
②Let students read the dialogue in pairs and choose some food.
Several minutes later, ask some students to act out their dialogues.
Make a model:
S1: What would you like?
S2: I’d like some chicken, vegetables and rice.
S1: OK. Twenty-one yuan, please.
S2: Here you are.
…
③Choose the best performers and give awards.
Step 3: Practice
1. Play a game—“What’s missing?”
(游戏说明:单词 noodles, vegetables, beef, chicken, soup 在课件上
逐一消失,让学生快速读出消失的单词。)
2. Let’s match.
Let students match the corresponding words with the pictures.
T: Now let’s match. I show the pictures, you read the words.
3. Play a game—“What would I like?”
Make a model:
T: Please guess. It’s five yuan on the menu. What would I like?
S1: You’d like some juice.
T: No.
S2: I know. You’d like some vegetables. Please guess. It’s ten
yuan on the menu. What would I like?
S3: …
Ask some students to do as they do.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Let’s play.
Let students work in groups of six.
T: You know the restaurant well and you know how much the food is.
Now let’s play. Please make a dialogue in groups. One of you can be
the waiter or waitress in the restaurant. The others go to the
restaurant and order.
Teaching purpose
通过活动,使学生形成
对于新授词汇的立体记忆,
以达到牢固掌握本课新授词
汇的目的。
Teaching purpose
让学生以点餐的方式来
进行对话练习。教师提供语
言架构支持,使学生在模拟
的情境中进行比较流畅的对
话,帮助学生提高口语表达
能力。
Teaching purpose
这是对学生听说读写中
“写”的训练,同时让学生
明白“珍惜粮食, 科学搭配,
均衡营养”,并学会根据自己
2. According to the dining principles, design your own three meals.
Choose students with the most reasonable three meals and the best
handwriting.
▶板书设计
203
▶作业设计
1. Read the new words and the dialogue of “Let’s learn” five times.
2. Design three meals for your parents.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 由 chant 和游戏引入,带领学生复习已学的与食物有关的单词和上一课的句型,迅速抓住学生的注意
力。
2. 通过情景引入新词,做到在语篇中呈现单词,具有情景性和完整性,也最大限度地增加了单词在篇章
中的运用频率,尽可能地提高综合语言运用能力。
3. 从听到说,再到读,从大量的输入再到学生自主的输出,由易到难,呈现递进关系,同时运用多种方
式调动学生学习的能动性与积极性。
4. 最后把“写”与生活相结合,并对学生进行思想教育,让学生把所学知识与生活更紧密地结合起来。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s learn
· Be able to listen, speak and read the words “beef, chicken, noodles, soup, vegetable”.
· Be able to use the sentence structures “—What would you like? —I’d like some…” skillfully
to ask for and express the will to eat.
Let’s play
· Be able to simulate the dialogue between the customer and the waiter when ordering in the
restaurant and quickly find the picture of food or judge the correctness of the pictures.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to listen, speak and read the words “beef, chicken, noodles, soup, vegetable”.
·Be able to use the sentence structures “—What would you like? —I’d like some…” skillfully
in real or virtual situations to ask for and express the will to eat.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the key words and sentence structures to carry out simple ordering activities.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Let’s chant.
3. Sharp eyes.
1. Greetings.
2. Read the chant together
and make a new chant.
3. Review the words of food
and drinks.
Stimulate students’
learning interest. Review
the contents of “Let’s
talk”. Create a learning
atmosphere and pave the way
for learning new knowledge.
Presentation
1. Teach the new words.
Teach the new words
“noodles, vegetables,
beef, chicken, soup”.
Learn the new words.
Pay attention to the
singular, plural and
uncountable forms of the
words about food.
Create a situation and use
the restaurant environment
to bring out the key
knowledge of this lesson.
Introduce the words about
food by using the menu. Help
students accumulate words
for the next step.
2. Watch the cartoon and
answer the question.
(1)Play the cartoon. Let
students guess what Zoom
would like.
(2)Let students read the
dialogue again and
answer the question.
(3)Read and act.
(1)Watch the cartoon and
guess the answer.
(2)Read the dialogue and
answer the question.
Check the answer with the
teacher. Make an
introduction according to
the answer.
(3)Read in different ways
and act out.
Create a situation to
practice the sentence
structures. Establish a
link between the food and
its price by adding the
price of the food. Prepare
for the creation of a new
dialogue.
Practice
1. Play a game—“What’s
missing?”
2. Let’s match.
3. Play a game—“What
would I like?”
Make a model.
1. Say the missing word.
2. Match the corresponding
words with the pictures.
3. Some students say the
price of the food and the
others guess what they
would like.
Let students form a
three-dimensional memory of
the new words through the
activities so as to achieve
the purpose of mastering the
new words of this lesson
firmly.
205
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Let’s play.
Let students work in
groups of six.
2. According to the dining
principles, ask students
to design their own three
meals.
1. Make a dialogue in
groups.
2. Design their own three
meals.
Improve students’
ability of speaking and
writing by practicing the
dialogue and designing
their own three meals.
Homework
1. Read the new words and the dialogue of “Let’s learn” five times.
2. Design three meals for your parents.
3. Do the exercises.
The third period(第三课时)
Part A Let’s spell
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s spell
·能够感知并归纳-e 在单词中的发音规则
·能够读出符合-e 发音规则的单词
·能够根据单词读音拼写出符合-e, -e-以及 a-e, i-e, o-e, u-e 发音规则的单词
▶教学重点
1.感知并归纳字母 e 在开音节(-e)与闭音节(-e-)中的发音规则。
2.能够读出符合-e 和-e-发音规则的单词。。
▶教学难点
能够根据单词的读音拼写出符合发音规则的单词。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、卡片等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Let’s chant. Teaching purpose
通过复习已经学过的字
母发音自编韵句进行热身,
帮助唤醒学生的已有知识。
T: Who can try to make a new chant like this? Please have a try!
Step 2: Presentation
207
1. Present the pictures.
(1)Talk about the pictures.
T: This is Lee. He is ten. He has… Tell me more about him.
Ss: He is thin. He has a red pen.
T: Look! This is Eve. Tell me something about her.
Ss: Eve is a girl. She is ten. She has a yellow pen.
(课件出示:男孩女孩身边的笔消失,然后一起找笔,红色的笔在课桌上,
黄色的笔在床上)
T: Where’s the red pen? Where’s the yellow pen?
Ss: The red pen is on the desk. The yellow pen is on the bed.
(课件出示:Zoom 出现并拿到笔说:“Let me get the pens.”)
Write down “he, she, me” and “ten, red, pen, yellow, desk, bed”
on the blackboard.
T: Read the chant together, then observe these words and tell me
the common letter among them.
Ss: Letter “e”.
(2)Look at the words and find out the pronunciation rules.
T: Look at these words “he, she, me”. What’s the sound of the
letter “-e”? Listen to me carefully. (Read these words.)
Ss: /i: /.
Teach the sound /i: /.
T: Look at these words “ten, red, pen, yellow, desk, bed”. What’s
the sound of the letter “-e-”? Listen to me carefully. (Read these
words.)
Ss: /e/.
Teach the sound /e/.
(3)Compare these words and summarize the pronunciation rules of
the letter “e”.
Teaching purpose
让学生通过读韵句观察
一些单词,发现它们的共有
字母 e 在-e 的结构中发相同
的读音/i: /,在-e-的结构中发
/e/。通过随录音跟读,让学
生初步感知、体验音素与字
母之间的对应关系,为下面
的拼读练习做准备
2. Let’s read.
Show the words “me, be, we, set, red, hen, beg, let” on the PPT.
(出示课件)
T: Who can read these words?
(1)Ask some students to read these words.
(2)Read aloud together.
3. Read, listen and chant.
(1)Show the pictures and the words. (课件出示:教材 P50 Read, listen
and chant 部分的内容)
Ask students to read the words one by one and then read in groups.
(2)Let’s chant.
Show the chant of “Read, listen and chant” on the PPT.
①Ask students to listen and read after it.
②Read together with students.
Step 3: Practice
1. Read, listen and tick.
(课件出示:教材 P50 Read, listen and tick 部分的图片)
T: Look at these words. Who can read these words?
Ss: …
T: Good! Now listen to the recording and tick the words you hear,
please. (课件出示:教材 P50 Read, listen and tick 部分的音频)
Check the answers.
Answers: be; red; me; she; let
2. Listen, circle and write.
(1)Let students observe the four pictures and guess what words
should be filled in the picture. (课件出示:教材 P50 Listen, circle and
write 部分的图片)
(2)Lead students to listen to the recording and write down the
answers. Then check the answers.
Answers: rice; he; red; we
T: Rice. Is it for “-e” or “i-e”?
Ss: It’s for “i-e”.
T: So circle “i-e”.
T: He, circle…
Ss: “-e”.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. 1Play a game—“Pick the apples from the tree.”
Teaching purpose
让学生将单词的读音与
拼写结合起来,同时帮助学
生区分字母 e 在开音节与闭
音节里的不同发音。
Teaching purpose
让学生在做游戏和任务
过程中感知字母 e 的发音。
Teaching purpose
教师变换不同的辅音字
母,让学生尝试读出新单词。
对含有字母 e 的单词的读
音,进行强化训练。培养学
生“见词能读”的能力。
Teaching purpose
在歌谣中练习所学字母
e 的读音,做到音不离词,
词不离句。
Teaching purpose
让学生通过观察和书写
单词,训练学生根据发音规
则拼写单词的能力,真正做
到把语音的学习落实到单词
的拼写上面。培养学生“听
词能写”的能力。
209
(课件出示:一棵苹果树,苹果上的单词为“we, wet, yes, me, pencil,
Lee, hen, be, set, met, he, let, desk, tell, she”,树下两个篮子,一
个是“-e/i:/”,一个是“-e-/e/”)
Divide students into two groups. Let one group use the basket
“-e/i:/” and the other use the basket “-e-/e/”.
T: Now you’re competing to pick apples. Give you ten seconds. The
winner belongs to the fast and accurate group.
2. Listen and lift.
The teacher gives out some word cards to students. When the teacher
says a word, students find the corresponding word card and lift it up.
3. Make a new chant.
T: It’s chant time. Listen first, then chant together. E, e, e;
it’s in “he”, /i:/, /i:/, /i:/. E, e, e; it’s in “pen”, /e/, /e/,
/e/.
Ask students to make a new chant one by one.
Use these chants to review the pronunciations of letters “a, e,
i, o, u”.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Write the words “rice, he, red, we” in four lines and three grids.
2. Think about other words with the letter “-e” and “-e-”.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
本课是人教 PEP 四年级上册第五单元的语音教学板块。小学英语语音教学是教会小学生运用英语语音的基
本知识,提高听、说、读、写的基本技能,培养学生的英语语感以及对听、说的感性认识。结合四年级学生的
年龄特点,本课设计突出了以下几点:
1. 创设语言情境,在语境中学习语音。
2. 拼读结合,在多层次的活动中练习语音。
3. 由浅入深,培养了学生的分析能力和举一反三的能力。
4. 利用自编 chant,师生频繁互动,小组竞赛等形式,使原本枯燥的语音课变得生动起来。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s spell
Teaching purpose
锻炼学生能听懂所学的
语音例词。提高学生的听音
辨音能力。
Teaching purpose
通过韵句来完整呈现本
课的重点语音知识,并复习
总结前四课的语音知识。
· Be able to perceive and summarize the pronunciation rule of “-e” in words.
· Be able to read words that conform to the pronunciation rule of “-e”.
· Be able to spell out the words that conform to the pronunciation rules of “-e, -e-” and “a-e,
i-e, o-e, u-e” according to the pronunciation of the words.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to perceive and summarize the pronunciation rules of the letter “e” in the open syllable
and closed syllable.
·Be able to read the words that conform to the pronunciation rules of “-e” and “-e-”.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to spell out the words that conform to the pronunciation rules according to the
pronunciation of the words.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Let’s chant.
1. Greetings.
2. Read the chant together.
Warm up with the
pronunciation of the
letters they have learned
through the chant.
Presentation
1. Present the pictures.
(1)Talk about the
pictures.
(2)Look at the words and
find out the
pronunciation rules.
(3)Compare these words and
summarize the
pronunciation rules of
the letter “e”.
(1)Talk about the pictures,
then read the chant and
review the words “he, she,
me” and “ten, red, pen,
yellow, desk, bed”.
(2)Read and find out the
pronunciation rules. Learn
the sounds of“/ i:/”and
“/e/”.
(3)Compare these words.
Let students have a
preliminary perception by
reading rhymes. Find out
the pronunciation rules by
observing and comparing.
Prepare for the following
spelling exercises.
2. Let’s read.
Show the words “me, be,
we, set, red, hen, beg,
let” on the PPT.
Read these words. Pay attention
to the pronunciation of letter
“e” in the words.
Change different
consonants and ask
students to read the new
words. Develop students’
ability to read words.
3. Read, listen and chant.
Teach the words and play
the chant.
Learn the words and chant
together.
Practice the
pronunciations of letter
“e” in rhymes. Keep the
sounds in the words, and
keep the words in the
sentences.
211
Practice
1. Read, listen and tick.
Ask students to read the
words and finish the
exercises.
Check the answers.
Read these words.
Listen to the recording and tick
the words they heard.
Check the answers.
Let students combine the
pronunciation of the words
with the spellings. At the
same time, help students
distinguish the
pronunciations of the
letter “e” in the open
syllable and the closed
syllable.
2. Listen, circle and
write.
Let students observe the
four pictures and write
down the words.
Listen to the recording and
write down the words.
Let students observe and
write down the words.
Train students to spell
out the words according to
the pronunciation rules.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Play a game—“Pick the
apples from the tree.”
Divide students into two
groups.
2. Listen and lift.
Give out some word cards
and say the words.
3. Make a new chant.
Make an example.
1. Compete to pick the apples.
2. Find the corresponding word
card and lift it up.
3. Make a chant one by one.
Let students feel the
pronunciations of the
letter “e” in the
process of playing games
and finishing tasks.
Improve students’
ability of listening and
distinguishing.
Use the chant to review the
pronunciations of letters
“a, e, i, o, u”.
Homework
1. Write the words “rice, he, red, we” in four lines and three grids.
2. Think about other words with the letter “-e” and “-e-”.
3. Do the exercises.
The fourth period(第四课时)
Part B Let’s talk & Let’s play
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s talk
·能够理解对话大意
·能够用正确的语音、语调朗读对话
·能够在情景中恰当运用句型“—Would you like…? —Yes, please./No, thanks. I can
use…”提出餐具使用建议并做出正确回应
·能够在情景中恰当运用功能句“Help yourself.”
·能够在语境中理解新词“knife, fork, chopsticks”的意思,并能够正确发音
Let’s play ·能够在选择食物的场景中巩固运用句型“Would you like some…?”
▶教学重点
1.能够听懂、会说句型“—Would you like some…? —Yes, please./No, thanks.”“Help yourself.”。
2.能够理解并正确朗读课文对话,做到发音准确、语调自然。
▶教学难点
能够在真实的情景中运用本课的句型来向别人提出用餐建议或餐具使用建议。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2.PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、卡片、筷子和刀叉等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Enjoy the song—What would you like? (课件出示:教材 P54 Let’s
sing 板块的歌曲动画)
3. Play a game—“What’s missing?”
(课件出示:egg, juice, bread, milk, water, fish, rice, cake, beef,
chicken, noodles, soup, vegetables 的图片依次快速出现,再消失)
T: Look! A lot of food! What are they?
Ss: …
T: Now, what’s missing?
Ss: …
4. Free talk.
T: What delicious food! Oh, I’m hungry. I’d like some fish,
chicken and beef. (教师表现出一副很想品尝的模样) What would you like?
Ss: I’d like some…
Step 2: Presentation
1. Teach the new words and sentences.
(1)(课件出示:18:00 的闹钟和一些食物的图片)
T: It’s time for dinner. What would you like for dinner? Would
you like some beef? If you would, you can say, “Yes, please.” If you
wouldn’t, you should say, “No, thanks.”
S1: Yes, please.
T: Would you like some rice?
S2: No, thanks.
…
Teaching purpose
通过听音乐和玩游戏来
复习学过的词汇,在自由谈
话中复习 A 部分的句型,帮
助唤醒学生的已有知识,并
为下一环节的学习做好准
备。
Teaching purpose
设置情景,让学生在情
景中学习新单词,感知新句
型。
213
Write down the sentence structures “—Would you like some…? —Yes,
please./No, thanks.” on the blackboard. Read these sentences
together.
(2)T: I want to eat some noodles. What can I use? (课件出示:
一双筷子和一副刀叉)
T: (Pick up the prepared tableware.) Chopsticks or a knife and fork?
(Students point to the chopsticks.)
T: Yes, chopsticks/ /,
ch/tʃ/-o/ɒ/-chop/tʃɒp/-sticks/stɪks/, / /. I can use
chopsticks.
Write down the word “chopsticks” on the blackboard and teach it.
(3)T: (Point to S1.) He would like some beef. What can he use?
Chopsticks or a knife and fork?
(Students point to the knife and fork.)
T: Yes, a knife and fork. Knife/naɪf/, kn/n/-i/aɪ/-fe/f/, /naɪf/;
fork/fɔ:k/, f/f/-or/ɔ:/-k/k/, /fɔ:k/. Knives and forks are used in sets.
A set of knife and fork means a knife and fork. He can use a knife and
fork.
Write down the phrase “a knife and fork” on the blackboard and
teach it.
T: (Point to some food on the table on the PPT and say to students.)
Now, dinner’s ready! Help yourself. Help/help/, e/e/, help/help/,
yourself/ /, your/jɔ:/-self/self/, yourself/ /.
Write down the sentence “Help yourself.” on the blackboard and
teach it.
T: You are all polite, so you should say…
Ss: Thanks.
T: Good! Oh, I can use chopsticks, but I can’t use a knife and
fork. Can you teach me?
Ask a student to demonstrate how to use it on the platform.
T: The fork is on the left. The knife is on the right. Do like this.
(教师做使用刀叉的动作) Now, I can use a knife and fork. Thank you.
2. Let’s talk.
(1)Present the first picture of “Let’s talk”. (课件出示:教
材 P51 Let’s talk 板块的图一)
T: Look. Mike is at Wu Yifan’s home. It’s 6:00 in the afternoon.
It’s time for dinner. Dinner’s ready. What’s for dinner? Look at
Picture 1.
S1: Soup, beef, vegetables and bread.
T: They are all western food. Why?
S2: Mike is from Canada.
T: Would Mike like a knife and fork for dinner? Guess!
S2: Yes./No.
Teaching purpose
通过各种活动,使学生
能够充分理解课文内容,并
且能够正确朗读课文。在不
同形式的读和表演活动中,
使学生逐步理解并掌握本课
的重点句型,为其熟练表达
奠定基础。
(2)Watch the cartoon and answer the questions. (课件出示:教
材 P51 Let’s talk 板块的视频)
T: When you listen to the recording, pay attention to the
pronunciation and the intonation. And underline the key sentences in
your book.
(3)Check the answers.
①T: Would Mike like a knife and fork?
S1: No. Mike says, “No, thanks.”
②T: What can he use? Can he use chopsticks?
S2: He can use chopsticks. Mike says, “I can use chopsticks.”
③T: Would Mike like some soup?
S3: Yes. Mike says, “Yes, please!”
(4)Read and act.
①Read after the recording and pay attention to the pronunciation
and the intonation.
②Let students practice the dialogue in groups.
③Act out.
Ask some groups to perform in different roles.
Step 3: Practice
1. Make a new dialogue.
Take out some pictures of food and tableware. Let students work
in pairs to make a new dialogue.
Make a model:
T: Would you like some bread/…? (Take out a picture of food.)
S1: Yes, please./No, thanks.
T: (Take out a picture of tableware.) Would you like a knife and
fork/chopsticks?
S1: Yes, please./No, thanks. I can use chopsticks/a knife and fork.
T: Now practice the dialogue with your partner.
2. Let’s play. (课件出示:教材 P51 Let’s play 板块的图片)
T: Let’s go to a restaurant now. Look! Today’s specials. Soup
is only 1 yuan now. Noodles are only 3 yuan now. Juice is only 2 yuan.
Fish is only 8 yuan. Beef is only 10 yuan. Vegetables are only 5 yuan.
So cheap!
Teaching purpose
通过创编对话让学生把
握重点句型的结构,熟练表
达重点句型。
Teaching purpose
利用教材中有关特惠菜
的图片进行对话交流,让学
生在交流中练习、使用重点
句型,培养学生灵活运用语
言的能力。既能落实课标的
要求,又能实现语言的迁移
运用。
215
Let students work in pairs. Make a model with a student.
T: Here are today’s specials. Would you like some beef?
S1: Yes, please. How much is it?
T: Ten yuan.
T: Now, do it in pairs. Ask and answer, please.
Ask some pairs to perform on the platform.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Make a new dialogue. (课件出示:吴一凡去 Mike 家吃饭的情景图)
T: Look. Who are they?
Ss: They are Mike’s mum, Mike and Wu Yifan.
T: Today Wu Yifan is at Mike’s home for dinner. Mike is from Canada.
What’s for dinner, Chinese food or western food? Guess!
Ss: Chinese food. Wu Yifan is from China.
(课件出示:分类展示中餐和西餐的图片)
T: Please make a new dialogue with your partners.
Let students work in groups of three. Then act out their dialogues.
Make a model:
2. Let’s chant.
Change the words to make a new chant.
▶板书设计
Teaching purpose
设置吴一凡去 Mike 家
做客的情境更具延续性。引
导学生运用所学新句型,结
合旧知,创编新对话,提高
语言的综合运用能力。
▶作业设计
1. Listen and imitate the dialogue of “Let’s talk” for three times.
2. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 在课前热身阶段,通过听歌曲、玩游戏、对话等活动让学生们在轻松的气氛中进入复习,同时这些食
物类的单词和句型也起到了承上启下的作用,为新课做了一定的铺垫。
2. 设计与生活相近、与课文内容也相关的语境,导入新词汇和句型,再自然地引入课文。环环相扣,层
层深入,让学生轻松地掌握课文内容。
3. 呈现的活动丰富、操练形式多样,充分调动了学生的积极性,使学生能够积极主动地参与到活动中,
既拓展了思维,也明显提高了语言能力。
4. 本节课的对话学习中穿插了中西饮食文化中餐具使用的差异,充分激发了学生的学习兴趣。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s talk
· Be able to understand the general idea of the dialogue.
· Be able to read the dialogue with the correct pronunciation and intonation.
· Be able to use the sentence structures“—Would you like…? —Yes, please./No, thanks. I can
use…”to offer suggestions on the use of tableware and make correct response in situations.
· Be able to use the functional sentence “Help yourself.” in situations properly.
· Be able to understand the meanings of the new words “knife, fork, chopsticks” in the context,
and pronounce them correctly.
Let’s play
·Be able to consolidate and use the key sentence structures in the scene of food selection.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand and say the sentence structures “—Would you like some…? —Yes, please.
/No, thanks.” “Help yourself.”
·Be able to understand and read the text correctly with accurate pronunciation and natural
intonation.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the sentence structures of this lesson in real situations to give advice on dining
or using tableware to others.
▶Teaching Procedures
217
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Enjoy the song.
3. Play a game—“What’s
missing?”
4. Free talk.
Ask some questions.
1. Greetings.
2. Enjoy the song.
3. Say the missing words.
4. Answer the questions.
Review the words learned
by listening to music and
playing games. And review
the sentence structures of
Part A in free talk. Help
students arouse their
existing knowledge and
prepare for the next step.
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Presentation
1. Teach the new words and
sentences.
Learn the new words and
sentences.
Set the situation, and let
students learn the new words
in situations and perceive
the new sentence
structures.
2. Let’s talk.
(1)Present the first
picture of“Let’s
talk”.
(2)Play the cartoon and
ask three questions.
(3)Check the answers.
(4)Read and act.
Let students practice
the dialogue in groups.
(1)Talk about the picture.
(2)Watch the cartoon and
answer the questions.
(3)Check the answers with
the teacher.
(4)Read after the
recording. Practice the
dialogue in groups. Then
act out.
Let students understand and
master the key sentence
structures in this lesson
gradually, and lay the
foundation for their
skillful expression.
Practice
1. Make a new dialogue.
Show some sentences on
the PPT. Make a model.
Look at the sentences on the
PPT.
Make a new dialogue in pairs
according to the example.
Through making new
dialogues, let students
grasp the structures of key
sentences and express them
skillfully.
2. Let’s play.
Show the picture of
“Let’s play” on the
PPT. Set a scene for
students to practice.
Make a model.
Look at the picture of
“Let’s play”.
Practice in pairs according
to the picture of “Let’s
play”.
Ask and answer as the
teacher’s model. Perform
on the platform.
Let students practice the
key sentence structures.
Cultivate students’
ability to use language
flexibly.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Make a new dialogue by
imitating the text.
Give the central
sentences.
2. Let’s chant.
Give an example.
1. Talk about the main scene
with the teacher.
Make a new dialogue in
groups of three. Act out
the dialogue.
2. Change the words to make
a new chant.
Through the two activities,
let students practice and
use the key words and
sentence structures they
have learned.
Homework 1. Listen and imitate the dialogue of “Let’s talk” for three times.
2. Do the exercises.
The fifth period(第五课时)
219
Part B Let’s learn & Let’s do
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s learn ·能够听、说、认读单词“chopsticks, bowl, fork, knife, spoon”
·能够运用句型“Pass me the knife and fork, please.”熟练地表述就餐时需要的餐具
Let’s do ·能够听懂指令,并根据指令做出正确的动作
▶教学重点
1.能够听懂、会说、认读单词“chopsticks, bowl, fork, knife, spoon”。
2.能够运用句型“Pass me the knife and fork, please.”熟练地表述就餐时需要的餐具。
▶教学难点
能够熟练且正确地向别人提出用餐建议或使用餐具的建议并做出正确的回应。。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、卡片、餐具、蔬菜等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Let’s chant.
3. Sharp eyes.
T: Now let’s play a game. When you see the picture, try to say
the word as quickly as you can. (课件出示:egg, juice, bread, milk, water,
fish, rice, cake, beef, chicken, noodles, soup, vegetables 的图片逐
一快速闪现)
4. Lead-in.
T: Do you know what I would like? Can you guess?
S1: Would you like some bread?
T: No, thanks.
S2: Would you like some beef?
Teaching purpose
由上一课时与本课的重
点句型作为韵句的主要结构
来进行热身,帮助唤醒学生
的已有知识,并为下一环节
的学习做好准备。
Teaching purpose
通过用课件快速闪现食
物图片,让学生快速说出单
词,在复习旧知的同时为学
习新知做铺垫,这个游戏能
使学生注意力高度集中,快
速融入课堂。
T: Yes, please.
…
T: What would I like? Yes, I’d like some beef,… (Write down the
food the teacher likes on the blackboard.)
Step 2: Presentation
1. Teach the new words and sentences.
(1)Teach the words “pass, knife, fork”.
(教师拿出餐具:chopsticks, a knife and fork, a spoon, a bowl)
T: Oh, I’m hungry. I’d like some beef. How can I eat it?I can
use…
S1: A knife and fork.
T: Good. I can use a knife and fork. Pass me the knife and fork.
Pass/pɑːs/, a/ɑː/, pass/pɑːs/. Pass me the knife and fork.
Write down the sentence “Pass me the knife and fork.” on the
blackboard and teach it.
T: Thank you. Knife/naɪf/, kn/n/-i/aɪ/-fe/f/. Knife, knife, cut
with the knife. (教师边说边做动作,学生跟读)
T: Fork/fɔ:k/, or/ɔ:/. Fork, fork, use the fork. (教师边说边做
动作,学生跟读)
T: Look! The knife is in my right hand. The fork is in my left hand.
Then cut with the knife and use the fork to eat. Can you use them now?
S1: Yes, I can. Let me show you.
T: Great! Can you use the knife and fork?
S2: No, I can’t.
T: Let me help you.
(2)Teach the word “bowl”.
T: (Show a bowl.) What’s this?
S2: 碗。
T: Yes, it’s a bowl. Bowl/bəʊl/, ow/əʊ/. Pass me the bowl. (用
动作示意 S2 把碗递过来)
T: Thank you! Bowl, bowl, pass me the bowl. (教师边说边做动作,
学生跟读)
Write down the word “bowl” on the blackboard and teach it.
T: What can I put in the bowl?
Ss: Rice./Noodles./Soup.
(课件出示:a bowl of rice, a bowl of noodles, a bowl of soup)
T: Bowl, bowl, a bowl of rice/a bowl of noodles/a bowl of soup.
(3)Teach the word “chopsticks”.
T: Oh, I’m hungry, too. I’d like a bowl of noodles. How can I
eat them? A knife and fork?
S3: No. Use the Chopsticks.
Teaching purpose
通过情景引入新词,把
单词和句子与情景结合起来
学习。在对话中加强学生对
新知的理解与运用能力。
221
T: Good. I can use the chopsticks. Chopsticks/ /, ch/tʃ/
-op/ɒp/-chop/tʃɒp/-sticks/stɪks/, / /. Pass me the
chopsticks. (用动作示意 S3 把筷子递过来)
T: Thanks. Chopsticks, chopsticks, use the chopsticks. (教师边
说边做动作,学生跟读)
Write down the word “chopsticks” on the blackboard and teach it.
(4)Teach the word “spoon”.
T: I can use the chopsticks to have noodles. Can I drink the soup
with the chopsticks?
S4: No.
T: I can use the spoon. Spoon/spu:n/, sp/sp/, oo/u:/. /u:/, noodles,
food, soup. Pass me the spoon. (用动作示意 S4 把勺子递过来)
T: Thank you. Spoon, spoon, use the spoon. (教师边说边做动作,学
生跟读)
Write down the word “spoon” on the blackboard and teach it.
2. Let’s learn. (课件出示:教材 P52 Let’s learn 板块的图片及音
频)
(1)Listen and ask.
T: John is eating dinner at Wu Yifan’s home. Wu Yifan’s mum cooks
a lot of delicious food. What can you see?
S1: I can see some rice, some beef, some vegetables, some soup…
S2: I can see a knife and fork, a spoon, some bowls, some
chopsticks…
T: Let’s listen to the recording, then answer the following
questions:
①What would John like?
②How can he eat it?
(2)Let students read after the recording and pay attention to the
pronunciation and the intonation.
(3)Check the answers.
T: What would John like?
S1: John would like some beef.
T: How can he eat it?
S2: He can use a knife and fork.
(4)Let students practice the dialogue in pairs.
(5)Act out the dialogue.
Step 3: Practice
1. Play games and practice the words.
(1)What’s missing?
(游戏说明:课件出示词汇“chopsticks, a knife and fork, a spoon,
a bowl”,然后让其中一个词汇快速消失,让学生说出消失的词汇。将词汇换
成图片,再玩一次。)
T: Please watch carefully and tell me what the missing word is.
Teaching purpose
在游戏中巩固本课所学
的新词,使学生学起来更轻
松更愉快,学习效果更好。
Teaching purpose
通过以上活动,使学生
能够充分理解课文内容,掌
握本课的重点单词和句型,
并且能够把本课学习的单词
和句型灵活地运用在一起。
(2)Listen and find.
Say a word or a phrase each time, and let students find the
corresponding picture. (课件出示:筷子、刀叉、勺子、碗的图片)
2. Let’s do.
(1)Make a salad.
T: You really did a good job. I want to make a salad for you. I
need some help. Who can help me?
Take out the prepared vegetables, knife, bowl, fork and spoon and
ask a student to help with the salad.
T: Look. A lot of vegetables. I want to make a vegetable salad.
S1, I say, you do. Pass me the bowl. Pass me the knife.
S1: Here you are.
T: Good, thank you. Go back to your seat. Let’s go on. Cut the
vegetables. Use the spoon. Use the fork. Now let’s try it! Wow, yummy!
(2)Listen and do some actions.
①Present the pictures of “Let’s do”. (课件出示:依次出示教材
P52 Let’s do 板块的图片,学生回答后呈现与图片对应的文字)
T: Let’s look at the pictures. I show, you say.
(Show Picture 1.)
S1: Pass me the bowl.
(Show Picture 2.)
S2: Pass me the knife.
…
②Listen to the recording and read after it. (课件出示:教材 P52
Let’s do 板块的音频)
③Listen to the order and point to the corresponding pictures.
T: Now I say, you point. Use the spoon.
S1: (Point to Picture 4.)
…
④Listen to the order and do the corresponding actions.
T: I say, you do. Pass me the knife.
S1: (Do the corresponding action.)
…
(3)Make a salad and taste the salad.
Make a salad in groups of four. Then taste the salad.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
Dinner time.
T: Suppose your friends are eating dinner at your home, make a
dialogue with your friends. Work in groups of three.
Make a model:
A: Dinner’s ready! Help yourself!
B: Thanks.
C: Would you like some…?
Teaching purpose
通过分享 的制作
过程让学生对本课的学习内
容更加感兴趣。利用
教学方法可以营造轻松愉快
的课堂气氛,更好地调动学
生的学习积极性。
Teaching purpose
通过创设情境,让学生
在情境中运用所学习的语言
知识,不仅可以帮助学生更
深层次地理解和掌握所学语
言知识,而且通过小组活动
可以培养学生的合作能力。
223
B: Yes, please./No, thanks. Pass me the…
C: Here you are.
Ask some groups to perform the dialogues on the platform and select
the best group.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Listen to the recording and read the new words and sentences for twenty minutes.
2. Make a salad for your parents.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 这是一节单词和句型的新授课。用 Let’s chant 这种说、做结合的活动来热身,既调节了气氛,又起
到了很好地承前启后的作用。
2. 把单词放入情景中教学,加深学生的理解和记忆,然后再通过游戏加以巩固,学习效果事半功倍。
3. 句型操练设计形式多样,以学生为本,层层递进,完成了语言从输入再到输出的过程。
4. Let’s do 部分制作沙拉,使用实物教学,边做边教学,再到学生自己动手做,自己品尝自己的成果,
把这节课推向高潮,学生不仅学会了做沙拉,也学会了用语言来表达沙拉的制作过程。
5. 板书设计清晰明了,重点突出,起到了很好的辅助作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s learn
· Be able to listen, speak and read the words “chopsticks, bowl, fork, knife, spoon”.
·Be able to use the sentence structure“Pass me the knife and fork, please.”to express the tableware
needed in dining skillfully.
Let’s do
·Be able to understand the instructions and make correct actions according to the instructions.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand, speak and read the words “chopsticks, bowl, fork, knife, spoon”.
·Be able to use the sentence structure“Pass me the knife and fork, please.”to express the tableware
for dining adroitly.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to give suggestions on dining or using tableware to others skillfully and correctly,
and make correct response.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Let’s chant.
3. Sharp eyes.
4. Lead-in.
1. Greetings.
2. Read the chant loudly and
act it out.
3. Say the word quickly.
4. Answer the questions.
Review the words about
food and related
sentence structures.
Help students awaken
their existing
knowledge.
225
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Presentation
1. Teach the new words and
sentences.
Learn the new words and
sentences.
Introduce the new words
through situations. Learn the
words in combination with the
situation. Strengthen
students’ understanding and
application of new knowledge
in dialogue.
2. Let’s learn.
(1)Play the recording and
ask.
(2)Play the recording
again.
(3)Check the answers.
(4)Let students practice
the dialogue in pairs.
(5)Let students act out the
dialogue.
(1)Listen and answer.
(2)Read after the recording
and pay attention to the
pronunciation and the
intonation.
(3)Check the answers with
the teacher.
(4)Practice the dialogue in
pairs.
(5)Act out the dialogue.
Understand the content of the
text, master the key words and
the sentence structures, and
use them flexibly through the
above activities.
Practice
1. Play games and practice
the words.
(1)What’s missing?
(2)Listen and find.
(1)Say the missing words.
(2)Listen to the teacher and
find out the
corresponding pictures.
Consolidate the new words in
the game. Make learning more
relaxing and enjoyable for
students, and make the
learning effect better.
2. Let’s do.
(1)Make a salad.
Teach how to make a
vegetable salad.
(2)Listen and do some
actions.
Show the pictures of
“Let’s do”.
(3)Make a salad and taste
the salad.
(1)Learn how to make a
salad.
(2)Listen and do the
relevant actions.
(3)Make a salad in groups
and taste it.
Stimulate students’
learning interest and
enthusiasm. Increase
students’ participation.
Consolidation
&
Extension
Dinner time.
Create a scene for
students. And give relevant
sentence structures.
Select the best group.
Make dialogues. Work in
groups of three. And show
the dialogue on the
platform.
Understand and master the
language knowledge at a
deeper level. Develop
students’ cooperative
ability through group
activities.
Homework
1. Listen to the recording and read the new words and sentences for twenty minutes.
2. Make a salad for your parents.
3. Do the exercises.
The sixth period(第六课时)
Part B Read and write & Let’s check & Let’s sing
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Read and write
·能够按意群和正确的语音、语调朗读对话并理解大意
·能够在有意义的语境中抄写本单元的话题词汇,完成句子
·能够综合运用本单元的核心词句
Let’s check ·检测学生是否能够听懂和理解本单元 A、B 部分的核心句型
·考查学生对于本单元核心词汇的认读和意义的理解
Let’s sing ·能够了解歌词意义,并能够清晰准确地歌唱
▶教学重点
1. 能够听懂、会说、认读本单元重点词汇。
2. 能够完成阅读、判断、匹配等活动,正确理解、认读本单元重点句型。
▶教学难点
1. 能够在有意义的语境中抄写本单元的话题词汇,完成句子。
2. 能够综合运用本单元的核心词句。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2. PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、卡片等。。
▶教学过程
Teaching purpose
通过听命令或问句找对
应词汇的互动形式来复习已
227
Step 1: Warm-up & Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Let’s do. (课件出示:教材 P52 Let’s do 板块的音频)
3. Listen and do.
The teacher pastes the pictures of tableware and food around the
classroom before class.
The teacher says, “Pass me…/Give me…” And students find the
right pictures and give them to the teacher. Or the teacher says, “What
would you like?” And students answer the question and find the right
pictures.
Step 2: Presentation
1. Pre-reading. (课件出示:傍晚 John 在家的图片)
(1)Look and say.
T: It’s time for dinner. Look! Where is John? Yes, he’s at home.
What would John like for dinner? Can you guess?
Ss: Beef./Bread…
The students guess the answers and the teacher writes down the words
on the blackboard. The teacher takes out the pictures of food and asks
several students to paste the pictures next to the corresponding words.
Show the pictures of tableware.
T: I’m hungry. I’d like some noodles. (教师从图片中随机抽取餐
具图片并提问) Can I have a spoon/a knife and fork/chopsticks, please?
Ss: Yes./No.
T: Would you like some noodles?
S1: Yes, please. (教师提示学生抽取一张餐具图片,其中不包含筷子
图片) Can I have a spoon/a knife and fork, please?
T: Yes, but try chopsticks for noodles.
Teach the sentence structures “Can I have…, please?” “Try…
for…” and ask students to practice them. (课件出示:①先呈现牛肉、
勺子图片,然后出现刀叉图片;②先呈现汤、筷子图片,然后出现勺子图片)
2. While-reading.
(1)Watch the cartoon and answer.
T: Look! John is at home with his mother. It’s time for dinner.
They are talking about their dinner. What would John like for dinner?
Watch the cartoon, find the answer and underline the key sentences.
(课件出示:教材 P53 Read and tick 部分的动画)
(2)Watch the cartoon again and answer.
T: Would John like some noodles? What can John use for noodles?
Watch the cartoon again, find the answers and underline the key
sentences. (出示课件)
(3)Read after the cartoon, then tick the pictures you read about
in the talk.
Teaching purpose
通过观察和描述图片,
在复习本单元的词汇和句型
的基础上认读理解本课的新
句型。
Teaching purpose
通过细读环节,培养学
生自主阅读获取信息和处理
信息的能力,进而提升学生
的阅读技巧,让学生比较扎
实地掌握所学知识。
Ask students to pay attention to imitating the accurate pause and
intonation and realize the emotion of the characters.
Check the answers.
Answers: Picture 2, 3, 5
(4)Read the dialogue after the teacher.
Instruct students to read the text according to the sense groups.
(5)Read the dialogue aloud.
(6)Act out the dialogue.
3. Post-reading.
Look, choose and write. (课件出示:教材 P53 Look, choose and write
部分的图片及练习)
(1)Talk about the soup and choose some words to fill in the blanks.
T: (Point to the soup.) What’s this? Yes, soup. This is John’s
soup. What’s in the soup?
Ss: Beef, vegetables and noodles.
T: If you are John, you can say, “In my soup, I’d like some beef,
vegetables and some noodles.” Pay attention to the spelling of these
words. When we write sentences, we should pay attention to capitalizing
the first letter. And we should also pay attention to punctuation marks.
Write the sentence on the blackboard for demonstration.
(2)Talk about your dinner and choose some words to fill in the
blanks.
T: Now suppose it’s 6:00 in the evening. It’s time for dinner.
What would you like for dinner? Please talk to your partner, then write
down your dinner in your book.
Write the sentence on the blackboard for demonstration:
I’d like some fish, vegetables and rice.
Step 3: Practice
1. Let’s check.
(1)Look at the pictures and describe them. (课件出示:教材 P54
Listen and tick 部分的图片)
Lead students to observe the four pairs of pictures carefully.
T: Let’s look at the first pair of pictures. What’s in the picture
above?
S1: Some soup and vegetables.
T: What’s in the picture below?
S2: Some vegetables and fish.
T: Let’s look at the second pair of pictures. What’s in the
picture above?
Teaching purpose
先引导学生观察图片中
的内容,再来选择正确的单
词进行填空,检验学生能否
正确地理解句子、认读单词。
最后让学生选择正确的单词
填写句子来介绍自己想吃的
晚餐食物,让学生在使用中
巩固所学知识。
Teaching purpose
在完成听力练习之前,
引导学生观察图片获取信
息,养成在做听力之前先获
取信息的习惯。
229
S3: A spoon.
T: What’s in the picture below?
S4: Chopsticks.
…
(2)Listen and tick.
Play the recording. (课件出示:教材 P54 Listen and tick 部分的音
频) Ask students to tick the correct pictures.
(3)Check the answers.
Answers: 第一组:上图; 第二组:下图; 第三组:上图; 第四组:上图
2. Look and match.
(1)Look at the pictures and describe them. (课件出示:教材 P54 Look
and match 部分的图片)
T: Look at the table. What’s on the table? Talk about it with your
partner.
(2)Look and match.
(3)Check the answers.
Answers: 第一行从左到右序号:531410
第二行从左到右序号:78926
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Let’s write.
(1)Show some sentences with blanks on the PPT and let students try
to write and practice in groups.
(2)Choose the best one in each group, then select in the whole class.
Selection rules:
①Write correctly and beautifully.
②Eat healthily.
2. Let’s sing.
(1)Learn the first part of the song.
①Listen to the first part of the song, then answer: What would
I like? (出示课件)
Ss: Some fish and beef.
Teaching purpose
给学生自由想象的空
间,真正把语言活学活用之
后,再运用到写作之中,可
以提高学生的写作水平和语
言组织能力。
Teaching purpose
这个活动是检验学生对
单词的认读和理解能力的。
学生获得图片中的信息之后
再去匹配单词,如果他们能
够正确认读单词,就能很轻
松地完成这个活动。
Teaching purpose
这首歌与本单元的重点
内容息息相关,最后以学习
歌曲来结束本节以及本单元
课程,可以让学生在轻松欢
快的氛围中复习巩固本单元
的内容。
(课件出示:学生回答之后出示 fish 和 beef 的图片,再出现 dish 的图
片。做出鱼和牛肉放到碟子中的动画,通过动画让学生理解“Put it on my
dish.”的含义)
T: (鼠标点击鱼,鱼到碟中) Put it on my dish.
T: (鼠标点击牛肉,牛肉到碟中) Put it on my dish.
②Learn the first part of the song after the recording.
(2)Learn the second part of the song.
①Listen and do. (课件出示:图片 a fork, a spoon, a knife)
T: Please pass me a fork. (请一名学生上前找到 PPT 中 fork 的图片,
并点击图片,图片飞到碟子的左边)
T: Please pass me a knife. (请一名学生上前找到 PPT 中 knife 的图
片,并点击图片,图片飞到碟子的右边)
T: Please pass me a spoon. (请一名学生上前找到 PPT 中 spoon 的图
片,并点击图片,图片飞到碟子中)
T: Now, dinner’s ready! Can we please eat soon? Can we please eat
soon? (教师边说边做动作,帮助学生们理解句子)
②Listen to the second part of the song and learn it. (出示课
件)
(3)Students sing the song while doing actions.
(4)Ask students to replace the words of food in the song when they
sing.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Write a family dinner plan.
2. Sing the song to your family.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
本课是本单元的最后一课时,它是一节综合复习的阅读课。
1. 热身部分就是对前面课程内容的复习。学生由唱到听最后到用,这样的复习很轻松,复习效果事半功
倍。
2. 在阅读这部分,从直观的看,到问答,再到读,让学生对这一部分内容烂熟于心,这样语言输入就完成了,
再通过练习与拓展,完成了语言输出的过程。
3. 学生们能正确地在四线三格内书写本单元的四会单词和句子。
4. 整个教学过程流畅自然,重点突出又有趣,达到了知识与趣味的结合。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
231
Read and write
·Be able to read the dialogue with the correct pronunciation and intonation and understand the
general idea of the dialogue.
·Be able to copy the topic words of this unit in meaningful context and complete the sentences.
·Be able to use the key vocabulary and sentences of this unit synthetically.
Let’s check
·Check students’ listening and understanding to the key sentence structures of Part A and Part
B in this unit.
·Examine students’ reading of the key words and understanding of the meanings of the words.
Let’s sing
·Be able to understand the meaning of lyrics and sing clearly and accurately.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand, speak and read the key words of this unit.
·Be able to complete the reading, judgment, matching and the other activities. Understand and
read the key sentence structures of this unit correctly.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to copy the topic words of this unit and complete the sentences in meaningful context.
·Be able to use the key words and sentences of this unit synthetically..
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Play the recording of
“Let’s do”.
3. Listen and do.
Give instructions or ask
questions.
1. Greetings.
2. Let’s do.
3. Find the right
pictures.
Review the key words and
sentence structures of
this unit by singing,
reading, listening and
speaking. Prepare for
the following study.
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Presentation
1. Pre-reading.
Show a picture of John
staying at home. Write the
words on the blackboard.
Take out the corresponding
pictures. Show the pictures
of tableware.
Guess what John would like
for dinner. Paste the
pictures. Choose the
tableware and practice
the sentence structures.
By observing and
describing the
pictures, read and
understand the new
sentence structures of
this lesson on the basis
of reviewing the
vocabulary and sentence
structures of this
unit.
2. While-reading.
(1)Play the cartoon and ask.
(2)Play the cartoon again and
ask.
(3)Let students read after the
cartoon and tick.
Check the answers.
(4)Let students read after the
teacher.
(5)Let students read aloud the
dialogue by themselves.
(6)Act out.
(1)Watch the cartoon and
answer.
(2)Watch the cartoon again
and answer.
(3)Read after the cartoon.
Then tick the pictures in
the talk. Check the
answers with the teacher.
(4)Read after the teacher.
(5)Read aloud.
(6)Act out.
Cultivate students’
ability of obtaining
and processing
information by close
reading, and then
improve students’
reading skills, so that
students can grasp the
knowledge solidly.
3. Post-reading.
Look, choose and write.
Lead students to observe the
picture and finish the
exercises.
Talk about the soup and
choose some words to fill in
the blanks. Talk about your
dinner and choose some words
to fill in the blanks.
Check whether students
can understand the
sentences and read the
words correctly. And
let students
consolidate their
knowledge by writing
sentences.
233
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Practice
1. Let’s check.
(1)Lead students to observe
and describe the pictures.
(2)Ask students to tick the
correct pictures.
(3)Check the answers.
2. Look and match.
(1)Lead students to describe
the pictures.
(2)Look and match.
(3)Check the answers.
1. Let’s check.
(1)Look at the pictures
and describe them.
(2)Listen and tick. Tick
the correct pictures.
(3)Check the answers.
2. Look and match.
(1)Look at the pictures
and describe them.
(2)Look and match.
(3)Check the answers.
This activity is to test
students’ ability to read
and understand the words.
Students get the
information from the
pictures and then match
the words. If they can
recognize the words
correctly, they can easily
complete the activity.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Let’s write.
(1)Show some sentences with
blanks on the PPT. Make a
model.
(2)Choose the best one.
Write something about
food and tableware.
Practice in groups.
Give students the space of
free imagination, and
apply the language to
writing after learning and
using, so as to improve
students’ writing level
and language organization
ability.
2. Let’s sing.
(1)Teach the first part of the
song.
(2)Teach the second part of
the song.
(3)Let students sing the song
while doing actions.
(4)Ask students to replace the
words of food in the song
when they sing.
(1)Learn the first part
of the song.
(2)Learn the second part
of the song.
(3)Sing the song while
doing actions.
(4)Replace the words of
food in the song.
This song is closely
related to the key content
of this unit. At last,
finish this section and
this unit by learning the
song, so that students can
review and consolidate the
content of this unit in a
relaxing and happy
atmosphere.
Homework
1. Write a family dinner plan.
2. Sing the song to your family.
3. Do the exercises.
Unit 6 Meet my family!
教材分析
本单元学习的主题是朋友之间如何互相了解对方的家庭情况。教学内容主要是通过谈论家
庭成员及其职业来展开的。教学重点是能够听、说、认读核心句型“—How many people are there
in your family? —Three.”“—Is this your uncle? —Yes, it is. He’s a football player.”
“—What’s your aunt’s job? —She’s a nurse.”;能够听、说、认读单词和短语“parents,
cousin, uncle, aunt, baby brother, doctor, cook, driver, farmer, nurse”。
教学目标
知识与能力目标:
句型
·能够听、说、认读句型“—How many people are there in your family? —Three.”“—Is
this your uncle? —Yes, it is. He’s a football player.”“—What’s your aunt’s job?
—She’s a nurse.”
·能够在情景中运用句型“How many people are there in your family?”询问并回答家中有
几位家庭成员;能够在情景中恰当运用句型“My family has six people.”“But that’s only
five.”
·能够在情景中运用句型“—Is this your…? —Yes, it is.”“—What’s your…’s job? —
He’s/She’s a…”询问并回答某人与说话方的亲属关系及其职业情况
·能够按照意群朗读 Read and write 文段中的核心句型
词汇
·能听、说、认读单词和短语“parents, cousin, uncle, aunt, baby brother, doctor, cook,
driver, farmer, nurse”
·能够在语境中正确使用上述有关家庭成员和职业的单词或短语简单介绍家庭成员及其职业
·能够在有意义的语境中抄写上述话题词汇
语音
·能够掌握 a-e, i-e, o-e, u-e, -e 在单词中的长音发音规则
·能够对比掌握 a, e, i, o, u 的长、短音发音规则
·能够根据发音规则正确读出生词,并能够按照示范例词的提示,从歌谣中找出符合 a, e, i, o,
u 长、短音发音规则的单词
情感态度、文化意识、学习策略目标:
·能够体会并表达对家庭和生活的热爱之情
·能够了解英语国家中家庭成员之间的称呼习俗
·能够逐步做到见到符合 a-e, i-e, o-e, u-e,-e 发音规则的单词能够拼读,听到符合发音规
则的单词能够拼写
课时安排
第一课时: Part A Let’s talk & Let’s count
第二课时: Part A Let’s learn & Let’s play
第三课时: Part A Let’s spell
第四课时: Part B Let’s talk & Draw and say
第五课时: Part B Let’ learn & Let’s play
第六课时: Part B Read and write & Let’s check & Let’s sing & Part C Story time
235
The first period(第一课时)
Part A Let’ s talk & Let’s count
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s talk
·能够在图片和教师的帮助下理解对话大意
·能够用正确的语音、语调朗读对话,并能够进行角色扮演
·能够在情景中运用句型“How many people are there in your family?”询问并回答家
中有几位家庭成员
·能够在情景中恰当运用句型“My family has six people.”“But that’s only five.”
·能够在语境中理解生词“people, but, little, puppy”的意思,并能够正确发音
Let’s count ·能够通过“看图数数”活动,在语境中运用句型“How many…are there in/on/near…
the…?”询问并回答物品数量
▶教学重点
1. 能够在图片和教师的帮助下理解对话大意;能够用正确的语音、语调朗读对话,并能够进行角色扮演。
2. 能够在情景中运用句型“How many people are there in your family?”询问并回答家中有几位家庭
成员。
▶教学难点
1. 能够熟练掌握句型“How many…are there…?”的用法,并能在实际情景中运用。
2. 能够掌握句型“My family has six people.”“But that’s only five.”并能进行初步运用。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2.PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、实物、头饰、家庭照片等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Revision.
Use the number of fingers and school supplies to review the
knowledge.
T: How many fingers/books/pens/…do you see?
Ss: …
Ask three boys/four girls to come to the platform.
T: How many boys/girls are there?
Ss: Three. / Four.
Step 2: Presentation
1. Let’s count.
(1) Show the picture of “Let’s count” on the PPT. (课件出示:
教材 P58 Let’s count 板块的图片)And talk about it with the sentence
structure “How many apples/ants/birds/…are there on/in the…?” in
class. (2) Teach the word “people”.
Teaching purpose
用英语对话快速吸引学
生的注意力,营造良好的英
语课堂氛围。通过谈论手指
及学校用品的数量帮助学生
复习数字的知识。运用课堂
上的实物和人物,操练句型
“How many…?”,为学习本
课的重点句型做准备。Teaching purpose
先请学生认真观察图
片,获取信息。然后请学生
数一数,以替换词汇的方式
练习重点句型。
T: Look in through the window. How many people are there in the
family?
Write down the word “people” on the blackboard and teach it.
T: p/p/-eo/ i:/-ple/pl/, people .
Then help students answer the question.
Ss: Three.
T: Who are they?
Ss: Father, mother and a boy.
T: Yes, they’re parents and the son.
(3) Teach the word “parents”.
Tell students “father + mother=parents”. Show a picture of
parents. ( 课 件 出 示 : 父 母 亲 的 图 片 ) Lead them to understand what
“parents” means.
T: p/p/-a/eə/r/-en/ ən/-ts/ts/, parents .
Let students read the word “parents” several times.
2. Teach the new sentence structures.
(1) Ask a student a question: How many people are there in your
family?
S1: Three. My father(dad), my mother(mum) and me.
T: You can also say “My parents and me.”
Write down the sentence structures “—How many people are there
in your family? —Three. My parents and me.” on the blackboard.
Lead students to make dialogues with the question “How many people
are there in your family?” according to the actual situations.
Students may answer with the words like brother, sister,
grandfather(grandpa) and grandmother(grandma). Ask students to read
and review these words.
(2) Present and practice the sentence structure “My family
has…people.”
T: …’s family has 5 people. What about you?
Ask students to practice the sentence structure in pairs. Then
choose some students to introduce their families.
(3) Present a survey form about the number of family members. (课
件出示:家庭成员人数调查表) Let students use the sentence structures
to carry out an investigation in groups of four and report the results
of the survey.
Present the results of a group survey. Point to the largest number
in the form and say, “Wow!It’s a big family!” Then point to the
smallest number and say, “But that’s only three.” Ask students to
guess the meaning of the sentence and then explain the meaning of
“but”.
(4) Take out a photo of the teacher’s family. Then point to the
family photo and ask the question.
Teaching purpose
在处理本课新授对话
时,采用从处理局部语言到
呈现完整对话的方式。先学
习对话中出现的新词、新句,
为后面学习并理解对话扫清
障碍。同时利用教学资源,
就学生的真实情况展开讨
论,提高语言运用的实践性,
也为完成下一步教学任务做
好铺垫。
237
T: Look! This is a photo of my family. How many people are there
in my family?
Ss: Five. T: No, my family has six people. This is my father. This
is my mother. This is my husband/wife. This is my little baby and this
is me. (Point to the pet.) And this is my little puppy.
Teach the words “baby, puppy” and ask students to read them. Use
body language to make students understand the meaning of “little”.
3. Let’s talk.
(1) Present the pictures of “Let’s talk” on the PPT. (出示
课件)
Lead students to observe the pictures and predict the main idea
of the dialogue.
(2) Watch the cartoon and answer the questions.
Show the questions. (出示课件) Play the cartoon and ask students
to answer the questions. (课件出示:教材 P58 Let’s talk 板块的动画) Let
students try to underline the answers in the book.
Q1: How many people are there in Chen Jie’s family? (Three.)
Q2: How many people are there in Amy’s family? Five or six? (Six.)
T: Great! Who are they in Chen Jie’s family? Who are they in Amy’s
family? Let’s watch the cartoon again.
Play the cartoon again. (出示课件) Ask students to try to underline
the answers in the book.
T: Who are they in Chen Jie’s family? You can answer like this:
Chen Jie says, “My parents and me.”
Ss: Chen Jie says, “My parents and me.”
T: Yes. The word “parents” here means “father and mother”. “My
parents and me.” means “Father, mother and Chen Jie.” So there are
three people in Chen Jie’s family.
T: Who are they in Amy’s family?
Ss: Amy says, “My dad, my mum, my sister, my baby brother and me.”
“And my little puppy!”
T: Wonderful!
(3)Play the recording of the dialogue. (出示课件) Ask students
to read after it and pay attention to the pronunciation and the
intonation.
Then show the sentences related to the dialogue on the PPT. Ask
students to fill in the blanks according to the dialogue.
Teaching purpose
通过观察对话情景图
片,初步猜测大意,激发学
生对新知的学习兴趣。然后
提出问题,激发学生的阅读
兴趣。在阅读对话后,通过
让学生回答问题帮助学生理
解对话含义,学会在具体语
境中运用新知。
Teaching purpose
通过跟读录音,帮助学
生用正确的语音、语调朗读
对话。通过构建语言框架,
让学生根据对话原文填空,
帮助学生充分理解课文内
容。
Step 3: Practice
1. Read the dialogue in roles.
T: Now, who wants to be Amy? Who wants to be Chen Jie? Let’s read
it in roles.
2. Act out the dialogue in class.
Take out some headdresses and ask some students to act out the
dialogue.
3. Play a game — “3D Family Photos”.
Lead students to work in groups of four. One student introduces
his/her family members, the others act out according to his/her
introduction in groups.
For example:
S1: Look, this is a photo of my family. This is my grandpa.
S2: Hi, I’m grandpa. I’m old. (Act with body language.)
S1: This is my dad.
S3: Hi, I’m Dad. I’m tall and strong. (Act with body language.)
…
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
Show a picture of Amy on the PPT. Introduce her family by using
the sentence structures of this lesson. Let students try to introduce
their families by following the example.
Ask students to practice in pairs. Then choose four students to
show in class. At last, select the best introduction.
▶板书设计
Teaching purpose
通过分角色朗读对话和
不同形式的表演活动,让学
生进一步理解并掌握本课的
重点句型,为学生能够熟练
运用重点句型进行表达奠定
基础。
Teaching purpose
通过课件的示范,让学
生运用所学词汇及句型介绍
自己的家庭,培养学生的综
合语言运用能力。
239
▶作业设计
1. Read and act out the dialogue of “Let’s talk”.
2. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 本课时主要学习谈论家庭成员。课程开始,由复习数字导入句型“How many…?”,结合活动中的图片操
练并运用句型。
2. 课程活动设计丰富,易操作,且具备层次感。从局部到整体,先学习对话中出现的新词、新句,为后面
学习并理解对话扫清障碍,有效地提升了学生的核心素养。结合表格进行调查,并谈论家庭成员的情况,帮助
学生理解核心句型的意义并学会运用。
3. 在对话教学时,从观察图片猜测内容,到预设问题粗读对话进行感知,经过听录音精读对话回答问题,
最后通过填空补充对话,复述内容。一步一步,由浅入深,由易到难,符合教学规律。并且通过多种形式的朗
读,帮助学生掌握对话,落实知识点。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s talk
· Be able to understand the main idea of the dialogue with the help of the pictures and the teacher.
· Be able to read the dialogue with the correct pronunciation and intonation and act it out in
different roles.
· Be able to use the sentence structure“How many people are there in your family?”in situations
to ask and answer the number of family members.
· Be able to use the sentences“My family has six people.”“But that’s only five.”appropriately
in situations.
· Be able to understand new words “people, but, little, puppy” in context and pronounce them
correctly.
Let’s count
· Be able to use the sentence structure“How many…are there in/on/near…the…?”in context
to ask and answer the number of things through counting activity.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand the main idea of the dialogue with the help of the pictures and the teacher.
Be able to read the dialogue with the correct pronunciation and intonation and act it out in
different roles.
·Be able to use sentence structure “How many people are there in your family?”in situations
to
ask and answer the number of family members.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to master the sentence structure “How many…are there…?” adroitly and use it in real
situations.
·Be able to master and use the sentences “My family has six people.”“But that’s only five.”
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Revision.
Practice the sentence
structures with fingers and
school supplies.
1. Greetings.
2. Answer the questions
and practice the
sentence structures.
Attract students’
attention quickly.
Practice the sentence
structures with objects
and characters in
class. Prepare for
studying the key
sentence structures in
this lesson.
Presentation
1. Let’s count.
(1) Show the picture of “Let’s
count” and talk about it
with the key sentence
structure.
(2) Teach the word “people”.
(3) Teach the word “parents”.
(1) Look at the picture and
talk about it.
(2) Answer the questions
and learn the word
“people”.
(3) Learn the word
“parents”.
Get information by
observing the picture
carefully. Practice the
key sentence structures
by replacing words.
2. Teach the new sentence
structures.
(1) Ask a student a question: How
many people are there in your
family?
(2) Present and practice the
sentence structure “My
family has…people.”
(3) Lead students to complete
the form. Teach the word
“but”.
(4) Teach the words “little,
baby,
puppy” with a family photo.
(1) Answer the question
and make dialogues
according to the actual
situations.
(2) Practice the sentence
structure “My family
has…people.” in
pairs.
(3) Use the sentence
structures to carry out
an investigation in
groups of four and
report the results.
Learn the word “but”.
(4) Learn the words
“little, baby,
puppy”.
Clear the way for
studying the new
dialogue by learning
the new words and
sentence structures.
Improve the
practicality of
language using by
discussing the actual
situations of students.
(续表)
Teaching Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
241
Stages
Presentation
3. Let’s talk.
(1) Present the pictures of
“Let’s talk” on the
PPT. Help students
predict the main idea of
the dialogue.
(2) Play the cartoon twice
and ask some questions.
(3) Play the recording. Ask
students to read the
dialogue after it.
Show the sentences
related to the dialogue
on the PPT. Ask students
to fill in the blanks.
(1) Observe the pictures and
predict the main idea of
the dialogue.
(2) Watch the cartoon twice.
Answer the questions.
(3) Read the dialogue after
the recording. Fill in
the blanks according to
the dialogue.
Stimulate students’
interest in learning
new knowledge
through observing
pictures. Use the
questions to attract
students’ attention
and help students
learn how to use new
knowledge in
specific contexts.
Make sure students
can read the dialogue
with the correct
pronunciation and
intonation.
Practice
1. Read the dialogue in
roles.
Ask students to read the
dialogue in roles.
1. Read the dialogue in
roles. Through reading the
dialogue in roles and
different forms of
performing
activities, let
students further
understand and
master the key
sentence structures.
2. Act out the dialogue in
class.
Ask students to act out
the
dialogue in class.
2. Act out the dialogue in
class.
3. Play a game— “3D Family
Photos”.
3. Work in groups of four.
One student introduces
his/her family members,
the others act out.
Consolidation
&
Extension
Show a picture of Amy.
Present an example.
Let students try to
introduce
their families by following
the
example.
Introduce their families by
following the example.
Cultivate students’
comprehensive
language using
ability by
introducing their
families.
Homework 1. Read and act out the dialogue of “Let’s talk”.
2. Do the exercises.
The second period(第二课时)
Part A Let’s learn & Let’s play
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s learn ·能够听懂、会说、认读单词和短语“parents, uncle, aunt, cousin, baby brother”
·能够在语境中正确运用以上单词和短语介绍自己的家人
Let’s play
·能够通过活动巩固所学单词和短语“parents, uncle, aunt, cousin, baby brother”
·能够在真实情景中运用句型“This is my… He’s/She’s…”介绍自己的家庭成员,并
简单描述其外貌特征
▶教学重点
1. 能够听懂、会说、认读单词和短语“parents, uncle, aunt, cousin, baby brother”,并能简单介
绍和描述自己的家人。
2. 能够理清家庭成员之间的关系。
▶教学难点
能够综合运用所学词汇和句型来介绍和描述自己的家人。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2.PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、人物头饰、家庭成员类单词卡片等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Lead-in
1. Greetings and enjoy a song.
Play the song—I love my family. (课件出示:PEP 三下教材 P20 Let’s
sing 板块的歌曲) Ask students to listen carefully and sing together.
2. Revision.
Take out the word cards of family members that students have learned
in Grade 3.
Choose several word cards at random. Ask students to read the words
and act with body movements according to the words on the cards.
3. Lead-in.
Show a photo of Tom’s family. (课件出示:男生 Tom 的家庭照片)
Lead students to introduce and describe Tom’s family members. Lead
in the relevant content of this lesson.
T: Boys and girls, look! This is Tom’s family. There are four
people in his family. This is his father. He is tall and strong. This
is his mother. She is short and nice. This is his baby sister. She is
little and cute. He loves his family.
Step 2: Presentation
1. Teach the phrase “baby brother”.
Show the picture of Amy’s outline on the PPT. (课件出示: Amy
的轮廓图) Ask students to guess who she is. Then play the recording
of Amy’s monologue “Hi. Meet my family!” (出示课件) Help students
understand the meaning of the sentences and ask them to read after the
recording.
Show the picture of the baby brother’s hair. (课件出示:Amy 弟弟
的头发图片) Lead students to guess basing on what they have learned:
Teaching purpose
以歌曲来吸引学生的注
意力,帮助他们开启英语学
习之旅。同时,复习有关家
庭成员和描述外貌的知识,
为接下来的学习做好知识与
心理的双重准备。
Teaching purpose
通过介绍 Tom 的家人,
让学生了解如何使用学过的
语言来介绍和描述他们的家
人,为下一环节的学习做好
准备。
Teaching purpose
用看人物轮廓猜一猜的
方式设疑,激发学生的学习
兴趣。从观察头发,到猜一
猜画中人物是谁,引导学生
进入新授知识的学习中,极
大地提高学习效率。
243
brother, sister, mother, father. Then show the complete picture of the
baby brother. (课件出示:Amy 弟弟的全图)
Write down the phrase “baby brother” on the blackboard and teach
it.
T: b/b/-a/eɪ/-b/b/-y/i/, baby .
T: This is Amy’s baby brother. He’s cute.
2. Teach the word “parents”.
Present the picture of Amy’s mum and dad’s outline. (课件出示:Amy
父母亲的轮廓图) Lead students to guess “father and mother”.
Continue to show the whole picture and teach the word “parents”.
(出示课件)
Write down the word “parents” on the blackboard and teach it.
3. Teach the words “uncle, aunt, cousin”.
Present the picture of Amy’s aunt and uncle on the PPT. (课件
出示: Amy 的叔叔和婶婶的图片) Ask a question: The man is Amy’s
father’s/mother’s brother. Who is he?
Help students understand the word “uncle”. Write it down on the
blackboard and teach it.
T: u/ʌ/-n/ŋ/-c/k/-le/l/, uncle / /.
Teach and practice the word “aunt” in the same way.
T: au/ɑː/-n/n/-t/t/, aunt /ɑːnt/.
Explain the usage of “aunt, uncle” in English-speaking
countries.
Show the picture of uncle and aunt’s child. (课件出示:叔叔婶婶
的孩子的图片)
T: She is Amy’s uncle’s daughter. She’s Amy’s…
Teach the word “cousin”.
T: c/k/-ou/ʌ/-s/z/-in/n/, cousin / /.
Explain the meaning of “cousin”: Uncle and aunt’s daughter or
son can be called “cousin”.
Write down the word “cousin” on the blackboard.
Point to the words “uncle, cousin”. Get students to pay attention
to the pronunciation of “u” and “ou”.
T: The letter “u” in “uncle” and the letter combination “ou”
in “cousin” both sound /ʌ/.
4. Listen, read and point.
Play the recording of the vocabulary of “Let’s learn” and ask
students to read after the recording. (课件出示:教材 P59 Let’s learn
板块中词汇部分的音频)
Let students listen again and point out the words or the phrase
they hear as they read them.
5. Let’s learn.
Teaching purpose
继续用猜人物的方式引
出单词,整合并复习上节课
学过的知识,并为后面教学
的自然过渡做铺垫。
Teaching purpose
在理解单词的意义以及
在中英国家中的不同用法的
基础上教授单词,帮助学生
更好地理解和掌握单词。
Teaching purpose
通过跟读录音,帮助学
生掌握正确的读音。通过边
读边指出该词这种形式,将
所学词汇的音和形相结合。
Show the picture of “Let’s learn”. (课件出示:教材 P59 Let’s
learn 板块的图片) Let students choose two people from the picture to
describe them according to the sentences on the PPT and act out in pairs.
Step 3: Practice
1. Sharp eyes.
Show pictures of Amy’s family members in a flash on the PPT, and
then pause at random. (出示课件) Let students say the vocabulary
related to the characters on the screen.
T: Who’s he/she?
Ss: He’s/She’s Amy’s…
2. Point and say.
Point to the vocabulary on the blackboard. Ask students to say it
out quickly.
3. A guessing game.
Show the back of the family members’ word cards. Ask students to
guess what word or phrase it is.
4. Make a “family tree”.
Ask students to make a “family tree” for Amy. Let students choose
the words or the phrase and fill them in the blanks of the family tree.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Let’s play.
Show the picture of “Let’s play” on the PPT. (课件出示: 教
材 P59 Let’s play 板块的图片) Lead students to observe the picture.
T: Look at Zhang Peng. He draws his family members on his fingers
and talks about his family members. Please draw and say in the same
way.
Ask students to work in groups by following the example on the PPT
and choose some students to show in class.
2. Make a summary.
Show the word “family” on the PPT and explain what it means.
Remind students to love their families and family members.
T: Look at the word “family”. F is from “father”. A is from
“and”. M is from “mother”. L is from “love”. Y is from “you”.
It’s a sentence: “Father and mother I love you.” Say it to your
parents. Do more for your parents. And I think your parents will love
you more.
Teaching purpose
在掌握词汇的基础上,
结合语言支架,挑选人物进
行描述并表演,灵活操练,
有效突出本课的重点。
Teaching purpose
三个活动的目的都是让
学生熟悉并操练重点词汇。
活动一帮助学生理解单词的
意思,并将单词图片与意义
结合起来。活动二让学生将
词形与读音结合起来。活动
三让学生通过反复地猜测来
不断重复重点词汇,进而熟
悉并掌握词汇。
Teaching purpose
以做家谱树的方式帮助
学生理清家庭成员之间的关
系。
Teaching purpose
这种趣味活动,一方面
可以激发学生的参与兴趣,
另一方面可以综合(课件出
示:Amy 家的家谱树图)介绍
家人和描述人物外貌特征的
知识,让学生在参与活动的
过程中提升自己的口语表达
能力。
Teaching purpose
通 过 介 绍 family 的 含
义,对学生进行情感教育,
教育学生要热爱家庭,关心
家人,并珍惜家人对自己的
爱。
245
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Copy the new vocabulary in this lesson five times.
2. Introduce your family photos to your teacher or friends in English.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 本节课以词汇教学为主,词汇的正确运用是学习英语的关键,词汇运用是用词汇去进行语言实践的过程,
在此过程中,句子和单词之间相辅相成,相互促进。
2. 采用图片和音频等直观教学手段,设计了一些有意义的任务,在学生们完成任务的过程中,帮助他们听
懂和理解对话,达到了运用语言进行真实交流的目的。
3. 在操练环节中通过让学生参与 Let’s play 板块的活动,增强了学生的口语表达能力。
4. 教学过程遵循了学生的认知规律,单词、短语、句型教学先是让学生知其义,再识其音和形,让学生在
理解中去学、去运用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s learn
· Be able to understand, speak and read the vocabulary “parents, uncle, aunt, cousin, baby
brother”.
· Be able to use the vocabulary above to introduce their family members in context correctly.
Let’s play
· Be able to consolidate the vocabulary “parents, uncle, aunt, cousin, baby brother” through
activities.
· Be able to use the sentence structures “This is my… He’s/She’s…” to introduce their family
members and describe their appearance characteristics simply in real situations.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand, speak and read the vocabulary “parents, uncle, aunt, cousin, baby
brother”, and be able to introduce and describe their family members briefly.
·Be able to sort out the relationship among family members.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the vocabulary and the sentence structures synthetically to introduce and describe
their family members.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Stages
Warm-up
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings and enjoy a song.
Play the song—I love my
family.
2. Revision.
Review the words of family
members with the word cards.
3. Lead-in.
Show a photo of Tom’s family.
Lead in the relevant content
of this lesson.
1. Greetings. Listen to
the song carefully and
sing together.
2. Read the words and act
with body movements
according to the words
on the cards.
3. Look at the photo of
Tom’s family.
Introduce and describe
Tom’s family members.
Use a song and a picture
to arouse students’
curiosity and interest.
Let students know how to
use the language they
have learned to
describe their family
members.
Presentation
1. Teach the phrase “baby
brother”.
Show Amy’s outline and
picture, her baby brother’s
hair and picture on the PPT.
Teach the phrase “baby
brother”.
Guess who she/he is.
Learn the phrase “baby
brother”.
Lead in the new
knowledge and improve
students’ learning
efficiency by asking
questions.
2. Teach the word “parents”.
Show the outline and the
picture of Amy’s parents and
teach this word.
Look at the picture and
learn the word
“parents”.
Integrate and review
the
knowledge of the last
lesson.
3. Teach the words “uncle,
aunt, cousin”.
Teach the words with pictures
and explain the usage of these
three words in
English-speaking countries.
Learn the words “uncle,
aunt, cousin”.
Understand the usage of
these words in
English-speaking
countries.
Help students
understand and master
the words on the basis
of understanding the
meaning of words and the
different usages in
Chinese and English
countries.
4. Listen, read and point.
Play the recording of the
vocabulary of “Let’s
learn” twice.
Read after the recording.
Point out the words or the
phrase they hear as they
read them.
Make sure students
master the correct
pronunciation.
5. Let’s learn.
Show the picture of “Let’s
learn”. Let students choose
two people from the picture to
describe according to the
sentences and act out in
pairs.
Choose two people from the
picture to describe
according to the
sentences. Act out in
pairs.
On the basis of
mastering vocabulary,
help students use
sentence structures to
practice the vocabulary
flexibly.
247
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Practice
1. Sharp eyes.
Show pictures of Amy’s
family members in a
flash, and then pause at
random.
Say the vocabulary related
to the characters on the
screen. The purpose of the
three activities is
to make students
familiarize and
practice the key
vocabulary.
2. Point and say.
Point to the vocabulary
on the blackboard.
Say the words or the phrase
out quickly.
3. A guessing game.
Show the back of the
family
members’ word cards.
Guess what word or phrase it
is.
4. Make a “family tree”.
Ask students to make a
“family tree” for Amy.
Make a “family tree” for
Amy.
Choose the words or the
phrase and fill them in the
blanks of the family tree.
Help students sort
out the relationship
among family members
by the way of making
a “family tree”.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Let’s play.
Show the picture of
“Let’s
play”. Ask students to
work in groups and choose
some students to show in
class.
Observe the picture, then
draw and say in the same way.
Work in groups and show in
class.
Let students enhance
their oral
expression ability
in the process of
participating in
activities.
2. Make a summary.
Show the word “family”
and explain what it
means.
Know the meaning of
“family”.
Through knowing the
meaning of
“family”, students
are reminded to love
their families, care
for their family
members and cherish
their family
members’ love.
Homework
1. Copy the new vocabulary in this lesson five times.
2. Introduce your family photos to your teacher or friends in English.
3. Do the exercises.
The third period(第三课时)
Part A Let’s spell
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s spell
·能够根据 a, e, i, o, u, a-e, i-e, o-e, u-e,-e 的发音规则读出单词
·能够通过对比 a, e, i, o, u 的长、短音,听录音选词,强化已学的发音规则
·能够跟读歌谣,在有节奏的吟唱中强化学习上述发音规则
·能够按照示范例词的提示,从歌谣中找出符合上述发音规则的单词
▶教学重点
1. 能够感知并归纳元音字母 a, e, i, o, u 在开音节及闭音节中的发音规则。
2. 能够读出符合 a, e, i, o, u 发音规则的单词。
▶教学难点
能够根据单词的读音拼写出符合发音规则的单词。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2.PPT 课件、录音、视频等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Read a chant.
Show a chant on the PPT. Ask students to read it with the teacher
together.
3. Lead-in.
Show a picture of a cat on the PPT. (课件出示: 一只猫的图片)
Then ask students to discuss what they see.
T: What’s this?
Ss: It’s a cat.
T: Yes! It’s a cute cat.
Step 2: Presentation
1. Listen and chant.
(1)①Present the picture on the PPT. (课件出示:教材 P60 Listen and
chant 部分中猫的头部图片)
Play the recording of the sentence “We like the cat!” (出示
课件) At the same time, present two options “cat/ cut” on the PPT.
(出示课件) Ask students to spell it according to the pronunciation
of “cat”, like this: /k/-/æ/-/t/, /kæt/. And choose the right word
“cat”. Emphasize that “a” sounds /æ/ in “cat”.
Teaching purpose
通过韵句唤醒学生的记
忆,帮助学生复习学过的单
词,引出即将在语音韵句中
提到的“cat”。
Teaching purpose
通过讨论图片,引导学
生预先感知韵句的内容,并
回忆一些语音例词的读音。
Teaching purpose
运用课件,逐步呈现本
部分小猫的图片。采用对比
的方法,在师生对话中寻找
该部分单词的语音特点。在
卡通形象的呈现中展示单
词,利用拼读规则找出每组
单词的细微不同,加深学生
249
Read the words “cat, cut” in class, and compare the sounds of
the two words: cat/k t/, cut/kʌt/.
②Present the picture on the PPT. (课件出示:教材 P60 Listen and
chant 部分中猫左右两手空着的图片)
Lead students to say,“Oh, the cat is cute!” Then present two
options “cut/cute” on the PPT. (出示课件) Ask students to spell
it according to the pronunciation of “cute”, like this: /k/-/ju:
/-/t/, /kju:t/. And choose the right word “cute”. Emphasize that
“u-e” sounds /ju / in “cute”.
Read the words “cut, cute” in class, and compare the sounds of
the two words: cut/kʌt/, cute/kju:t/.
③Present the picture on the PPT. (课件出示:教材 P60 Listen and
chant 部分中猫右手拿蛋糕的图片)
Play the recording of the sentence “He’s got a cake!” (出示
课件) At the same time, present two options “cake /Coke” on the PPT.
(出示课件) Ask students to spell it according to the pronunciation
of “cake”, like this: /k/-/eɪ/-/k/, /keɪk/. And choose the right word
“cake”. Emphasize that “a-e” sounds /eɪ/ in “cake”.
Read the words “cake, Coke” in class, and compare the sounds of
the two words: cake/ keɪk /, Coke/kəʊk/.
④Point at the rose on the cake in the picture and say, “A red
rose on the cake!” Ask students to spell the two words according to
the pronunciations of “red” and “rose”, like this: /r/-/e/-/d/,
/red/; /r/-/əʊ/-/z/, /rəʊz/.
Read the phrase “a red rose” in class.
⑤Present the picture on the PPT. (课件出示:教材 P60 Listen and
chant 部分中猫左手拿一杯牛奶的图片)
Play the recording of the phrase “a cup of milk”. (出示课件) Ask
students to spell it according to the pronunciation of “milk”, like
this: /m/-/ɪ/-/l/-/k/, /mɪlk/.
Read the phrase “a cup of milk” in class.
⑥Ask the question “Do you like the cat?” Lead students to answer,
“Yes, we like the cat.”
Present two options “like/lake” on the PPT. (出示课件) Ask
students to spell it according to the pronunciation of “like”, like
this: /l/-/aɪ/-/k/, /laɪk/. Then choose the right word “like”.
Emphasize that “i-e” sounds /aI/ in “like”. Read the words “like,
lake” in class, and compare the sounds of the two words: like/laɪk/,
lake/leɪk/.
(2) Play the recording of “Listen and chant”. (课件出示:教材
P60 Listen and chant 部分的音频)
First let students listen carefully and feel the melody of the chant.
Then ask students to sing the chant after the recording.
Chant with students sentence by sentence.
2. Sing the chant freely.
Let students sing the chant freely with clapping their hands.
3. Act out the chant together.
Let students act out the chant in pairs,then ask four pairs to
show in class.
Step 3: Practice
1. Read, listen and circle.
Ask students to read the words of “Read, listen and circle” and
pay attention to the pronunciations of the words.
Play the recording of this part. (课件出示:教材 P60 Read, listen
and circle 部分的音频) Get students to listen to the recording and
circle the correct words.
Check the answers in class.
Answers: 1. he; men; rice2. had; make; nose3. use; cat; mum
2. Chant again. Group and write.
Show the chart of “Chant again. Group and write” on the PPT. (课
件出示: 教材 P60 Chant again. Group and write 部分的表格)
Get students to sing the chant in groups again and read the words
in the chart by themselves. Then let them complete the chart in groups.
Ask a group to show their answers and then ask other students to add.
Write down students’ answers on the blackboard.
3. Classify the words.
Show lots of words students have learned on the PPT. (出示课件)
Let students read and classify them according to the example words.
Check the answers.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Make a summary.
2. Review the chant.
Play the recording of the “Listen and chant”. (出示课件) Ask
students to sing it together.
▶板书设计
Teaching purpose
此活动让学生将单词的
读音与词形结合起来,帮助
学生区分元音字母在开音节
与闭音节中发音方式的不
同。
Teaching purpose
通过教师的引导与示
范,帮助学生回忆表格中各
元音字母的发音规则,并根
据发音规则写出符合其发音
规则的单词。通过拼写与拼
读来进一步巩固其发音规
则。
Teaching purpose
通过这个活动,让学生
根据所给例词,将单词进行
分类,区分其属于开音节发
音规则还是闭音节发音规
则。将字母与其发音匹配起
来,帮助学生更好地掌握元
音字母的发音规则。
Teaching purpose
通过语音韵句,帮助学
生再一次巩固各元音字母的
发音规则。
251
▶作业设计
1. Read the words and the chant of “Let’s spell” three times after the recording.
2. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 本课是一节语音复习课。主要教学元音字母 a, e, i, o, u 及 a-e, i-e, o-e, u-e, -e 的发音规则。
在教学音标时,充分调动了学生的积极性,让学生在不断的感知和练习中自主总结发音规律。
2. 通过自编 chant 导入,将发音规则融入到活泼的韵句中,激发了学生学习的兴趣。
3. 在小组和全班同学中进行“看图片,听录音,选单词”“拼读单词选单词”“chant 表演”等活动,将所
学知识运用于实践,提高了学生参与课堂学习的意识,调动了其学习热情。
4. 通过听一听,读一读,圈一圈,分一分等多种形式来反复练习,使学生在听、读中体会发音规律和拼写
规律,并做到见词能读、听音能写。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s spell
· Be able to read the words according to the pronunciation rules of “a, e, i, o, u, a-e, i-e,
o-e, u-e, -e”.
· Be able to listen and choose the words by comparing the long and short sounds of “a, e, i, o,
u”.
· Be able to read the chant after the recording and learn the pronunciation rules above in rhythmic
chant.
·Be able to identify the words that conform to the pronunciation rules above from the chant according
to the example words.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to perceive and summarize the pronunciation rules of vowel letters “a, e, i, o, u”
in open and closed syllables.
·Be able to read the words that conform to the pronunciation rules of “a, e, i, o, u”.
▶Teaching Difficulties
· Be able to spell the words that conform to the pronunciation rules according to their
pronunciations.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Revision
1. Greetings.
2. Read a chant.
3. Lead-in.
1. Greetings.
2. Read the chant with the
teacher.
Help students review
the words they have
learned.
&
Lead-in
Show a picture of a cat and ask
students to discuss what they
see.
3. Talk about the picture. Lead students to
perceive the chant and
recall the
pronunciations of the
example words by
discussing the picture.
Presentation
1. Listen and chant.
(1) Show the pictures and play
the recordings.
Lead students to notice the
different pronunciations of
the similar words.
(2) Play the recording of
“Listen and chant”.
(1) Look at the pictures
and listen to the
recordings to
distinguish the
similar words in each
group, and master the
words.
(2) Listen to the chant
carefully and feel the
melody of it. Then sing
after the recording.
With the method of
comparison, deepen
students’
understanding of the
pronunciation rules of
the vowel letters.
Read after the
recording to help
students get the
correct pronunciation.
2. Sing the chant freely. Sing the chant freely with
clapping their hands.
Let students practice
the chant in the way
they like to achieve the
goal of singing the
chant skillfully.
3. Act out the chant
together.
Act out the chant in pairs
and show in class.
By acting the chant,
strengthen the
pronunciation rules of
the vowel letters.
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Practice
1. Read, listen and circle.
Play the recording. Then
check the answers in
class.
Read the words. Then listen
to the recording and circle
the correct words. Check the
answers.
Help students
distinguish the
sounds of vowel
letters in the open
and closed
syllables.
2. Chant again. Group and
write.
Show the chart. Ask
students to complete it.
Write down the words on the
blackboard.
Sing the chant in groups
again and read the words in
the chart by themselves.
Complete the chart.
Help students review
and consolidate the
pronunciation rules
of the vowel letters
in the chart.
253
3. Classify the words.
Show lots of words students
have learned on the PPT.
Read and classify the words
according to the example
words.
Help students better
master the
pronunciation rules
of the vowel letters.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Make a summary.
2. Review the chant.
Play the recording of the
chant.
Sing the chant together.
Help students
further consolidate
the pronunciation
rules of the vowel
letters.
Homework
1. Read the words and the chant of “Let’s spell” three times after the
recording.
2. Do the exercises.
The fourth period(第四课时)
Part B Let’s talk & Draw and say
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s talk
·能够在图片和教师的帮助下理解对话大意
·能够用正确的语音、语调朗读对话,并能够分角色表演对话
·能够在情景中运用句型“—Is this your…? —Yes, it is./No, it isn’t./No, it’s
me.”“—What’s your…’s job? —He’s/She’s a/an…”询问并回答某人与说话方
的亲属关系及其职业情况
·能够在语境中理解词汇“football player, nurse”的意思,并能够正确发音
Draw and say ·能够通过画一画、说一说,巩固 B 部分对话中所学的核心句型
▶教学重点
1. 能够在图片和教师的帮助下理解对话大意;能够用正确的语音、语调朗读对话,并分角色表演。
2. 能够理解并运用句型“—Is this your…? —Yes, it is./No, it isn’t./No, it’s me.”“—What’s
your…’s job? —He’s/She’s a/an…”。
▶教学难点
能够在真实情景中灵活运用核心句型。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2.PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、家庭称呼类和职业类单词卡片等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Show the chant—I love you.
Ask students to read the chant carefully and then chant it together. Teaching purpose
用自编 chant 吸引学生
的注意力,激发他们学习英
语的兴趣。同时,复习有关
家庭称呼的知识,为接下来
的学习做好准备。
3. Lead-in.
Show the outline picture of the teacher’s family photo on the PPT.
(课件出示: 教师全家福的轮廓图)Ask students to guess the relationship
between the person in the picture and the teacher.
T: This is my family photo. Guess! Who’s she/he? You can ask like
this: Is this your…? Remind students to use rising tones in general
questions.
Ss: Is this your cousin/aunt/…?
T: Yes, it is. / No, it isn’t. / No, it’s me.
Write down the sentence structures “—Is this your…? —Yes, it
is. / No, it isn’t. / No, it’s me.” on the blackboard.
Step 2: Presentation
1. Teach the new vocabulary and sentence structures.
(1) After guessing some characters, the picture of the teacher’s
family members is clearly presented. The teacher points to
herself/himself and says, “I’m a teacher.”
Then point to her/his aunt in the picture.
T: This is my aunt. She’s a nurse.
Show a picture of the teacher’s aunt in a nurse’s uniform. Help
students understand what “nurse” means.
Teach the word “nurse”, n/n/-ur/ɜː/-se/s/, nurse/nɜːs/. (课
件出示:nurse 的相关内容)
Ask students to read after the teacher and pay attention to the
sound of “ur”. It sounds /ɜː/ here.
T: What’s my aunt’s job? She’s a/an…
Ask students to guess the meaning of this question and the word
“job” according to the context.
Ss: She’s a nurse.
Write down the sentence “What’s your aunt’s job?” on the
blackboard and get students to read after the teacher.
T: au/ɑː/-n/n/-t/t/, aunt/ɑːnt/, t’s/ts/, aunt’s/ɑːnts/.
“t’s” sounds /ts/ here.
T: j/dʒ/-o/ɒ/-b/b/, job/dʒɒb/.
T: Now you can ask me about my other family members with the sentence
structure.
Ss: What’s your…’s job?
T: He’s/She’s a/an… (doctor, football player, nurse, farmer,
cook, driver…)
Teaching purpose
通过图片,帮助学生理
解新词的含义,并引导学生
通过听音和拆音的方法学习
新词的读音,为对话学习扫
清障碍。
Teaching purpose
通过介绍家人的职业,
引出职业名称,帮助学生理
解其含义,并使其掌握单词
的读音。
255
Show the pictures of the jobs above to help students understand.
Write down the sentence structure “He’s/She’s a/an…” on the
blackboard.
(2) Write down the phrase “football player” and the sentence
“He’s a football player.” on the blackboard. Help students
understand the meaning of “football” through pictures of a foot, a
ball and a football on the PPT. (出示课件)
Show the cards of “father” “teacher” “sister” and so on. Let
students listen to the pronunciation of these words to know the sound
of “-er” when it appears at the end of a word and spell the word
“player”. Teach the word “player”. Ask students to read after the
recording. (课件出示:player 的相关内容)
2. Talk about the picture of the main scene.
Present the picture of the main scene on the PPT.(课件出示: 教
材 Unit 6 主情景图)
T: This is Sarah’s family. They are putting on a play. Do you know
its name?
Students may answer in Chinese.
T: How many people are there in Sarah’s family?
Ss: Nine. Wow!
Point to one actor in the picture and ask, “Is this Sarah’s
uncle?”
Ss: Yes, it is. /No, it isn’t.
T: What’s his job?
Lead students to find relevant person. Ask students to describe
his job through the dialogue in the picture.
Ss: He’s a football player.
Continue to talk about Sarah’s aunt’s and father’s jobs.
Play the cartoon of the main scene on the PPT. (课件出示: 教材
Unit 6 主情景图的视频) Ask students to read after it.
3. Let’s talk.
(1) Show the pictures of the three characters in “Let’s talk”
on the PPT. (课件出示: 教材 P61 Let’s talk 板块中 Sarah 的叔叔和婶
婶的照片以及 Sarah 小时候的照片)
Ask students to guess who these people related to Sarah are and
predict the main idea of the dialogue.
T: Is this your Sarah’s…?
Ss: …
Write down the words on the blackboard according to students’
guessing.
T: What are Sarah and Zhang Peng talking about?
Ss: They are talking about Sarah’s family members and their jobs.
(2) Play the cartoon and ask the questions.
Teaching purpose
通过对本单元主情景图
的学习,设置特定的语言环
境,进一步感知核心句型。
Teaching purpose
通过提问让学生对对话
内容产生阅读的兴趣。再通
过回答问题,帮助学生理解
对话的内容。
Questions: Who’s this man/woman? What’s his/her job? Is the
little baby Sarah’s baby brother?
1 Play the cartoon of “Let’s talk” on the PPT and let students
pay attention to the pronunciation and the intonation. (课
件出示:教材 P61 Let’s talk 板块的视频) Ask students to watch
the cartoon with the questions. Underline the answers in the
book.
②Answer the questions.
T: Who’s this man?
Ss: It’s Sarah’s uncle.
T: What’s his job?
Ss: He’s a football player.
T: Who’s this woman?
Ss: It’s Sarah’s aunt.
T: What’s her job?
Ss: She’s a nurse.
③Play the cartoon again. (Pause at the last picture.) (出示
课件)
T: Who’s the baby? Is the little baby Sarah’s baby brother?
Ss: No. It’s Sarah. Sarah says, “It’s me!”
(3) Read after the recording.
Play the recording of “Let’s talk” on the PPT. (出示课件) Ask
students to read after it. Then let them read in pairs.
(4) Act out the dialogue.
Ask students to read the dialogue freely and act out in roles.
Select four pairs to act out in class.
Step 3: Practice
1. Make a dialogue.
Present the picture of the main scene of this unit once again on
the PPT. (课件出示: 教材 Unit 6 主情景图) Ask students to select a
person in the picture and make a dialogue. Then let them practice in
pairs.
Make an example:
A: Is this Sarah’s mother?
B: Yes, it is. /No, it isn’t. She’s…
A: What’s Sarah’s mother’s job?
B: She’s a/an…
2. Draw and say.
(1) Let students look at the four stick figures in “Draw and say”.
(课件出示:教材 P61 Draw and say 板块的四幅简笔画)Ask them to describe
the jobs of the characters.
(2) Ask two students to read the dialogue of this part. Remind them
to use rising tones in general questions.
Teaching purpose
通过跟读与分角色表演
对话,保证学生能够正确朗
读对话,并进一步熟悉重点
句型的表达。
Teaching purpose
通过呈现单元主情景
图,创编对话并操练重点句
型,帮助学生在真实情境中
运用核心句型,进而突破本
课的重难点。
Teaching purpose
通过观察图片、问答操
练以及替换单词操练,逐步
达到本部分“画一画,说一
说”的要求,帮助学生巩固
在对话中所学的核心句型。
257
(3) Ask students to draw pictures of their family members. Then
lead them to introduce their family members and the jobs of their family
members w ith the key sentences.
(4) Lead students to ask and answer in pairs with the following
sentence structures.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Play a game— “Magic mirror”.
Ask two students to make a model.
First, use the ready-made materials in the classroom to make the
frame of the magic mirror, such as a wooden ruler, broom, etc.
Then ask student A to wear a mask with reflective effect and stand
behind the mirror in a fixed position.
B: (Stand in front of the mirror and ask.) Mirror, mirror on the
wall! Is this B?
A (“Magic mirror”): Yes, it is.
B: What’s his/her job?
A (“Magic mirror”): He’s/She’s a/an…
Then let both of them make the representative action of this job
at the same time.
Get students to practice in pairs, then show in class.
2. Let’s sing—My family.
Play the song My family. (课件出示:教材 P64 Let’s sing 板块的
歌曲)Ask students to listen carefully and sing together.
3. Make a summary.
Point to the vocabulary and the sentence structures on the
blackboard, ask students to review them quickly.
▶板书设计
Teaching purpose
“魔镜游戏”是上一个
教学环节 Draw and say 活动
的变化和延伸,让学生在轻
松的游戏中,操练重点词汇
和句型,并结合肢体语言,
使学生对职业名词的理解更
深入。
Teaching purpose
通过小结活动,帮助学
生梳理并再现重点词汇与句
型,从而对本课的重点内容
进行总结及强化。
▶作业设计
1. Read the dialogue to your parents.
2. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 本课在 A 部分的基础上学习重点句型“—Is this your…? —Yes, it is./No, it isn’t./No, it’s
me.”“—What’s your…’s job? —He’s/She’s a/an…”,教学内容贴近学生生活,因此学生们对话题较
熟悉,这有助于他们更好地掌握知识。
2. 通过对本单元主情景图的教学,让学生在情景中初步感知重点词汇和句型,让英语课堂生动起来。
3. 在实践中注意分层教学,因材施教,用最有效的方式激发学生主动参与的兴趣,培养其独立思考和合作
探究的创新精神。
4. 教学层次分明,引导适当,体现了学生在学习中的主体地位,顺利完成了教学目标。
5. 板书设计清晰明了,重点突出,起到了很好的辅助作用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s talk
· Be able to understand the main idea of the dialogue with the help of the pictures and the teacher.
· Be able to read the dialogue with the correct pronunciation and intonation and act out the dialogue
in roles.
· Be able to use the sentence structures “—Is this your…? —Yes, it is./No, it isn’t. /No,
it’s me.”“—What’s your…’s job? —He’s/She’s a/an…” in situations to ask and answer
the relationship
between someone and the speaker and his/her job.
· Be able to understand new vocabulary “football player, nurse” in context, and pronounce them
correctly.
Draw and say
· Be able to consolidate the key sentence structures learned in Part B by drawing and saying.
259
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand the main idea of the dialogue with the help of the pictures and the teacher.
Be able to read the dialogue with the correct pronunciation and intonation and act out the dialogue
in roles.
·Be able to understand and use the sentence structures “—Is this your…? —Yes, it is./No, it
isn’t./No, it’s me.”“—What’s your…’s job? —He’s/She’s a/an…”
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use the key sentence structures flexibly in real situations.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Show the chant—I love you.
3. Lead-in.
Show the outline picture of
the teacher’s family photo on
the PPT. Ask students to
guess.
1. Greetings.
2. Read the chant
carefully and chant with
the teacher.
3. Talk about the outline
picture with the
teacher.
Stimulate students’
curiosity and
enthusiasm to
participate in class by
guessing.
Presentation
1. Teach the new vocabulary and
sentence structures.
(1) Teach the word “nurse” and
the sentence structures
“—What’s your…’s job?
—He’s/She’s a/an…”
(2) Teach the phrase “football
player”.
Learn the vocabulary and
the sentence structures.
Help students learn the
meanings and
pronunciations of the
new vocabulary.
Let students perceive
the new sentence
structures.
Clear the way for
dialogue learning.
2. Talk about the picture of the
main scene.
Present the picture and play
the cartoon of the main scene.
Practice the key sentence
structures by talking
about the main scene.
Read after the cartoon.
Further perceive the
key sentence structures
by learning the main
scene of the unit.
3. Let’s talk.
(1) Show the pictures of the
three characters in “Let’s
talk” on the PPT. Ask
students to guess.
(2) Play the cartoon and ask the
questions.
(3) Play the recording of
“Let’s talk”.
(4) Ask four pairs to act out in
class.
(1) Look at the pictures
and guess.
(2) Watch the cartoon with
the questions.
Underline the answers
in the book. And answer
the questions.
(3) Read after the
recording and read in
pairs.
(4) Read the dialogue
freely and act out in
Attract students’
interest in reading by
asking questions.
Help students
understand the dialogue
and perceive the key
sentence structures.
roles.
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Practice
1. Make a dialogue.
Present the picture of
the main scene. Ask
students to select a
person in the picture and
make a dialogue. Then let
them practice in pairs.
Select a person in the
picture and make a dialogue.
Then practice in pairs.
Help students use the
key sentence
structures and break
through the
difficult points in
real situations.
2. Draw and say.
Lead students to
complete the activities
as
required.
Watch the stick figures and
read the dialogue of this
part.
Draw pictures of their
family members.
Ask and answer in pairs.
Help students
consolidate the key
sentence structures
through a series of
activities.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Play a game — “Magic
mirror”.
Ask two students to make
a model. Then ask
students to play the game
in pairs.
Play the game and practice
in pairs and then show in
class.
Practice the key
vocabulary and
sentence structures
in the relaxing game.
Make students have a
deeper understanding
of occupational
nouns.
2. Let’s sing—My family. Listen carefully and sing
the song together.
Activate the
atmosphere of class.
3. Make a summary.
Point to the vocabulary
and the sentence
structures on the
blackboard.
Review the vocabulary and
the sentence structures
quickly.
Help students
consolidate and sort
out the key knowledge
of this lesson.
Homework 1. Read the dialogue to your parents.
2. Do the exercises.
The fifth period(第五课时)
Part B Let’s learn & Let’s play
261
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Let’s learn
·能够听、说、认读五个有关职业的单词“doctor, cook, driver, farmer, nurse”
·能够在语境中正确运用这五个单词
·能够在真实语境中理解句子“They’re helpful!”的意义,引导学生树立职业平等的观
念
Let’s play ·能够在活动中模仿这五个职业的标志性动作,并用所学句型“—What’s his/her job? —
He’s/She’s a/an…”正确询问并回答所模拟的职业
▶教学重点
1. 能够听、说、认读并正确运用单词“doctor, cook, driver, farmer, nurse”。
2. 能够灵活运用句型“—What’s his/her job? —He’s/She’s a/an…”。
▶教学难点
能够正确询问并回答家人的职业。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2.PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、学生准备的家人照片、家庭称呼类单词、职业类单词卡片等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Free talk and lead-in.
Ask students to take out photos of their family and introduce their
family members to each other in the groups. Then ask four students to
show in class. Select the best performer.
Make a model:
Hi! Meet my family!
This is my father.
This is my mother.
This is my sister.
This is my brother.
Step 2: Presentation
1. Teach the words “nurse, doctor”.
Present Sarah’s aunt’s photo on the PPT and ask the question.
T: What’s Sarah’s aunt’s job?
Ss: She’s a nurse.
T: Yes, she’s a nurse and she works in a hospital. Present the
word “nurse” on the PPT and teach it. (课件出示:nurse 的相关内容)
T: n/n/-ur/ɜː/-se/s/, nurse/nɜːs/.
Present a picture of the hospital to help students understand the
meaning of “hospital”. (课件出示:医院的图片)
T: My aunt works in a hospital, too. But she is not a nurse. (课
件出示:一位女医生的图片) She’s a…
Present the word “doctor” on the PPT and teach it. (课件出
示:doctor 的相关内容)
Teaching purpose
让学生用学过的句子,
结合全家福照片,在小组中
自由交流,激发学生的语言
表达欲望,快速导入教学。
T: d/d/-o/ɒ/-c/k/-t/t/-or/ ə (r)/, doctor/ /.
Write down the words “nurse, doctor” on the blackboard.
Play the recording of the two words. (出示课件) Let students read
them after the recording.
Ask students to read the words in groups with actions.
For example: nurse (Do the action of holding an injector.)
doctor (Do the action of holding a stethoscope.)
2. Teach the words “driver, farmer”.
Ask the question: What’s Sarah’s uncle’s job?
Ss: He’s a football player.
T: Great! My uncle is not a football player. He drives a taxi. He
is very helpful. What’s his job?
Lead students to guess the word “driver” with the help of
teacher’s body movement. Some students may speak in Chinese.
Write down the word “driver” on the blackboard and teach it. (课
件出示:driver 的相关内容)
T: dr/dr/-i/aɪ/-v/v/-er/ ə (r)/, driver/ /.
Let students read after the recording and read it one by one or
in a row. (出示课件)
Present a picture of a farmer on the PPT. (课件出示: 一位农民
的图片)
T: Sarah’s grandpa is very strong. He works on a farm. What’s
his job?
Lead students to guess the word “farmer”. Some students may speak
in Chinese.
Write down the word “farmer” on the blackboard and teach it. (课
件出示:farmer 的相关内容)
T: f/f/-ar/ɑː/-m/m/-er/ ə (r)/, farmer/ /.
Let students read after the recording and read it one by one or
in a row. (出示课件)
Present some occupational nouns similar to “driver, farmer”. Get
students to try to read and find out what the words have in common.
3. Teach the word “cook”.
Present a picture of a cook on the PPT. (课件出示: 一位厨师的
图片)
T: Look at the man. He looks like a farmer. But he is not a farmer.
Listen. What’s his job? (课件出示:菜入油锅和炒菜的声音)
Lead students to guess the word “cook”. Some students may speak
in Chinese.
Teaching purpose
通过观察并讨论图片,
让学生先对新授知识有直观
的认识,再通过认真倾听获
取信息,对新单词的词义和
读音有更深的认识,最后通
过对driver和farmer的比较,
归纳并掌握更多的符合这种
构词规则的职业类名词。
Teaching purpose
以图片及音频相结合的
方式呈现新单词,让学生从
多角度感知新的教学内容。
通过做与职业相关的动作,
听与职业相关的声音,降低
学习的难度,加深对新词的
理解。通过拼读教学法与跟
读获取新单词的准确读音,
使学生在模仿中加深对新词
的理解和记忆。
Teaching purpose
适时地进行情感教育,
帮助学生树立职业平等的观
念,培养其为家人职业而自
豪的情感。
263
Write down the word “cook” on the blackboard and teach it. (课
件出示:cook 的相关内容)
T: c/k/-oo/ʊ/-k/k/, cook/kʊk/.
Let students read after the recording.(出示课件)Ask some students
to read aloud.
T: The nurse and the doctor can protect our health. The driver can
drive. They can do many things for us. They are helpful!
Write down the sentence “They are helpful!” on the blackboard
and teach the word “helpful”.(课件出示:helpful 的相关内容)
T: help/help/-ful/ful/, helpful/helpful/.
Ask students to read the sentence.
4. Watch the cartoon and read.
Play the cartoon of “Let’s learn”.(课件出示:教材 P62 Let’s
learn 板块的视频) Let students read after the recording. Remind them
to pay attention to the pronunciation and the intonation.
Ask students to listen again and point out the words they hear as
they read them.
5. Act out the dialogue.
Show the picture of “Let’s learn”. (课件出示:教材 P62 Let’s
learn 板块的图片) Take out the headdresses of Chen Jie and Sarah. Let
students act out the dialogue in pairs.
Chen Jie: What’s your…’s job?
Sarah: My…is a/an…
Step 3: Practice
1. Play a game— “I point, you say.”
Point to the words on the blackboard quickly. Let students read
them loudly.
2. Play a game—“What’s missing?”
Show all the word cards of jobs to students.
Ask students to close their eyes, and take out one card from the
word cards.
Then let students open their eyes. Show them the word cards again.
T: What’s missing?
Let students say the missing word quickly. Reward the student who
guesses quickly and correctly.
3. Play a game— “Stand, stand, stand!”
Choose five students to go to the front of the classroom. Let each
student squat down with a word card. Then lead students to play the
game.
(游戏说明:座位上的一位学生说出句子“I’m a/an…”。蹲在前面的
五个人中,拿着相应图卡的学生马上站起来,举起图卡并将该单词大声读三
遍。如果没有及时站起来,或者站起来的不是持有正确单词图卡的学生,则
出局,再寻找其他的学生替换。)
Teaching purpose
在掌握新单词和核心句
型的基础上,通过角色扮演
来表演对话,让学生在真实
情境中灵活运用语言,体验
学习的乐趣。
Teaching purpose
通过不同的操练活动,
帮助学生认读单词,将单词
的读音、拼写与词义结合起
来。
Teaching purpose
通过这个游戏,使学生
重温本课的重点单词与句
型,起到复习、巩固的效果。
4. Ask and answer.
Show some word cards of family members and jobs. Take out a card
randomly and ask students to practice.
T: If I show you the word cards “mother” and “nurse”, boys must
ask, “What’s your mother’s job?” Then girls answer, “She is a
nurse.”
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Let’s play.
(1)Present the five pictures of “Let’s play” on the PPT. (课
件出示:教材 P62 Let’s play 板块的图片) Ask students to say out the
words of jobs in the pictures in turn, and do actions to act out the
jobs.
(2)A boy does the action and other boys ask, “What’s his job?”
Girls guess the job with the sentence structure “He’s a/an…” Then
exchange.
2. Make a survey in groups.
Let students ask the jobs of family members in the groups with the
sentence structure “What’s your…’s job?” and make a survey
according to the chart.
(活动说明:如果出现了不会的职业类名词,学生可以先用中文代替。教
师在巡视过程中给以帮助和补充。)
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Copy the words learned in this lesson five times.
2. Investigate the jobs of friends or relatives.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 本课主要是学习五个表示职业的单词和询问某人职业的句型及其回答。教学新课前,用歌曲和对话的方
式帮助学生复习了上节课所学的知识,为后面的授课做了铺垫。
Teaching purpose
通过TPR活动,训练手、
眼、脑的配合。一方面能帮
助学生进一步理解职业的特
征,另一方面使学生巩固职
业类单词的读音、词义。
Teaching purpose
通过小组活动,让学生
在进行调查时不断使用目标
语言,以达到熟练掌握的目
的。
265
2. 结合课件和师生互动,复习旧知并导入新课,将新授单词融入到句型教学中,利用图片引入单词,灵活
操练,并在学习新词的基础上进行句型操练。
3. 通过“I point, you say.”“What’s missing?”“Stand, stand, stand!”这三个游戏,将单词的拼
写、读音和词义进行匹配操练。通过“看单词创编对话”的活动将单词和核心句型穿插融合,灵活操练。一系
列活动过程由易到难,趣味性强。
4. 运用 TPR 活动完成 Let’s play 的教学,加强了学生对新知识的掌握。在小组中完成调查表格,进一步
加深了学生对单词和句型的理解与运用。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Let’s learn
· Be able to listen, speak and read the words “doctor, cook, driver, farmer, nurse”.
· Be able to use the five words of jobs correctly in the context.
· Be able to understand the meaning of the sentence “They’re helpful!” in real context. Lead
students to establish the concept of occupational equality.
Let’s play
· Be able to imitate the symbolic actions of the five occupations in the activity. Be able to ask
and answer the occupation with the key sentence structures “—What’s his/her job?
—He’s/She’s a/an…” correctly.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to listen, speak and read the words “doctor, cook, driver, farmer, nurse”, and use
them correctly.
·Be able to use sentence structures “—What’s his/her job? —He’s/She’s a/an…”flexibly.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to ask and answer the jobs of their family members correctly.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Lead-in
1. Greetings.
2. Free talk and lead-in.
1. Greetings.
2. Introduce family
members to each other in
the groups.
Free talk can stimulate
students’ language
expression desire.
Presenta
tion
1. Teach the words “nurse,
doctor”.
Play the recording
Learn the words “nurse,
doctor”. Read after the
recording and read the
words in groups with
actions.
Have a good grasp of the
meanings and
pronunciations of the
words by comparing.
2. Teach the words “driver,
farmer”.
Play the recording.
Learn the words “driver,
farmer”. Read after the
recording and read one by
one or in a row.
Through discussion and
listening, make
students get a deeper
understanding of the
meanings and
pronunciations of new
words.
3. Teach the word “cook”.
Play the recording. Help
students understand the
sentence “They’re
helpful!”
Learn the word “cook”
and the sentence
“They’re helpful!”
Read after the recording.
Read the sentence.
The teaching of
vocabulary was
accompanied with
emotional education.
4. Watch the cartoon and read.
Play the cartoon.
Read after the recording.
Listen again and point out
the words they hear as they
read them.
Get the exact
pronunciations of new
words by reading.
Deepen students’
understanding and
memory by imitating.
5. Act out the dialogue.
Show the picture of “Let’s
learn”. Take out the
headdresses of Chen Jie and
Sarah.
Act out the dialogue in
pairs.
Make sure students can
read the dialogue
correctly and fluently.
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Practice
1. Play a game— “I point,
you say.”
Point to the words on the
blackboard quickly.
2. Play a game — “What’s
missing?”
Show all the word cards
of jobs and take out one
card from them.
3. Play a game — “Stand,
stand, stand!”
1. Read the words loudly.
2. Say the missing word
quickly.
3. Play the game.
Help students become
familiar with the
spellings,
pronunciations and
meanings of the new
words.
4. Ask and answer.
Show the word cards and
make an explanation.
Make a new dialogue
according to the cards taken
out by the teacher.
Review the key words
and sentence
structures in this
lesson to summarize
and consolidate the
knowledge.
Consolidation
&
1. Let’s play.
Lead students to complete
1. Say out the words of jobs
and do actions to act out
Through the activity
of TPR, train the
267
Extension the activity.
2. Make a survey in groups.
Give help and
supplement to students.
the jobs.
2. Ask and answer in groups,
and make a survey.
coordination of
students in hands,
eyes and brains.
Help students master
the target language.
Homework
1. Copy the words learned in this lesson five times.
2. Investigate the jobs of friends or relatives.
3. Do the exercises.
The sixth period(第六课时)
Part B Read and write & Let’s check & Let’s sing & Part C Story time
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Read and write
·能够在图片的帮助下读懂小文段,并对照文后小图所提示的职业,判断文后四个问题的
正误
·能够在图片的帮助下,仿照示范例句,在四线三格中填充所缺少的单词
·能够根据实际情况画简图,呈现家庭成员或朋友的外貌特征及职业,并仿照示范例句填
充句子
Let’s check ·检测单元核心句型,考查本单元关于家人和职业核心词汇的认读
Let’s sing ·能够了解歌词意义并能够清晰准确地歌唱
Story time ·能够在图片的帮助下理解故事内容,复习巩固有关职业的词汇和句型
·能够在教师的帮助下表演故事
▶教学重点
能够综合运用本单元的核心词汇和句型并按要求完成练习。
▶教学难点
总结并复习本单元所学的主要知识,提高学生总结知识的能力。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2.PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、家庭称呼类和职业类的单词卡片等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Lead-in
1. Enjoy a song—My family.
Play the song twice. (课件出示:教材 P64 Let’s sing 板块的歌曲视
频) Ask students to listen to it and then sing after it. At last, let
students sing the song together.
2. Revision.
Take out the word cards they have learnt in this unit.
Show students the word cards one by one. Let students say them as
quickly as they can. Then ask students to talk about their family
members and the jobs of their family members with the word cards.
T: What’s your…’s job?
Teaching purpose
首先通过歌曲,激发学
生学习的兴趣。再借助单词
卡片,帮助学生复习学过的
家庭称呼类和职业类的词
汇。讨论学生家人的职业,
以帮助他们复习本单元的重
点句型,并为下一环节的学
习做准备。
Ss: He’s/She’s a/an…
Step 2: Presentation
1. Pre-reading.
(1)Show the picture of “Read and write” on the PPT. (出示课
件) Talk about it with students.
T: Look at the picture. It’s a picture of John’s family. How many
people are there in the picture?
Ss: Five.
T: Look at this woman. Can you say something? (Point to the woman
on the right in the picture.)
Lead students to describe her with the sentence “She’s
friendly.” and guess her job with the sentence structure “She’s
a/an…”
(2) Point to the taller man in the picture.
T: Look at this man. Can you say something?
Lead students to describe him with the sentence “He’s strong.”
and guess his job with the sentence structure “He’s a/an…”
(3) Draw a basketball on the blackboard. Show a picture of a
basketball player. (课件出示:一名篮球运动员的图片)
Lead students to say “basketball player” according to the
“football player”.
Write down the phrase “basketball player” on the blackboard, and
get students to read after the teacher.
(4)Point to another man in the picture.
Ask students to describe his appearance and guess his job with the
pictures of a cook’s hat and a spatula on the PPT. (出示课件)
Ss: He’s a cook.
T: Yes. He can cook so many kinds of food. He is very helpful.
(5) Point to the little boy John.
T: Look, this is John. Can you say something about him?
Ss: He’s friendly.
T: Yes. He is very friendly. What’s his job? Is he a basketball
player, too?
Ss: … (Students guess.)
Present a schoolbag on the PPT and lead students to answer “No.”
(出示课件)
T: He likes basketball. But he isn’t a basketball player. He is
a student. He has no job.
Write down the phrase “no job” on the blackboard and teach it.
2. While-reading.
Read and tick or cross.
Teaching purpose
在预读中,先让学生观
察图片,结合图片中的人物,
师生展开对话,描述外貌特
征,猜测职业。既能复习旧
知,又能扫清小文段中的障
碍,为后面的阅读和任务的
完成奠定基础。
Teaching purpose
首先让学生粗读文段,
预测短文大意,并找出短文
的关键词汇;然后观察问题
里的图片,感知图片内容,
找出问题的关键信息,培养
学生自主阅读获取信息和处
理信息的能力。最后模仿录
音并跟读,引导学生按照正
确的语音、语调朗读短文。
269
(1) Show the passage of “Read and write”. (课件出示:教材 P63 Read
and write 板块的短文内容) Ask students to predict the main idea of the
passage.
(2) Look at the family photo in the book. Lead students to find
the key vocabulary “mother, teacher, father, basketball player, uncle,
cook, aunt, nurse” in the passage.
(3) Ask students to observe the pictures in the questions carefully
in the book. Lead students to find the key information of the questions.
Then let students read the passage and finish the task of “Read and
tick or cross”.
Check the answers together. Answers: ×××√
(4) Ask the question “What’s his/her job?” about the characters
in the pictures.
Ask students to find out and state the character’s jobs according
to the passage.
(5) Be “A reading star”.
Play the recording of the passage. (课件出示:教材 P63 Read and tick
or cross 部分的音频) Ask students to read after it and imitate with the
correct pronunciation and intonation.
Let students read together, then read the passage freely in groups.
Select one student from each group for the reading contest. The
best reader will be named as “A reading star”.
3. Post-reading.
Look and write.
(1) Show the picture of the driver in “Look and write”. (出示
课件)
T: What’s his job?
T: This is a man. So we say “He is a…”
Ss: He is a driver.
Then show the picture of the doctor in “Look and write”. (出
示课件)
T: What’s this man’s job?
Ss: He’s a doctor.
Write down the sentence structures “—What’s his job? —He’s
a/an…” on the blackboard.
Remind students to use capital letters at the beginning of
sentences. And ask students to fill in the blanks in the book as
required.
(2) Show the picture of the nurse in “Look and write”. (出示
课件)
T: This is a woman. So we say “She is a/an…”
Ss: She is a nurse.
Teaching purpose
先引导学生观察图片,
复习并熟练运用核心句型。
让学生根据自己观察到的图
片内容来选择正确的单词进
行填空,检验学生能否正确
地理解句子、认读单词。最
后在个性化书写中,让学生
发散思维,正确运用并书写
核心句型,让学生在使用中
巩固所学知识。
Then show the picture of the farmer in “Look and write”. (出
示课件)
T: What’s this woman’s job?
Ss: She’s a farmer.
Ask students to fill in the blanks in the book.
(3) Ask students to draw a stick figure of a family member and finish
the imitative writing activity in the book independently.
Step 3: Practice
1. Listen and tick.
Let students look at the pictures one by one. (课件出示:教材 P64
Listen and tick 部分的图片) Talk about the pictures with students:
How many people are there in Picture 1/Picture 2? (Four/Three.)
What’s his job in Picture 3/Picture 4? (He’s a farmer/doctor.)
What’s her job in Picture 5/Picture 6? (She’s a nurse/doctor.)
What’s his job in Picture 7/Picture 8? (He’s a cook/basketball
player.)
Then play the recording and ask students to finish the task. (出
示课件) Remind students to pay attention to the key vocabulary while
listening.
Ask students to retell what they have heard or say the key
vocabulary they have heard. Then check the answers in class.
Answers: P1; P4; P5; P8
2. Look and match.
Show the pictures of “Look and match” on the PPT.(课件出示: 教
材 P64 Look and match 部分的图片) Let students look at the pictures.
Ask them to read the text in the book carefully.
T: Let’s look at this family. How many people are there in this
family? What are their jobs?
Remind students to pay attention to the key words while reading
and match the pictures with the sentences. Then check the answers
together. (出示课件)
Lead students to chant the text with a certain rhythm.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Story time.
(1) Present the pictures of a baseball and a baseball player on
the PPT.(课件出示: 一个棒球及一名棒球运动员的图片)
Teach the word “baseball” and the phrase “baseball player”.
Present a picture of a taxi driver on the PPT and teach the phrase
“taxi driver”. (课件出示:一位出租车司机的图片)
Get students to read the phrases after the teacher and do actions.
(2) Play the cartoon. (课件出示:教材 P65 Story time 板块的动画)
(Help students understand the main idea of the story.) Introduce the
background of the story first.
Teaching purpose
在完成听力练习之前,
先引导学生观察图片获取信
息,养成在做听力题目之前
先获取信息的习惯。
Teaching purpose
这个活动检验学生能否
正确认读句型并理解重点词
汇和句型的意思。带韵律的
吟唱能增加文段朗读的趣味
性。
271
T: Some animals are in Zip’s house. They look at Zip’s family
photos and talk about the people in the photos.
Play the cartoon again and ask the questions.
Check the answers.
Answers: 1. Yes, they are.2. He’s a cook.3. It’s Zip.
(3) Play the recording of the story. (出示课件) Ask students to
read the story after the recording. Remind students to imitate the
pronunciation and the intonation after the recording.
(4) Ask students to act out the story in groups. Then choose two
or three groups to perform on the platform. And select the best group.
2. Sing the song together.
Play the song My family. (出示课件) Let students sing it in two
groups.
Show the second paragraph of the song on the PPT. Ask students to
learn to sing it.
Then lead students to make some new parts of the song according
to the real situations.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Complete the composition “My family” with the key vocabulary and sentence structures.
2. Sing the song to your parents.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 本课时是在基本掌握本单元重点词汇和句型的基础上进行的阅读、练习测试与复习课。
Teaching purpose
以重温歌曲的方式结束
课程,补充歌曲的第二段歌
词,编创后面歌词,让学生
通过歌曲来回忆本单元重点
词汇和核心句型,以达到总
结的目的。
2. 在阅读教学过程中,将知识点的难点在阅读前进行细化。阅读中教师指导学生抓住几个问题的关键词,
并通过听录音、读课文,把短文的重点句子找出来,阅读后,轻松完成活动。既减轻了学生的压力,也活跃了
课堂气氛。
3. 在整个教学过程中,充分运用游戏、图片、录音等教学手段,充分让学生参与课堂活动,学生的参与意
识很强,完成效果也不错。
4. 通过引导学生开展练习、操练句型、完成任务,加深了学生对句型的印象,也培养了学生继续学习英语
的兴趣。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Read and write
· Be able to read and understand the passage. And be able to finish the task of “Read and tick
or cross” according to the pictorial prompts.
· Be able to fill in the missing words with the pictures following the examples.
· Be able to present the required content with stick figure according to the actual situation,
and fill in the sentences following the examples.
Let’s check
· Check the key sentence structures in the unit. Examine the reading of the key vocabulary about
family and jobs in this unit.
Let’s sing
· Be able to understand the meaning of the lyrics and be able to sing it clearly and accurately.
Story time
· Be able to understand the story with the pictures, review and consolidate the vocabulary and
sentence structures related to the occupations.
· Be able to act out the story with the help of the teacher.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to use the key vocabulary and sentence structures of this unit synthetically, and complete
the exercises as required.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Summarize and review the main points learned in this unit. Improve students’ ability
of summarizing knowledge.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Lead-in
1. Enjoy a song—My family.
Play the song twice.
2. Revision.
Take out the word cards. Show
the word cards one by one.
1. Listen to the song and
sing after it. Sing the
song together.
2. Say the words quickly.
Then talk about family
members and the jobs of
their family members
Stimulate students’
interest in learning.
Review the key words and
sentence structures in
this unit.
273
with the word cards.
Presentation
1. Pre-reading.
Show the picture of “Read and
write” and talk about it with
students.
Teach the phrases
“basketball player, no
job”.
Talk about the characters
in the picture and
understand the meaning of
the phrases “basketball
player, no job”.
Review the knowledge
they have learned and
remove the obstacles in
the passage.
2. While-reading.
Read and tick or cross.
(1) Show the passage of “Read
and write” on the PPT.
(2) Lead students to find the key
vocabulary.
(3) Ask students to observe the
pictures and finish the task
in this section. Check the
answers.
(4) Ask the question “What’s
his/her job?” about the
characters in the pictures.
(5) Be “A reading star”.
(1) Predict the main idea
of the passage.
(2) Find the key
vocabulary in the
passage.
(3) Observe the pictures
and finish the task.
Check the answers.
(4) State the character’s
jobs according to the
passage.
(5) Read the passage in
different ways.
Compete to be “A
reading star”.
Cultivate students’
ability of obtaining
and processing
information. Improve
students’ reading
skills.
3. Post-reading.
Look and write.
Show the pictures in this
section on the PPT one by
one.
Ask students to fill in the
blanks.
Ask students to draw a stick
figure of a family member and
finish the imitative writing
activity in the book.
Talk about the pictures
and
fill in the blanks in the
book.
Draw a stick figure of a
family member. And finish
the imitative writing
activity in this section
independently.
Make sure students can
correctly understand
the sentences and
recognize the words.
Cultivate students’
awareness of
standardized writing.
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Practice
1. Listen and tick.
Lead students to look at
the pictures and talk
about them with students.
Play the recording.
Look at the picture and talk
with the teacher. Listen to
the recording and finish the
task.
Retell or say the content
Help students get
into the habit of
obtaining
information before
listening.
Check the answers. they have heard.
Check the answers.
2. Look and match.
Show the pictures. Lead
students to read the text
and complete the matching
task.
Look at the pictures and
read the text carefully.
Finish the matching task.
Chant the text with a
certain rhythm.
Check whether
students can read and
understand the
sentences correctly.
Increase students’
interest in reading
passages.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Story time.
(1) Teach the phrases
“baseball player, taxi
driver” with pictures.
(2) Play the cartoon twice.
Ask the questions.
(3) Play the recording.
(4) Ask two or three groups
of students to perform.
(1) Observe the pictures and
learn the phrases.
(2) Watch the cartoon twice
and answer the
questions.
(3) Read the story after the
recording.
(4) Ac t out the story in
groups.
Improve students’
participation and
help students
experience a
sense of achievement
in learning.
2. Sing the song together.
Play the song, and show
the second paragraph of
the song. Then let
students make some new
parts of the song
according to the real
situations.
Sing the song in two groups.
Make some new parts of the
song according to the real
situations.
Let students review
the key words and
sentence structures
of this unit to
achieve the purpose
of making a summary
through the song.
Homework
1. Complete the composition “My family” with the key vocabulary and sentence
structures.
2. Sing the song to your parents.
3. Do the exercises.
Recycle 2
教材分析
本单元是一个复习单元,主要复习 4~6 单元的核心知识点。该单元主要包含六个部分的内
容。
Read aloud 和 Listen and number the rooms 通过 John 和陈杰去 Mike 家参加家庭圣诞晚
宴的情景,让学生在情景中综合复习 4~6 单元的核心句型。并通过听录音为房间编号的活动,
复习第四单元房间名称的词汇。
Look, listen and write 通过小女孩与圣诞老人的对话复习本册所学的语音知识,活动要
求学生能根据单词读音填出对话中所缺少的单词。
Look, ask and answer 通过 John 一家人相聚过圣诞节的情景综合复习 4~6 单元的内容。包
275
括第四单元所学的房间名称词汇以及询问人物、物品位置的句型,第五单元的用餐情景和第六
单元询问并描述家庭情况和家人职业的句型。
Let’s sing 部分的歌曲围绕本单元主题“圣诞节”展开,帮助学生进一步感知单元主题。
Play a game 的活动综合复习 4~6 单元的重点词汇和核心句型,通过问答竞赛的形式来复习
位置、房间、家具、家人、职业和食物等话题的词汇和句型。
教学目标
知识与能力目标:
句型
·复习询问物品位置的句型“—Where are/is the…? —They’re/It’s…”“—Are/Is they/it
on/near/in the…? —Yes, they are/it is./No, they aren’t/it isn’t.”,并能够运用
这些句型询问和谈论物品位置
·复习用餐时的基本句型“—What would you like? —I’d like…”“Help yourself.”“Would
you like some…?”,并能够运用这些句型征求并表达用餐意愿,提出用餐建议
·复习询问别人家庭情况的句型“How many people are there in your family?”“Is this your…?”
“—What’s your…’s job? —She /He is a/an…”,并能够运用这些句型询问对方家庭成
员的信息和职业,回答自己的家庭情况
词汇
·理解 Merry Christmas 的意思,并会唱歌曲《We wish you a merry Christmas》
·复习词汇“bedroom, living room, study, kitchen, bathroom, bed, phone, table, sofa,
fridge”,并能够运用这些词汇简单描述自己的家,结合句型描述各个房间及室内家具陈设的
名称、特征、位置等
·复习单词“beef, chicken, noodles, soup, vegetable, chopsticks, bowl, fork, knife,
spoon”,并能够运用这些单词表达用餐食物和餐具使用意愿
·复习词汇“parents, cousin, uncle, aunt, baby brother, doctor, cook, driver, farmer,
nurse”,并能够正确使用上述词汇简单介绍家人情况
语音
·复习 a-e, i-e, o-e, u-e, -e 在单词中的长音发音规则,并能够综合运用这些规则,逐步做
到见词能够拼读,听音能够拼写
情感态度、文化意识、学习策略目标:
·感受并激发和家人间互爱互助的情感
·了解西方国家过圣诞节的文化习俗
·进一步注意到单词音、形、义之间的联系,整体学习单词,并能够将规律举一反三地运用
课时安排 第一课时: Read aloud & Listen and number the rooms & Look, listen and write
第二课时: Look, ask and answer & Let’s sing & Play a game
The first period(第一课时)
Read aloud & Listen and number the rooms & Look, listen and write
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Read aloud
·能够理解故事大意
·能够整体认读句子,用正确的语音、语调朗读对话
·能够在情景中综合运用 4~6 单元中的核心句型
·能够在语境中理解新词“Father Christmas, turkey”和情景语言“Merry Christmas”
的意思,并能够正确发音
Listen and
number the rooms
·能够看图说话并完成听录音给房间标号的任务
·能够复习巩固描述房间名称及室内陈设的重点词汇及句型
Look, listen and
write
·能够根据单词读音填出对话中所缺少的单词
·能够读出符合 a-e, i-e, o-e, u-e, -e 发音规则的单词
▶教学重点
1. 能够理解并在情景中综合运用 4~6 单元的重点词汇及核心句型。
2. 复习巩固 a-e, i-e, o-e, u-e, -e 在单词中的发音,能够读出符合其发音规则的单词。
▶教学难点
能够根据 a-e, i-e, o-e, u-e, -e 的发音规则拼写单词,完成听音填空任务。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2.PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、人物头饰等。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Lead-in
1. Sing a song—My home.
Play the video. (课件出示:教材 P44 Let’s sing 板块的歌曲视频) Ask
students to sing the song My home together.
2. Revision.
Show the pictures of “Let’s learn” on page 39. (课件出示:教
材 P39 Let’s learn 板块的图片)
T: Whose home is this?
Ss: It’s Amy’s home.
T: Where is Amy? Is she in the bathroom? Is she in the bedroom?
Ss: No. She is in the study.
T: Where are her mother and father? Are they in the study?
Ss: …
T: Where is the bed? Where is the phone?
Ss: …
Step 2: While-learning
1. Lead-in.
Play the cartoon of the last picture of the story on the PPT. (课
件出示: 教材 P66 最后一张图片的动画) And play the song We wish you a
merry Christmas as the background music. (出示课件)
T: Is this Mike’s family? Where are they?
Ss: …
T: What’s for dinner?
Teaching purpose
通过歌曲跟唱和图片讨
论,让学生在轻松愉快的氛
围中复习相关内容,为下一
环节的学习做好准备。
Teaching purpose
通过观察动画,讨论问
题,带领学生获取对话中的
信息,初步了解对话内容。
277
Lead students to observe the picture and answer, “Salad, bread,
juice…”
T: And turkey.
Teach the word “turkey”. Emphasize that “ur” sounds /ɜː/.
T: Listen! Why are Chen Jie and John having dinner with Mike’s
family?
Ss: For Christmas!
T: Do you know about Christmas? Can you say something about
Christmas?
Ask students to say what they know about Christmas in Chinese or
English.
2. Learn about the background of the story.
(1)Show the pictures of Christmas tree and Father Christmas on
the PPT. (课件出示:圣诞树和圣诞老人的图片)
Teach the word “Christmas”. Emphasize that “ch” sounds /k/.
The consonant “t” is silent.
Play Father Christmas and greet students with “Merry Christmas!”
Lead students to say “Merry Christmas!”
(2)Wear Mike’s father’s or mother’s headdress and talk with
students.
T: Now, I’m Mike’s mother/father. You’re at my home for
Christmas dinner.
T: What would you like?
S1: I’d like…
T: Would you like some turkey?
S2: Yes, please. / No, thanks.
3. Watch and answer.
Play the cartoon of the story on the PPT. (课件出示: 教材 P66 Read
aloud 板块的视频)Ask the question.
T: What would Chen Jie like?
Ss: She would like some turkey.
Present three questions and related pictures on the PPT. (出示
课件)Ask students to peruse the story with the questions, then answer
them.
①Where is the Christmas tree? (It’s in the living room.)
②Who is Father Christmas now? (Mike’s father.)
③What’s Mike’s mother’s job? (She’s a nurse.)
Check the answers together.
4. Listen and read.
Play the cartoon again. Let students listen carefully and read
after it.
Ask students to read the story in roles. Then act it out.
Step 3: Post-learning
Teaching purpose
通过讨论图片内容,让
学生理解故事的背景,为接
下来的活动做好准备。
Teaching purpose
设置问题引起学生阅读
的兴趣,让学生学会带着问
题去听、去读,培养他们认
真倾听和阅读的习惯。
Teaching purpose
通过跟读使学生掌握对
话的正确读音;通过自由读
及分角色读,使学生在不同
方式的读中熟悉、巩固重点
句型,内化语言,提高自己
的综合语言运用能力。
1. Listen and number the rooms.
(1)Present the picture of “Listen and number the rooms” on the
PPT.(课件出示:教材 P67 Listen and number the rooms 部分的图片)
T: Look! This is Mike’s home. Where is he? Is he in the study?
Ss: No. He’s in his bedroom.
T: Yes, and his father and mother are in their bedroom, too.
Father Christmas will come and give gifts to children. He will put
gifts in the socks.
(2)Play the recording of “Listen and number the rooms”. (课
件出示:教材 P67 Listen and number the rooms 部分的音频) Let students
listen to the recording and complete the task.
T: Father Christmas wants to give Mike some gifts for Christmas.
What does he say? Does he find the sock? Listen and number the rooms
according to what you hear.
Remind students that there are six rooms in the picture and only
five in the recording.
Check the answers.
T: Which room is not in the recording?
Ss: The bathroom.
2. Look, listen and write.
(1) Present the pictures of this part on the PPT. (课件出示:教
材 P67 Look, listen and write 部分的图片) Talk about them with students.
T: Do you like Christmas? Do you like Father Christmas? The name
of Father Christmas is Santa Claus. Look! A girl meets Santa Claus.
What does she want?
(2) Play the recording. (课件出示:教材 P67 Look, listen and write
部分的音频) Ask students to complete the task of writing the missing
words.
Check the answers.
(3) Ask students to read the dialogue freely and practice it in
roles. Then choose some students to act it out in class.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
1. Make a dialogue.
T: Do you want to invite your friends to your home? When will you
invite them? What will you say? What will you do? Ask students to make
a dialogue with their friends and practice in groups.
Walk around to help students solve problems in the process.
Ask four groups of students to perform on the platform. Then select
the best group.
2. Enjoy a song.
T: They say “Merry Christmas!” at Christmas. They sing Merry
Christmas, too. Let’s listen to other Christmas songs.
Teaching purpose
在进行听音标号活动之
前,先对学生进行一定的提
示和指导。完成活动之后,
让学生讨论自己的答案,为
他们创造交流的机会。
Teaching purpose
通过导读帮助学生理解
对话的背景;通过各种形式
的读,让学生掌握词汇及句
子的标准读音;通过表演使
学生内化语言,提高自己的
口语表达能力。
Teaching purpose
以欢乐的歌曲结束课
程,让学生能够在愉快的心
情中结束本课的学习。
279
Play a Christmas song Jingle Bells. (课件出示:歌曲《Jingle Bells》)
Let students listen to the song and sing along with it.
T: Do you like the song? Let’s sing the song together.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Read the story to your family.
2. Sing the song My family to your parents.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 本节课由歌曲开场,在跟唱歌曲和讨论图片的师生对话中,让学生复习了 4~6 单元所学的单词及短语,
然后引出相关话题的句型的复习,为本部分的对话学习做铺垫。
2. 学习故事的时候,通过图片和圣诞节音乐的播放,营造了真实的语言情景。其次,通过角色扮演的方式
练习对话,提高了学生的口语表达能力。
3. 通过听录音、看图片以及填单词的活动,复习并巩固了元音字母的发音规律。
4. 通过创编对话的活动,不仅让学生更好地内化了所学词汇和句子,更让语言知识借助真实情景得到延伸,
并且各个话题之间有横向和纵向的构建,从而完成了语言输出。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Read aloud
· Be able to understand the main idea of the story.
· Be able to read sentences as a whole and read the story with the correct pronunciation and
intonation.
·Be able to understand and apply the key sentence structures in Units 4~6 in situations.
· Be able to understand the new vocabulary “Father Christmas, turkey” and the sentence “Merry
Christmas!” in context and pronounce them correctly.
Listen and number the rooms
· Be able to describe the pictures and finish the task of listening and numbering the rooms.
· Be able to review and consolidate the key vocabulary and sentence structures that describe rooms
and indoor furnishings.
Look, listen and write
· Be able to write the missing words in the dialogue according to the pronunciation of the words.
· Be able to read the words that conform to the pronunciation rules of “a-e, i-e, o-e, u-e, -e”.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Be able to understand and apply the key vocabulary and sentence structures in Units 4~6 in
situations.
·Review and consolidate the pronunciation of “a-e, i-e, o-e, u-e, -e” in words and pronounce
the words according to their pronunciation rules.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to spell words according to the pronunciation rules of “a-e, i-e, o-e, u-e, -e” and
complete the task of listening and filling in the blanks.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Warm-up
&
Lead-in
1. Sing a song.
Play the song—My home.
2. Revision.
Show the pictures and talk
with students.
1. Listen to the song and
sing together.
2. Look at the pictures
and talk with the
teacher.
Review the content of
the rooms and indoor
furnishings through
the song and the
pictures. Prepare for
the next learning.
While-learning
1. Lead-in.
Play the cartoon of the last
picture and the song.
Teach the word “turkey”.
Watch the cartoon and
learn the word.
Then say something about
Christmas.
Lead students to get
information in the
story and have a
preliminary
understanding of the
story.
2. Learn about the background of
the story.
Show the pictures about
Christmas. Teach the word
“Christmas” and the phrase
“Merry Christmas”.
Look at the pictures and
learn the word
“Christmas” and the
phrase “Merry
Christmas”.
Help students know the
background of the
story.
3. Watch and answer.
Play the cartoon of the story
and ask some questions. Check
the answers with students.
Watch the cartoon and
answer the questions.
Check the answers with the
teacher.
Set questions to
stimulate students’
interest in reading.
Develop their habit of
listening and reading
281
carefully.
4. Listen and read.
Play the cartoon again and
ask students to read the
story in roles and act it out.
Listen carefully and read
after the cartoon.
Read the story in roles.
Then act it out.
Make sure students can
read the story
correctly and
fluently.
Strengthen the key
sentence structures
and internalize the
language. Improve
students’
comprehensive language
application
ability.
(续表)
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Post-learning
1. Listen and number the
rooms.
(1) Present the picture of
this part on the PPT. And
talk about it with
students.
(2) Play the recording and
lead students to
complete the task.
(1) Look at the picture and
review knowledge through
talking.
(2) Listen to the recording
and complete the task.
Improve students’
listening
skills. Help
students review the
vocabulary and the
sentence
structures about
rooms. Create
communication
opportunities for
students.
2. Look, listen and write.
(1) Present the pictures of
this part. Talk with
students.
(2) Play the recording. Ask
students to complete the
task. Then check the
answers.
(3) Ask students to read the
dialogue and act it out
in roles.
(1) Look at the pictures and
talk with the teacher.
(2) Complete the task of
writing the missing
words. Check the
answers.
(3) Read the dialogue and
act it out in roles.
Help students get the
standard
pronunciation of the
vocabulary and the
sentences by reading
in various forms.
Consolidation
&
Extension
1. Make a dialogue.
Ask students to make a
dialogue and act it out in
groups.
2. Enjoy a song.
Play the song Jingle
Bells.
1. Make a dialogue and act it
out in groups.
2. Listen to the song and
sing along with it.
Help students
internalize the
language and improve
their speaking
ability.
Homework
1. Read the story to your family.
2. Sing the song My family to your parents.
3. Do the exercises.
The second period(第二课时)
Look, ask and answer & Let’s sing & Play a game
▶教学内容与目标
课时教学内容 课时教学目标
Look, ask and
answer
·能够通过看图问答“Where’s…?”复习第四单元所学的房间名称词汇以及询问人物、物
品位置的句型
·能够通过看图问答“How many people are there in the family?”“Is this John’s…?”
“What’s his/her job?”复习第六单元询问并描述家庭情况和家人职业的句型
·能够通过观察图片复习第五单元的用餐情景
·能够在语境中灵活运用 4~6 单元的重点词汇和核心句型
Let’s sing ·能够了解歌词的意义,并清晰准确地歌唱
Play a game ·能够通过游戏活动复习巩固 4~6 单元的重点词汇和核心句型
▶教学重点
1. 能够通过一系列的活动来复习 4~6 单元的重点词汇和核心句型。
2. 能够在游戏中正确回答问题,复习巩固相关知识。
▶教学难点
能够使用所学内容正确地进行提问,并做出相应的回答。
▶教学准备
1.预习《状元大课堂》《创优作业 100 分》《状元作业本》中本课时的相关内容。
2.PPT 课件、课文录音、视频、各类词汇卡片(家人、职业和房间)、4~6 单元重点句型卡片。
▶教学过程
Step 1: Warm-up & Lead-in
1. Enjoy a song—We wish you a merry Christmas.
(1) Play the recording of the song We wish you a merry Christmas.
(出示课件)Let students listen and try to sing along with it.
(2) Ask students to sing the song in groups.
2. Lead-in.
T: Mike is at John’s home today. It’s time for dinner. Now, let’s
do a role-play.
Teaching purpose
以欢快的歌曲进行热
身,创造一个良好的语言环
境,为学生学习本节课的内
容做好充分的知识和心理准
备。
283
Show some pictures of food. (课件出示:Unit 5 中的食物图片) Take out
the headdresses of John and Mike. Lead students to make dialogues as
the demonstration.
S1(John): What would you like for dinner, Mike?
S2(Mike): I’d like some…, please.
S1(John): OK. Would you like some…?
S2(Mike): Yes, please. /…
Step 2: While-learning
Look, ask and answer.
(1) Take out the word cards of family members, jobs and room names.
①Ask students to read the words of family members in lines or rows
one by one.
②Select one from the cards of jobs. Lead students to do the
corresponding actions.
③Take out all the cards of room names. Play a guessing game with
students.
Take away a card and hide it when students close their eyes.
T: What’s missing?
Ss: … (Students guess the missing words.)
(2) Lead students to look at the small pictures of characters around
the big picture. (课件出示:教材 P68 Look, ask and answer 部分的人物
介绍图)
T: How many people are there in the family? Who are they?
Ss: …
…
(3) Lead students to ask and answer according to the pictures in
pairs as the example.
T: What’s John’s mum’s job?
Ss: She is a PE teacher.
S1: What’s John’s…’s job?
S2: He’s/She’s a…
…
(4) Present the pictures of this part on the PPT. (课件出示: 教
材 P68 Look, ask and answer 部分的图片)
Let students observe the pictures. Ask and answer in class with
the sentence structures “—Where is…? —He/ She is…” “—Where
are…? —They are…”
T: Where is John?
Ss: He is in the living room.
T: Where are John’s grandma and grandpa?
Ss: They are in the bedroom.
Teaching purpose
通过家人称呼类、职业
类和房间名称类词汇卡的呈
现、TPR 以及游戏“What’
s missing?”的开展,帮助学
生复习学过的词汇,为后面
完成问答活动做好准备。
Teaching purpose
通过老师的示范,帮助
学生尝试针对图片进行提
问,并引导其他学生回答。
Teaching purpose
完成针对图片进行的问
答活动,借以复习有关家庭
关系、家人职业的重点句型。
(5) Ask students to read the questions below the pictures and
discuss in pairs. Finally, choose four pairs of students to show their
answers.
Step 3: Post-learning
1. Talk about the pictures.
Let students close their books. Show the pictures of John’s family
on the PPT. (课件出示: 打乱顺序的 John 的家人的图片) Ask students to
tell who they are and what they do.
2. Let’s sort.
Show different kinds of words in Units 4~6 on the PPT. (课件出
示:教材 Units 4~6 中不同类的词汇)
Ask students to read the words and sort them. Choose some students
to show their answers.
Then check the answers together.
3. Play a game.
(1)Ask students to read the questions fluently by themselves.
Then lead students to ask and answer in groups.
(2)Choose some students to have a show. The winner is the group
that spends the least time.
( 3 ) Take out the question cards prepared before class. And
rearrange them. Finally ask several students to take turns on the
platform to choose cards. The rest of the class answer the questions
on the cards.
Step 4: Consolidation & Extension
Have a dictation.
Ask students to take out their exercise books and have a dictation
about the key vocabulary and sentences of Units 4~6.
▶板书设计
▶作业设计
1. Sing the song We wish you a merry Christmas to your parents.
Teaching purpose
以比赛的形式进行问答
活动,使学生在有限的时间
里练习重点句型,锻炼学生
熟练地使用重点句型的能
力。
Teaching purpose
通过听写使学生牢固掌
握 4~6 单元的重点词汇和句
子,并能查漏补缺,发现不
足。
Teaching purpose
复习 4~6 单元的重点词
汇,唤醒学生的记忆。为接
下来的活动做准备。
285
2. Read the sentences of “Play a game” five times.
3. Do the exercises. (见“状元成才路”系列丛书《创优作业 100 分》或《状元作业本》对应课时作业)
▶教学反思
1. 通过唱歌、词汇分类游戏及师生对话的方式,带领学生复习了 4~6 单元所学的词汇和句型,为本节课活
动的完成做了铺垫。
2. 通过听录音、唱歌曲和看图片等方式了解圣诞节文化。将文化和语言牢牢结合在一起,体现了语言的实
用性。
3. 通过小组竞赛、问答核心句型等方式,对本节课的知识加以巩固,激发了学生的积极性。整个教学过程
以学生活动为主,充分体现了以学生为主体的教育理念,教学效果良好。
▶Teaching Contents & Teaching Aims
Look, ask and answer
· Review the vocabulary of the room names and the sentence structures of asking about the location
of people and objects in Unit 4 by looking at the pictures, asking and answering the questions.
· Review the sentence structures of asking and describing family members and their jobs in Unit
6 by looking at the pictures, asking and answering the questions.
· Review the dining scene of Unit 5 by observing the pictures.
· Be able to use the key vocabulary and sentence structures flexibly in Units 4~6 in context.
Let’s sing
· Be able to understand the meaning of the lyrics and sing clearly and accurately.
Play a game
·Review and consolidate the key vocabulary and sentence structures in Units 4~6 by playing the
game.
▶Teaching Priorities
·Review the key vocabulary and sentence structures in Units 4~6 through a series of activities.
·Be able to answer the questions correctly in the games, review and consolidate relevant knowledge.
▶Teaching Difficulties
·Be able to use what they have learned to ask questions correctly and respond appropriately.
▶Teaching Procedures
Teaching
Stages Teacher’ s Activities Students’ Activities Teaching Purposes
Pre-learning
1. Enjoy a song.
Play the song We wish you a
merry Christmas.
2. Lead-in.
Show the pictures of food and
take out the headdresses of
John and Mike. Lead students
to make dialogues.
1. Listen to the song and
learn to sing.
2. Make dialogues as the
demonstration and act
it
out.
Create a good language
learning environment
for students.
Review the key words
and sentence
structures of Unit 5.
Make preparation for
the following class.
While-learning Look, ask and answer. Read the words in lines or Help students review
(1) Take out the word cards of
family members, jobs and room
names. Help students review
the vocabulary.
rows one by one. Do the
actions and play a
guessing game.
the learned
vocabulary. Prepare
for the next activity.
(2) Lead students to talk about
John’s family members with
the key sentence structures.
(3) Lead students to talk about
John’s family members’
jobs with the key sentence
structures.
(4) Present the pictures. Ask
students to talk about the
location of people with the
key sentence structures.
Observe the pictures. Ask
and answer in class with
the key sentence
structures in different
ways.
Through the teacher’s
demonstration, help
students try to talk
about the pictures.
Enhance students’
communication ability.
Help them review the
knowledge in Units 4~6.
(5) Lead students to finish the
exercises below the pictures
in the book.
Read the questions and
practice in pairs.
Review the key sentence
structures about
family relations and
jobs.
Post-learning
1. Talk about the pictures.
Show the pictures of John’s
family on the PPT. Ask
students to tell who they are
and what they do.
Look at the pictures on
the PPT and answer the
questions.
Through this activity,
students are more
familiar with the
vocabulary and the
sentence structures of
asking the location of
family members and
jobs.
2. Let’s sort.
Show different kinds of words
in Units 4~6 on the PPT. Ask
students to read and sort
them. Choose some students to
show their answers.
Read the words freely.
Sort the words.
Check the answers.
Review the words, wake
up students’ memory,
and prepare for the
following activity.
3. Play a game.
Lead students to complete the
activity in the form of
competition.
Complete the activity in
groups and in class.
In the form of
competition, students
can practice their
ability to use key
sentence structures
proficiently.
Consolidation
&
Extension
Have a dictation.
Have a dictation about the
key vocabulary and
sentences of Units 4~6.
Help students grasp the
key knowledge firmly.
And help them find
their weaknesses.
287
Homework
1. Sing the song We wish you a merry Christmas to your parents.
2. Read the sentences of “Play a game” five times.
3. Do the exercises.